Merge from trunk; up to 2012-12-09T01:04:43Z!rgm@gnu.org.
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
26 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
27 @end quotation
28 @end copying
29
30 @iftex
31 @iflatex
32 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
33 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
34 \usepackage{pagestyle}
35 \usepackage{epsfig}
36 \usepackage{pixidx}
37 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
38
39 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
40 \else
41 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
42 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
43 \pdfcompresslevel=9
44 \fi
45
46 \makeindex
47 \begin{document}
48
49 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
50 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
51 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
52 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
53
54 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
57 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
58 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
59 \else
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
61 \fi
62 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
64
65 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
75 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
85 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
92
93 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
95 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
96 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
97 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
98 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
100 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
101 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
106
107 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
110 }
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
113
114 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
115 {\mbox{}}
116 }
117
118 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
119 \gnusdimen 0pt
120
121 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
122 \gnuscleardoublepage
123 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
124 \chapter{#2}
125 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
126 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
127 \thispagestyle{empty}
128 \hspace*{-2cm}
129 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
130 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
131 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
132 \end{picture}
133 \clearpage
134 }
135
136 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
137 \begin{figure}
138 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
139 #3
140 \end{picture}
141 \caption{#1}
142 \end{figure}
143 }
144
145 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
146 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
147 }
148
149 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
150 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
151 }
152
153 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
154 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
155 }
156
157 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
158 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
159 }
160
161 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
162
163 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
164 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
165 \section{#1}
166 }
167
168 \newenvironment{codelist}%
169 {\begin{list}{}{
170 }
171 }{\end{list}}
172
173 \newenvironment{asislist}%
174 {\begin{list}{}{
175 }
176 }{\end{list}}
177
178 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
179 {\begin{list}{}{
180 \labelwidth=0cm
181 }
182 }{\end{list}}
183
184 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
185 {\begin{list}{}{
186 }
187 }{\end{list}}
188
189 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
190 {\begin{list}{}{
191 }
192 }{\end{list}}
193
194 \newenvironment{samplist}%
195 {\begin{list}{}{
196 }
197 }{\end{list}}
198
199 \newenvironment{varlist}%
200 {\begin{list}{}{
201 }
202 }{\end{list}}
203
204 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
205 {\begin{list}{}{
206 }
207 }{\end{list}}
208
209 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
210 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
211 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
212
213 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
214 {
215 {
216 \ifodd\count0
217 {
218 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
219 }
220 \else
221 {
222 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
223 }
224 }
225 \fi
226 }
227 }
228 {
229 \ifodd\count0
230 \mbox{} \hfill
231 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
232 \else
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
234 \hfill \mbox{}
235 \fi
236 }
237
238 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
239 {
240 {
241 \ifodd\count0
242 {
243 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
244 }
245 \else
246 {
247 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
248 }
249 \fi
250 }
251 }
252 {
253 \ifodd\count0
254 \mbox{} \hfill
255 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
256 \else
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
258 \hfill \mbox{}
259 \fi
260 }
261
262 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
263 {
264 {
265 \ifodd\count0
266 {
267 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
268 }
269 \else
270 {
271 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
272 }
273 \fi
274 }
275 }
276 {
277 \ifodd\count0
278 \mbox{} \hfill
279 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
280 \else
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
282 \hfill \mbox{}
283 \fi
284 }
285
286 \pagenumbering{roman}
287 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
288
289 @end iflatex
290 @end iftex
291
292 @iftex
293 @iflatex
294
295 \begin{titlepage}
296 {
297
298 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
299 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
300 \parindent=0cm
301 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
302
303 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
304 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
305 \vfill
306 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
307 \vfill
308 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
309 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
310 \newpage
311 }
312
313 \mbox{}
314 \vfill
315
316 \thispagestyle{empty}
317
318 @c @insertcopying
319 \newpage
320 \end{titlepage}
321 @end iflatex
322 @end iftex
323
324 @dircategory Emacs network features
325 @direntry
326 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
327 @end direntry
328 @iftex
329 @finalout
330 @end iftex
331
332
333 @titlepage
334 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
335 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
336 @end ifset
337 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
338 @title Gnus Manual
339 @end ifclear
340
341 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
342 @page
343 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
344 @insertcopying
345 @end titlepage
346
347 @summarycontents
348 @contents
349
350 @node Top
351 @top The Gnus Newsreader
352
353 @ifinfo
354
355 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
356 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
357 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
358 luck.
359
360 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
362
363 @ifnottex
364 @insertcopying
365 @end ifnottex
366
367 @end ifinfo
368
369 @iftex
370
371 @iflatex
372 \tableofcontents
373 \gnuscleardoublepage
374 @end iflatex
375
376 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
377 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
378
379 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
380 being accused of plagiarism:
381
382 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
383 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
384 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
385 can even read news with it!
386
387 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
388 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
389 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
390 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
391 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
392 the program.
393
394 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
395 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
396
397 @heading Other related manuals
398 @itemize
399 @item Message manual: Composing messages
400 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
401 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
402 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
403 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
404 @end itemize
405
406 @end iftex
407
408 @menu
409 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
410 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
411 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
412 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
413 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
414 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
415 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
416 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
417 * Various:: General purpose settings.
418 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
419 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
420 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
421 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
422 * Key Index:: Key Index.
423
424 Other related manuals
425
426 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
427 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
428 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
429 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
430 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
431
432 @detailmenu
433 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
434
435 Starting Gnus
436
437 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
438 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
439 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
440 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
441 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
442 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
443 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
444 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
445 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
446 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
447
448 New Groups
449
450 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
451 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
452 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
453
454 Group Buffer
455
456 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
457 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
458 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
459 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
460 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
461 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
462 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
463 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
464 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
465 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
466 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
467 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
468 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
469 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
470 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
471 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
472 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
473 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
474
475 Group Buffer Format
476
477 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
478 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
479 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
480
481 Group Topics
482
483 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
484 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
485 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
486 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
487 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
488
489 Misc Group Stuff
490
491 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
492 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
493 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
494 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
495 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
496
497 Summary Buffer
498
499 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
500 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
501 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
502 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
503 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
504 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
505 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
506 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
507 * Threading:: How threads are made.
508 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
509 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
510 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
511 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
512 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
513 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
514 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
515 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
516 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
517 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
518 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
519 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
520 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
521 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
522 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
523 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
524 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
525 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
526 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
527 or reselecting the current group.
528 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
529 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
530 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
531 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
532
533 Summary Buffer Format
534
535 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
536 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
537 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
538 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
539
540 Choosing Articles
541
542 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
543 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
544
545 Reply, Followup and Post
546
547 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
548 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
549 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
550 * Canceling and Superseding::
551
552 Marking Articles
553
554 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
555 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
556 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
557 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
558 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
559 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
560
561 Threading
562
563 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
564 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
565
566 Customizing Threading
567
568 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
569 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
570 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
571 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
572
573 Decoding Articles
574
575 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
576 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
577 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
578 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
579 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
580 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
581
582 Decoding Variables
583
584 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
585 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
586 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
587
588 Article Treatment
589
590 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
591 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
592 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
593 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
594 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
595 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
596 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
597 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
598 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
599 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
600 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
601
602 Alternative Approaches
603
604 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
605 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
606
607 Various Summary Stuff
608
609 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
610 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
611 * Summary Generation Commands::
612 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
613
614 Article Buffer
615
616 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
617 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
618 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
619 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
620 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
621
622 Composing Messages
623
624 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
625 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
626 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
627 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
628 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
629 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
630 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
631 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
632 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
633
634 Select Methods
635
636 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
637 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
638 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
639 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
640 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
641 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
642 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
643 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
644 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
645
646 Server Buffer
647
648 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
649 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
650 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
651 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
652 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
653 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
654 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
655
656 Getting News
657
658 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
659 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
660
661 @acronym{NNTP}
662
663 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
664 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
665 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
666
667 Getting Mail
668
669 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
670 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
671 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
672 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
673 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
674 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
675 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
676 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
677 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
678 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
679 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
680 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
681 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
682
683 Mail Sources
684
685 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
686 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
687 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
688
689 Choosing a Mail Back End
690
691 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
692 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
693 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
694 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
695 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
696 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
697 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
698
699 Browsing the Web
700
701 * Archiving Mail::
702 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
703 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
704 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
705
706 Other Sources
707
708 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
709 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
710 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
711 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
712 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
713
714 Document Groups
715
716 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
717
718 Combined Groups
719
720 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
721
722 Email Based Diary
723
724 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
725 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
726 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
727
728 The NNDiary Back End
729
730 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
731 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
732 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
733
734 The Gnus Diary Library
735
736 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
737 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
738 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
739 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
740
741 Gnus Unplugged
742
743 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
744 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
745 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
746 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
747 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
748 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
749 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
750 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
751 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
752 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
753 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
754 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
755 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
756 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
757
758 Agent Categories
759
760 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
761 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
762 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
763
764 Agent Commands
765
766 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
767 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
768 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
769
770 Scoring
771
772 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
773 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
774 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
775 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
776 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
777 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
778 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
779 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
780 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
781 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
782 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
783 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
784 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
785 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
786 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
787 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
788
789 Advanced Scoring
790
791 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
792 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
793 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
794
795 Searching
796
797 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
798 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
799
800 nnir
801
802 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
803 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
804 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
805
806 Setting up nnir
807
808 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
809
810 Various
811
812 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
813 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
814 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
815 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
816 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
817 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
818 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
819 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
820 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
821 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
822 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
823 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
824 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
825 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
826 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
827 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
828 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
829 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
830 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
831
832 Formatting Variables
833
834 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
835 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
836 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
837 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
838 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
839 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
840 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
841 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
842
843 Image Enhancements
844
845 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
846 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
847 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
848 meant to be shown.
849 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
850 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
851 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
852
853 Thwarting Email Spam
854
855 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
856 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
857 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
858 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
859
860 Spam Package
861
862 * Spam Package Introduction::
863 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
864 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
865 * Spam and Ham Processors::
866 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
867 * Spam Back Ends::
868 * Extending the Spam package::
869 * Spam Statistics Package::
870
871 Spam Statistics Package
872
873 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
874 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
875 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
876
877 Appendices
878
879 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
880 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
881 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
882 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
883 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
884 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
885 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
886 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
887 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
888
889 History
890
891 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
892 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
893 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
894 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
895 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
896 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
897 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
898 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
899
900 New Features
901
902 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
903 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
904 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
905 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
906 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
907 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
908 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
909 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
910
911 Customization
912
913 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
914 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
915 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
916 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
917
918 Gnus Reference Guide
919
920 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
921 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
922 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
923 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
924 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
925 * Group Info:: The group info format.
926 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
927 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
928 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
929
930 Back End Interface
931
932 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
933 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
934 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
935 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
936 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
937 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
938
939 Various File Formats
940
941 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
942 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
943
944 Emacs for Heathens
945
946 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
947 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
948
949 @end detailmenu
950 @end menu
951
952 @node Starting Up
953 @chapter Starting Gnus
954 @cindex starting up
955
956 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
957 Heathens} first.
958
959 @kindex M-x gnus
960 @findex gnus
961 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
962 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
963 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
964 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
965 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
966 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
967
968 @findex gnus-other-frame
969 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
970 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
971 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
972
973 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
974 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
975 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
976
977 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
978 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
979
980 @menu
981 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
982 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
983 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
984 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
985 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
986 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
987 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
988 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
989 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
990 @end menu
991
992
993 @node Finding the News
994 @section Finding the News
995 @cindex finding news
996
997 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
998 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
999 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1000 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1001 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1002 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1003 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1004 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1005
1006 @vindex gnus-select-method
1007 @c @head
1008 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1009 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1010 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1011 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1012 secondary or foreign groups.
1013
1014 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1015 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1016
1017 @lisp
1018 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1019 @end lisp
1020
1021 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1022
1023 @lisp
1024 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1025 @end lisp
1026
1027 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1028 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1029 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1030 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1033 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1034 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1035 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1036 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1037 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1038 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1039 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1040 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1041
1042 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1043 @kindex B (Group)
1044 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1045 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1046 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1047 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1048 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1049 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1050
1051 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1052 @c @head
1053 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1054 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1055 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1056 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1057 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1058 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1059 groups are.
1060
1061 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1062 you would typically set this variable to
1063
1064 @lisp
1065 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1066 @end lisp
1067
1068
1069
1070 @node The Server is Down
1071 @section The Server is Down
1072 @cindex server errors
1073
1074 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1075 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1076 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1077
1078 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1079 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1080 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1081 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1082 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1083 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1084 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1085
1086 @findex gnus-no-server
1087 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1088 @c @head
1089 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1090 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1091 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1092 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1093 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1094 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1095 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1096
1097
1098 @node Slave Gnusae
1099 @section Slave Gnusae
1100 @cindex slave
1101
1102 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1103 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1104 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1105 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1106
1107 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1108 @file{.newsrc} file.
1109
1110 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1111 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1112 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1113 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1114 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1115 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1116 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1117
1118 @findex gnus-slave
1119 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1120 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1121 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1122 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1123 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1124 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1125 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1126 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1127
1128 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1129 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1130
1131 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1132 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1133 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1134 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1135 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1136
1137
1138
1139 @node New Groups
1140 @section New Groups
1141 @cindex new groups
1142 @cindex subscription
1143
1144 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1145 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1146 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1147 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1148 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1149 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1150 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1151 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1152 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1153
1154 @menu
1155 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1156 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1157 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1158 @end menu
1159
1160
1161 @node Checking New Groups
1162 @subsection Checking New Groups
1163
1164 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1165 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1166 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1167 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1168 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1169 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1170 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1171 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1172 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1173 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1174 command.
1175
1176 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1177 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1178 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1179 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1180 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1181 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1182 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1183 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1184 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1185 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1186 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1187
1188 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1189 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1190 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1191 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1192 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1193 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1194
1195
1196 @node Subscription Methods
1197 @subsection Subscription Methods
1198
1199 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1200 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1201 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1202
1203 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1204 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1205
1206 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1207
1208 @table @code
1209
1210 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1211 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1212 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1213 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1214 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1215 (with @kbd{u}).
1216
1217 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1218 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1219 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1220 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1221
1222 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1223 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1224 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1225
1226 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1227 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1228 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1229 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1230 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1231 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1232 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1233 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1234 up. Or something like that.
1235
1236 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1237 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1238 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1239 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1240 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1241
1242 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1243 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1244 Kill all new groups.
1245
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1248 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1249 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1250 topic parameter that looks like
1251
1252 @example
1253 "nnml"
1254 @end example
1255
1256 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1257 that topic.
1258
1259 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1260 top-level topic.
1261
1262 @end table
1263
1264 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1265 A closely related variable is
1266 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1267 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1268 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1269 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1270 hierarchy or not.
1271
1272 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1273 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1274 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1275 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1276
1277
1278 @node Filtering New Groups
1279 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1280
1281 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1282 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1283 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1284
1285 @example
1286 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1287 @end example
1288
1289 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1290 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1291 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1292 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1293 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1294 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1295 subscribing these groups.
1296 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1297 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1298
1299 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1300 that is supports -- you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1301 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1302
1303 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1304 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1305 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1306 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1307 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1308 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1309 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1310 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1311
1312 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1313 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1314 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1315 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1316 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1317 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1318 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1319 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1320 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1321 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1322 variable to @code{nil}.
1323
1324 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1325 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1326 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1327 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1328 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1329 should be subscribed automatically.
1330
1331 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1332 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1333
1334
1335 @node Changing Servers
1336 @section Changing Servers
1337 @cindex changing servers
1338
1339 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1340 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1341 very flaky and you want to use another.
1342
1343 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1344 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1345
1346 @emph{Wrong!}
1347
1348 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1349 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1350 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1351 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1352 worthless.
1353
1354 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1355 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1356 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1357 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1358 Use with caution.
1359
1360 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1361 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1362 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1363 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1364
1365 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1366 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1367 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1368 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1369 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1370 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1371 cache for all groups).
1372
1373
1374 @node Startup Files
1375 @section Startup Files
1376 @cindex startup files
1377 @cindex .newsrc
1378 @cindex .newsrc.el
1379 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1380
1381 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1382 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1383 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1384 read.
1385
1386 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1387 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1388 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1389 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1390 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1391 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1392 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1393
1394 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1395 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1396 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1397 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1398 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1399 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1400
1401 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1402 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1403 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1404 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1405 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1406 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1407 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1408 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1409 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1410 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1411 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1412 news reader.
1413
1414 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1415 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1416 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1417 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1418 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1419 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1420 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1421 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1422 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1423 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1424 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1425 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1426
1427 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1428 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1429 @vindex version-control
1430 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1431 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1432 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1433 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1434 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1435 @code{version-control} variable.
1436
1437 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1438 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1439 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1440 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1441 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1442 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1443 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1444 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1445 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1446 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1447
1448 @lisp
1449 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1450 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1451
1452 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1453 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1454 @end lisp
1455
1456 @vindex gnus-init-file
1457 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1458 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1459 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1460 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1461 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1462 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1463 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1464 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1465 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1466 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1467 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1468 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1469 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1470
1471
1472 @node Auto Save
1473 @section Auto Save
1474 @cindex dribble file
1475 @cindex auto-save
1476
1477 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1478 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1479 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1480 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1481 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1482 this file.
1483
1484 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1485 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1486 saved.
1487
1488 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1489 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1490 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1491
1492 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1493 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1494 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1495 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1496 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1497 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1498
1499 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1500 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1501 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1502
1503
1504 @node The Active File
1505 @section The Active File
1506 @cindex active file
1507 @cindex ignored groups
1508
1509 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1510 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1511 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1512
1513 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1514 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1515 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1516 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1517 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1518 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1519 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1520
1521 @c This variable is
1522 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1523 @c if you set it to anything else.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1526 @c @head
1527 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1528 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1529 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1530
1531 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1532 you actually subscribe to.
1533
1534 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1535 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1536 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1537 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1538
1539 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1540 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1541 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1542 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1543 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1544 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1545
1546 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1547 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1548 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1549 variable.
1550
1551 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1552 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1553 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1554 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1555 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1556 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1557
1558 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1559 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1560
1561 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1562 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1563
1564 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1565 secondary select methods.
1566
1567
1568 @node Startup Variables
1569 @section Startup Variables
1570
1571 @table @code
1572
1573 @item gnus-load-hook
1574 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1575 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1576 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1577 times you start Gnus.
1578
1579 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1580 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1581 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1582
1583 @item gnus-before-resume-hook
1584 @vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1585 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1586
1587 @item gnus-startup-hook
1588 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1589 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1590
1591 @item gnus-started-hook
1592 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1593 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1594 successfully.
1595
1596 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1597 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1598 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1599 generating the group buffer.
1600
1601 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1602 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1603 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1604 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1605 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1606 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1607 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1608 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1609
1610 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1611 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1612 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1613 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1614 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1615 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1616
1617 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1618 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1619 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1620
1621 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1622 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1623 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1624 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1625 group operation some.
1626
1627 @end table
1628
1629
1630 @node Group Buffer
1631 @chapter Group Buffer
1632 @cindex group buffer
1633
1634 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1635 @c
1636 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1637 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1638 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1639 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1640 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1641 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1642 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1643 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1644 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1645 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1646 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1647 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1648 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1649 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1650 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1651 @c human rights at 9...
1652
1653
1654 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1655 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1656 long as Gnus is active.
1657
1658 @iftex
1659 @iflatex
1660 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1661 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1662 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1663 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1664 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1665 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1666 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1667 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1668 }
1669 @end iflatex
1670 @end iftex
1671
1672 @menu
1673 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1674 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1675 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1676 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1677 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1678 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1679 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1680 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1681 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1682 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1683 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1684 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1685 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1686 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1687 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1688 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1689 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1690 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1691 @end menu
1692
1693
1694 @node Group Buffer Format
1695 @section Group Buffer Format
1696
1697 @menu
1698 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1699 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1700 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1701 @end menu
1702
1703 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1704 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1705 available in Emacs.
1706
1707 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1708 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1709 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1710 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1711 Emacs version.
1712
1713 @node Group Line Specification
1714 @subsection Group Line Specification
1715 @cindex group buffer format
1716
1717 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1718 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1719
1720 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1721
1722 @example
1723 25: news.announce.newusers
1724 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1725 @end example
1726
1727 Quite simple, huh?
1728
1729 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1730 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1731 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1732 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1733
1734 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1735 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1736 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1737 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1738 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1739 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1740
1741 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1742
1743 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1744 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1745 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1746 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1747 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1748
1749 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1750 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1751 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1752
1753 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1754
1755 @table @samp
1756
1757 @item M
1758 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1759
1760 @item S
1761 Whether the group is subscribed.
1762
1763 @item L
1764 Level of subscribedness.
1765
1766 @item N
1767 Number of unread articles.
1768
1769 @item I
1770 Number of dormant articles.
1771
1772 @item T
1773 Number of ticked articles.
1774
1775 @item R
1776 Number of read articles.
1777
1778 @item U
1779 Number of unseen articles.
1780
1781 @item t
1782 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1783 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1784
1785 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1786 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1787 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1788 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1789 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1790 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1791 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1792
1793 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1794 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1795 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1796 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1797 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1798 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1799 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1800
1801 @item y
1802 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1803
1804 @item i
1805 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1806
1807 @item g
1808 Full group name.
1809
1810 @item G
1811 Group name.
1812
1813 @item C
1814 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1815 comment element in the group parameters.
1816
1817 @item D
1818 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1819 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1820 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1821 command.
1822
1823 @item o
1824 @samp{m} if moderated.
1825
1826 @item O
1827 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1828
1829 @item s
1830 Select method.
1831
1832 @item B
1833 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1834
1835 @item n
1836 Select from where.
1837
1838 @item z
1839 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1840 used.
1841
1842 @item P
1843 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1844
1845 @item c
1846 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1847 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1848 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1849 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1850 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1851
1852 @item m
1853 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1854 @cindex %
1855 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1856 the group lately.
1857
1858 @item p
1859 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1860
1861 @item d
1862 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1863 Timestamp}).
1864
1865 @item F
1866 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1867 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1868 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1869 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1870
1871 @item u
1872 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1873 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1874 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1875 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1876 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1877 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1878 specifier.
1879 @end table
1880
1881 @cindex *
1882 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1883 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1884 group, or a bogus native group.
1885
1886
1887 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1888 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1889 @cindex group mode line
1890
1891 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1892 The mode line can be changed by setting
1893 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1894 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1895
1896 @table @samp
1897 @item S
1898 The native news server.
1899 @item M
1900 The native select method.
1901 @end table
1902
1903
1904 @node Group Highlighting
1905 @subsection Group Highlighting
1906 @cindex highlighting
1907 @cindex group highlighting
1908
1909 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1910 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1911 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1912 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1913 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1914
1915 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1916 background is dark:
1917
1918 @lisp
1919 (cond (window-system
1920 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1921 (defface my-group-face-1
1922 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1923 (defface my-group-face-2
1924 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1925 "Second group face")
1926 (defface my-group-face-3
1927 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1928 (defface my-group-face-4
1929 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1930 (defface my-group-face-5
1931 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1932
1933 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1934 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1935 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1936 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1937 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1938 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1939 @end lisp
1940
1941 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1942
1943 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1944 include:
1945
1946 @table @code
1947 @item group
1948 The group name.
1949 @item unread
1950 The number of unread articles in the group.
1951 @item method
1952 The select method.
1953 @item mailp
1954 Whether the group is a mail group.
1955 @item level
1956 The level of the group.
1957 @item score
1958 The score of the group.
1959 @item ticked
1960 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1961 @item total
1962 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1963 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1964 @item topic
1965 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1966 topic being inserted.
1967 @end table
1968
1969 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1970 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1971 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1972
1973 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1974 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1975 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1976 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1977
1978
1979 @node Group Maneuvering
1980 @section Group Maneuvering
1981 @cindex group movement
1982
1983 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1984 expected, hopefully.
1985
1986 @table @kbd
1987
1988 @item n
1989 @kindex n (Group)
1990 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1991 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1992 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1993
1994 @item p
1995 @itemx DEL
1996 @kindex DEL (Group)
1997 @kindex p (Group)
1998 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1999 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2000 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2001
2002 @item N
2003 @kindex N (Group)
2004 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2005 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2006
2007 @item P
2008 @kindex P (Group)
2009 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2010 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2011
2012 @item M-n
2013 @kindex M-n (Group)
2014 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2015 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2016 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2017
2018 @item M-p
2019 @kindex M-p (Group)
2020 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2021 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2022 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2023 @end table
2024
2025 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2026
2027 @table @kbd
2028
2029 @item j
2030 @kindex j (Group)
2031 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2032 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2033 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2034 like living groups.
2035
2036 @item ,
2037 @kindex , (Group)
2038 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2039 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2040 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2041
2042 @item .
2043 @kindex . (Group)
2044 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2045 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2046 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2047 @end table
2048
2049 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2050 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2051 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2052 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2053 is @code{t}.
2054
2055 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2056 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2057 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2058 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2059 @code{t}.
2060
2061 @node Selecting a Group
2062 @section Selecting a Group
2063 @cindex group selection
2064
2065 @table @kbd
2066
2067 @item SPACE
2068 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2069 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2070 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2071 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2072 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2073 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2074 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2075 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2076 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2077 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2078
2079 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2080 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2081 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2082
2083 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2084 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2085 ones.
2086
2087 @item RET
2088 @kindex RET (Group)
2089 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2090 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2091 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2092 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2093 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2094 entry.
2095
2096 @item M-RET
2097 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2098 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2099 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2100 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2101 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2102 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2103 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2104 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2105 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2106 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2107
2108 @item M-SPACE
2109 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2110 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2111 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2112 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2113 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2114
2115 @item C-M-RET
2116 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2117 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2118 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2119 doing any processing of its contents
2120 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2121 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2122 manner will have no permanent effects.
2123
2124 @end table
2125
2126 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2127 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2128 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2129 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2130 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2131 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2132 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2133 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2134 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2135 most recently will be fetched.
2136
2137 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2138 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2139 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2140 newsgroups.
2141
2142 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2143 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2144 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2145 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2146 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2147 are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2148 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2149 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2150 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2151 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2152 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2153 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2154 get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
2155 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2156 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2157 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2158 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2159
2160 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2161 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2162 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2163 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2164 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2165 Which article this is controlled by the
2166 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2167 variable are:
2168
2169 @table @code
2170
2171 @item unread
2172 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2173
2174 @item first
2175 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2176
2177 @item unseen
2178 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2179
2180 @item unseen-or-unread
2181 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2182 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2183 unread article.
2184
2185 @item best
2186 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2187
2188 @end table
2189
2190 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2191 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2192
2193 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2194 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2195 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2196 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2197 selected.
2198
2199
2200 @node Subscription Commands
2201 @section Subscription Commands
2202 @cindex subscription
2203
2204 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2205 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2206 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2207 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2208 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2209
2210 @table @kbd
2211
2212 @item S t
2213 @itemx u
2214 @kindex S t (Group)
2215 @kindex u (Group)
2216 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2217 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2218 Toggle subscription to the current group
2219 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2220
2221 @item S s
2222 @itemx U
2223 @kindex S s (Group)
2224 @kindex U (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2226 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2227 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2228 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2229
2230 @item S k
2231 @itemx C-k
2232 @kindex S k (Group)
2233 @kindex C-k (Group)
2234 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2235 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2236 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2237
2238 @item S y
2239 @itemx C-y
2240 @kindex S y (Group)
2241 @kindex C-y (Group)
2242 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2243 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2244
2245 @item C-x C-t
2246 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2247 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2248 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2249 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2250 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2251
2252 @item S w
2253 @itemx C-w
2254 @kindex S w (Group)
2255 @kindex C-w (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2257 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2258
2259 @item S z
2260 @kindex S z (Group)
2261 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2262 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2263
2264 @item S C-k
2265 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2266 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2267 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2268 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2269 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2270 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2271 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2272 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2273 @file{.newsrc} file.
2274
2275 @end table
2276
2277 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2278
2279
2280 @node Group Data
2281 @section Group Data
2282
2283 @table @kbd
2284
2285 @item c
2286 @kindex c (Group)
2287 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2288 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2289 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2290 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2291 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2292 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2293 the group buffer.
2294
2295 @item C
2296 @kindex C (Group)
2297 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2298 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2299 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2300
2301 @item M-c
2302 @kindex M-c (Group)
2303 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2304 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2305 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2306
2307 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2308 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2309 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2310 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2311 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2312 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2313 caution.
2314
2315 @end table
2316
2317
2318 @node Group Levels
2319 @section Group Levels
2320 @cindex group level
2321 @cindex level
2322
2323 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2324 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2325 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2326 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2327 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2328
2329 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2330
2331 @table @kbd
2332
2333 @item S l
2334 @kindex S l (Group)
2335 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2336 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2337 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2338 prompted for a level.
2339 @end table
2340
2341 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2342 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2343 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2344 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2345 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2346 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2347 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2348 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2349 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2350 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2351 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2352 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2353 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2354 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2355 reasons of efficiency.
2356
2357 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2358 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2359
2360 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2361 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2362 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2363 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2364 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2365 groups are hidden, in a way.
2366
2367 @cindex zombie groups
2368 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2369 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2370 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2371 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2372 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2373 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2374
2375 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2376 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2377 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2378 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2379 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2380 list of killed groups.)
2381
2382 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2383 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2384 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2385
2386 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2387 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2388 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2389 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2390 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2391 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2392 relevant valid ranges.
2393
2394 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2395 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2396 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2397 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2398 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2399 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2400 rest.
2401
2402 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2403 one with the best level.
2404
2405 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2406 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2407 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2408 by default.
2409 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2410 be called and the result will be used as value.
2411
2412
2413 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2414 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2415 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2416 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2417 listed.
2418
2419 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2420 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2421 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2422 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2423
2424 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2425 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2426 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2427 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2428 to 5. The default is 6.
2429
2430
2431 @node Group Score
2432 @section Group Score
2433 @cindex group score
2434 @cindex group rank
2435 @cindex rank
2436
2437 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2438 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2439 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2440 reason?
2441
2442 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2443 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2444 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2445 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2446 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2447 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2448 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2449 least significant part.))
2450
2451 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2452 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2453 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2454 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2455 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2456 action after each summary exit, you can add
2457 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2458 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2459 slow things down somewhat.
2460
2461
2462 @node Marking Groups
2463 @section Marking Groups
2464 @cindex marking groups
2465
2466 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2467 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2468 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2469 bidding on those groups.
2470
2471 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2472 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2473 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2474
2475 @table @kbd
2476
2477 @item #
2478 @kindex # (Group)
2479 @itemx M m
2480 @kindex M m (Group)
2481 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2482 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2483
2484 @item M-#
2485 @kindex M-# (Group)
2486 @itemx M u
2487 @kindex M u (Group)
2488 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2489 Remove the mark from the current group
2490 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2491
2492 @item M U
2493 @kindex M U (Group)
2494 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2495 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2496
2497 @item M w
2498 @kindex M w (Group)
2499 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2500 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2501
2502 @item M b
2503 @kindex M b (Group)
2504 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2505 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2506
2507 @item M r
2508 @kindex M r (Group)
2509 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2510 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2511 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2512 @end table
2513
2514 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2515
2516 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2517 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2518 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2519 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2520 the command to be executed.
2521
2522
2523 @node Foreign Groups
2524 @section Foreign Groups
2525 @cindex foreign groups
2526
2527 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2528 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2529 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2530 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2531 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2532 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2533 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2534 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2535
2536 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2537 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2538 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2539 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2540 consulted.
2541
2542 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2543 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2544 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2545
2546 @table @kbd
2547
2548 @item G m
2549 @kindex G m (Group)
2550 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2551 @cindex making groups
2552 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2553 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2554 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2555
2556 @item G M
2557 @kindex G M (Group)
2558 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2559 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2560 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2561
2562 @item G r
2563 @kindex G r (Group)
2564 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2565 @cindex renaming groups
2566 Rename the current group to something else
2567 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2568 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2569 on some back ends.
2570
2571 @item G c
2572 @kindex G c (Group)
2573 @cindex customizing
2574 @findex gnus-group-customize
2575 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2576
2577 @item G e
2578 @kindex G e (Group)
2579 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2580 @cindex renaming groups
2581 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2582 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2583
2584 @item G p
2585 @kindex G p (Group)
2586 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2587 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2588 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2589
2590 @item G E
2591 @kindex G E (Group)
2592 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2593 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2594 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2595
2596 @item G d
2597 @kindex G d (Group)
2598 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2599 @cindex nndir
2600 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2601 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2602
2603 @item G h
2604 @kindex G h (Group)
2605 @cindex help group
2606 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2607 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2608
2609 @item G D
2610 @kindex G D (Group)
2611 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2612 @cindex nneething
2613 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2614 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2615 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2616
2617 @item G f
2618 @kindex G f (Group)
2619 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2620 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2621 @cindex nndoc
2622 Make a group based on some file or other
2623 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2624 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2625 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2626 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2627 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2628 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2629 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2630 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2631 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2632
2633 @item G u
2634 @kindex G u (Group)
2635 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2636 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2637 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2638 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2639
2640 @item G w
2641 @kindex G w (Group)
2642 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2643 @cindex Google
2644 @cindex nnweb
2645 @cindex gmane
2646 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2647 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2648 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2649 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2650 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2651 @xref{Web Searches}.
2652
2653 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2654 to a particular group by using a match string like
2655 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2656
2657 @item G R
2658 @kindex G R (Group)
2659 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2660 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2661 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2662 @xref{RSS}.
2663
2664 @item G DEL
2665 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2666 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2667 This function will delete the current group
2668 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2669 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2670 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2671 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2672 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2673
2674 @item G V
2675 @kindex G V (Group)
2676 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2677 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2678 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2679
2680 @item G v
2681 @kindex G v (Group)
2682 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2683 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2684 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2685 @end table
2686
2687 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2688 methods.
2689
2690 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2691 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2692 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2693 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2694 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2695 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2696 newsgroups.
2697
2698
2699 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2700 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2701
2702 @table @code
2703 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2704 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2705 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2706 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2707 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2708 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2709 the article range.
2710
2711 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2712 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2713 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2714 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2715 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2716 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2717 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2718 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2719 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2720 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2721
2722 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2723 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2724 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2725 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2726 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2727
2728 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2729 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2730 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2731 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2732 @end table
2733
2734 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2735 Buttons}.
2736
2737 Here is an example:
2738 @lisp
2739 (require 'gnus-art)
2740 (add-to-list
2741 'gnus-button-alist
2742 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2743 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2744 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2745 @end lisp
2746
2747
2748 @node Group Parameters
2749 @section Group Parameters
2750 @cindex group parameters
2751
2752 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2753
2754 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2755 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2756 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2757 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2758 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2759 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2760 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2761
2762 Here's an example group parameter list:
2763
2764 @example
2765 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2766 (auto-expire . t))
2767 @end example
2768
2769 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2770 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2771 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2772 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2773
2774 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2775 is an alist of regexps and values.
2776
2777 The following group parameters can be used:
2778
2779 @table @code
2780 @item to-address
2781 @cindex to-address
2782 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2783
2784 @example
2785 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2786 @end example
2787
2788 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2789 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2790 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2791 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2792 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2793
2794 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2795 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2796 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2797 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2798 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2799 list address instead.
2800
2801 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2802
2803 @item to-list
2804 @cindex to-list
2805 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2806
2807 @example
2808 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2809 @end example
2810
2811 It is totally ignored
2812 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2813 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2814
2815 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2816 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2817 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2818 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2819 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2820
2821 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2822 @cindex mail list groups
2823 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2824 entering summary buffer.
2825
2826 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2827
2828 @anchor{subscribed}
2829 @item subscribed
2830 @cindex subscribed
2831 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2832 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2833 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2834 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2835 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2836 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2837 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2838 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2839
2840 @lisp
2841 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2842 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2843 @end lisp
2844
2845 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2846 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2847
2848 @item visible
2849 @cindex visible
2850 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2851 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2852 of whether it has any unread articles.
2853
2854 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2855 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2856
2857 @item broken-reply-to
2858 @cindex broken-reply-to
2859 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2860 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2861 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2862 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2863 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2864 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2865
2866 @item to-group
2867 @cindex to-group
2868 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2869 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2870
2871 @item newsgroup
2872 @cindex newsgroup
2873 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2874 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2875 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2876 news group.
2877
2878 @item gcc-self
2879 @cindex gcc-self
2880 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2881 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2882 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2883 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2884 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2885 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2886 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2887
2888 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2889 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2890 doesn't accept articles.
2891
2892 @item auto-expire
2893 @cindex auto-expire
2894 @cindex expiring mail
2895 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2896 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2897 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2898
2899 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2900
2901 @item total-expire
2902 @cindex total-expire
2903 @cindex expiring mail
2904 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2905 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2906 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2907 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2908 expiry.
2909
2910 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2911
2912 @item expiry-wait
2913 @cindex expiry-wait
2914 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2915 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2916 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2917 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2918 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2919 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2920 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2921
2922 @item expiry-target
2923 @cindex expiry-target
2924 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2925 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2926
2927 @item score-file
2928 @cindex score file group parameter
2929 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2930 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2931 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2932
2933 @item adapt-file
2934 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2935 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2936 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2937 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2938
2939 @item admin-address
2940 @cindex admin-address
2941 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2942 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2943 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2944 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2945
2946 @item display
2947 @cindex display
2948 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2949 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2950
2951 @table @code
2952 @item all
2953 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2954
2955 @item an integer
2956 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2957 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2958
2959 @item default
2960 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2961 ticked articles.
2962
2963 @item an array
2964 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2965
2966 Here are some examples:
2967
2968 @table @code
2969 @item [unread]
2970 Display only unread articles.
2971
2972 @item [not expire]
2973 Display everything except expirable articles.
2974
2975 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2976 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2977 responded to.
2978 @end table
2979
2980 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2981 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2982 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2983 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2984 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2985
2986 @end table
2987
2988 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2989 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2990 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2991
2992 @item comment
2993 @cindex comment
2994 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2995 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2996 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2997
2998 @item charset
2999 @cindex charset
3000 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3001 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3002 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3003
3004 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3005
3006 @item ignored-charsets
3007 @cindex ignored-charset
3008 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3009 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3010 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3011
3012 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3013
3014 @item posting-style
3015 @cindex posting-style
3016 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3017 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3018 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3019 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3020 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3021
3022 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3023 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3024 like this in the group parameters:
3025
3026 @example
3027 (posting-style
3028 (name "Funky Name")
3029 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3030 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3031 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3032 @end example
3033
3034 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3035 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3036 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3037 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3038 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3039 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3040 to.
3041
3042
3043 @item post-method
3044 @cindex post-method
3045 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3046 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3047
3048 @item mail-source
3049 @cindex mail-source
3050 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3051 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3052 mail source for this group.
3053
3054 @item banner
3055 @cindex banner
3056 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3057 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3058 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3059 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3060 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3061
3062 @item sieve
3063 @cindex sieve
3064 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3065 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3066 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3067 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3068
3069 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3070 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3071 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3072 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3073
3074 @example
3075 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3076 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3077 @}
3078 @end example
3079
3080 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3081 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3082 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3083 like the following is generated:
3084
3085 @example
3086 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3087 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3088 @}
3089 @end example
3090
3091 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3092 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3093
3094 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3095 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3096
3097 @item (agent parameters)
3098 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3099 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3100 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3101 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3102 minimize the configuration effort.
3103
3104 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3105 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3106 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3107 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3108 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3109 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3110 @code{eval}ed there.
3111
3112 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3113 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3114 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3115 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3116 form needs to be set to it.
3117
3118 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3119 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3120 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3121 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3122 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3123 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3124 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3125
3126 @lisp
3127 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3128 @end lisp
3129
3130 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3131 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3132 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3133
3134 @example
3135 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3136 @end example
3137
3138 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3139 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3140 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3141 into the group parameters for the group.
3142
3143 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3144 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3145 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3146 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3147 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3148
3149 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3150 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3151 following is added to a group parameter
3152
3153 @lisp
3154 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3155 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3156 @end lisp
3157
3158 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3159 expired.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @vindex gnus-parameters
3164 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3165 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3166 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3167 For example:
3168
3169 @lisp
3170 (setq gnus-parameters
3171 '(("mail\\..*"
3172 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3173 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3174 (gnus-summary-line-format
3175 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3176 (gcc-self . t)
3177 (display . all))
3178
3179 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3180 (to-group . "\\1"))
3181
3182 ("mail\\.me"
3183 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3184
3185 ("list\\..*"
3186 (total-expire . t)
3187 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3188 @end lisp
3189
3190 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3191 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3192 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3193 override the first.
3194
3195 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3196 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3197
3198 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3199 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3200 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3201 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3202 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3203 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3204 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3205 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3206 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3207 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3208 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3209 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3210
3211 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3212 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3213 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3214 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3215 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3216 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3217 weekly news RSS feed
3218 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3219 @xref{RSS}.
3220
3221 @lisp
3222 (setq
3223 gnus-parameters
3224 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3225 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3226 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3227 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3228 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3229 ("nnrss.*debian"
3230 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3231 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3232 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3233 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3234 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3235 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3236 @end lisp
3237
3238
3239 @node Listing Groups
3240 @section Listing Groups
3241 @cindex group listing
3242
3243 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3244
3245 @table @kbd
3246
3247 @item l
3248 @itemx A s
3249 @kindex A s (Group)
3250 @kindex l (Group)
3251 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3252 List all groups that have unread articles
3253 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3254 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3255 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3256 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3257 groups).
3258
3259 @item L
3260 @itemx A u
3261 @kindex A u (Group)
3262 @kindex L (Group)
3263 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3264 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3265 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3266 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3267 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3268 unsubscribed groups).
3269
3270 @item A l
3271 @kindex A l (Group)
3272 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3273 List all unread groups on a specific level
3274 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3275 with no unread articles.
3276
3277 @item A k
3278 @kindex A k (Group)
3279 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3280 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3281 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3282 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3283 from the server.
3284
3285 @item A z
3286 @kindex A z (Group)
3287 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3288 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3289
3290 @item A m
3291 @kindex A m (Group)
3292 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3293 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3294 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3295
3296 @item A M
3297 @kindex A M (Group)
3298 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3299 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3300
3301 @item A A
3302 @kindex A A (Group)
3303 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3304 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3305 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3306 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3307 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3308 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3309 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3310 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3311
3312 @item A a
3313 @kindex A a (Group)
3314 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3315 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3316 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3317
3318 @item A d
3319 @kindex A d (Group)
3320 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3321 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3322 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3323
3324 @item A c
3325 @kindex A c (Group)
3326 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3327 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3328
3329 @item A ?
3330 @kindex A ? (Group)
3331 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3332 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3333
3334 @item A !
3335 @kindex A ! (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3337 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3338
3339 @item A /
3340 @kindex A / (Group)
3341 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3342 Further limit groups within the current selection
3343 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3344 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3345 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3346 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3347 articles.
3348
3349 @item A f
3350 @kindex A f (Group)
3351 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3352 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3353
3354 @item A p
3355 @kindex A p (Group)
3356 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3357 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3358
3359 @end table
3360
3361 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3362 @cindex visible group parameter
3363 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3364 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3365 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3366 get the same effect.
3367
3368 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3369 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3370 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3371 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3372 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3373
3374
3375 @node Sorting Groups
3376 @section Sorting Groups
3377 @cindex sorting groups
3378
3379 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3380 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3381 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3382 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3383 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3384 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3385 include:
3386
3387 @table @code
3388
3389 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3390 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3391 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3392
3393 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3394 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3395 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3396
3397 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3398 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3399 Sort by group level.
3400
3401 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3402 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3403 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3404
3405 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3406 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3407 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3408 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3409
3410 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3411 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3412 Sort by number of unread articles.
3413
3414 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3415 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3416 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3417
3418 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3419 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3420 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3421
3422
3423 @end table
3424
3425 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3426 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3427 the last one.
3428
3429
3430 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3431 some sorting criteria:
3432
3433 @table @kbd
3434 @item G S a
3435 @kindex G S a (Group)
3436 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3437 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3438 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3439
3440 @item G S u
3441 @kindex G S u (Group)
3442 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3443 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3444 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3445
3446 @item G S l
3447 @kindex G S l (Group)
3448 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3449 Sort the group buffer by group level
3450 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3451
3452 @item G S v
3453 @kindex G S v (Group)
3454 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3455 Sort the group buffer by group score
3456 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3457
3458 @item G S r
3459 @kindex G S r (Group)
3460 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3461 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3462 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3463
3464 @item G S m
3465 @kindex G S m (Group)
3466 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3467 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3468 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3469
3470 @item G S n
3471 @kindex G S n (Group)
3472 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3473 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3474 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3475
3476 @end table
3477
3478 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3479 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3480
3481 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3482 commands will sort in reverse order.
3483
3484 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3485
3486 @table @kbd
3487 @item G P a
3488 @kindex G P a (Group)
3489 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3490 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3491 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3492
3493 @item G P u
3494 @kindex G P u (Group)
3495 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3496 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3497 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3498
3499 @item G P l
3500 @kindex G P l (Group)
3501 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3502 Sort the groups by group level
3503 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3504
3505 @item G P v
3506 @kindex G P v (Group)
3507 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3508 Sort the groups by group score
3509 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3510
3511 @item G P r
3512 @kindex G P r (Group)
3513 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3514 Sort the groups by group rank
3515 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3516
3517 @item G P m
3518 @kindex G P m (Group)
3519 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3520 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3521 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3522
3523 @item G P n
3524 @kindex G P n (Group)
3525 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3526 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3527 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3528
3529 @item G P s
3530 @kindex G P s (Group)
3531 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3532 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3533
3534 @end table
3535
3536 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3537 move groups around.
3538
3539
3540 @node Group Maintenance
3541 @section Group Maintenance
3542 @cindex bogus groups
3543
3544 @table @kbd
3545 @item b
3546 @kindex b (Group)
3547 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3548 Find bogus groups and delete them
3549 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3550
3551 @item F
3552 @kindex F (Group)
3553 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3554 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3555 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3556 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3557 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3558 zombies.
3559
3560 @item C-c C-x
3561 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3562 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3563 @cindex expiring mail
3564 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3565 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3566 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3567 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3568
3569 @item C-c C-M-x
3570 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3571 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3572 @cindex expiring mail
3573 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3574 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3575
3576 @end table
3577
3578
3579 @node Browse Foreign Server
3580 @section Browse Foreign Server
3581 @cindex foreign servers
3582 @cindex browsing servers
3583
3584 @table @kbd
3585 @item B
3586 @kindex B (Group)
3587 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3588 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3589 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3590 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3591 @end table
3592
3593 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3594 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3595 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3596 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3597
3598 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3599
3600 @table @kbd
3601 @item n
3602 @kindex n (Browse)
3603 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3604 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3605
3606 @item p
3607 @kindex p (Browse)
3608 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3609 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3610
3611 @item SPACE
3612 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3613 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3614 Enter the current group and display the first article
3615 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3616
3617 @item RET
3618 @kindex RET (Browse)
3619 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3620 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3621
3622 @item u
3623 @kindex u (Browse)
3624 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3625 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3626 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3627 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3628 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3629 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3630 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3631
3632 @item l
3633 @itemx q
3634 @kindex q (Browse)
3635 @kindex l (Browse)
3636 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3637 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3638
3639 @item d
3640 @kindex d (Browse)
3641 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3642 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3643
3644 @item ?
3645 @kindex ? (Browse)
3646 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3647 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3648 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3649 @end table
3650
3651
3652 @node Exiting Gnus
3653 @section Exiting Gnus
3654 @cindex exiting Gnus
3655
3656 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3657
3658 @table @kbd
3659 @item z
3660 @kindex z (Group)
3661 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3662 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3663 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3664 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3665
3666 @item q
3667 @kindex q (Group)
3668 @findex gnus-group-exit
3669 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3670 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3671
3672 @item Q
3673 @kindex Q (Group)
3674 @findex gnus-group-quit
3675 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3676 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3677 @end table
3678
3679 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3680 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3681 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3682 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3683 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3684 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3685 exiting Gnus.
3686
3687 Note:
3688
3689 @quotation
3690 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3691 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3692 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3693 plastic chair.
3694 @end quotation
3695
3696
3697 @node Group Topics
3698 @section Group Topics
3699 @cindex topics
3700
3701 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3702 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3703 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3704 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3705 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3706 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3707
3708 @iftex
3709 @iflatex
3710 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3711 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3712 }
3713 @end iflatex
3714 @end iftex
3715
3716 Here's an example:
3717
3718 @example
3719 Gnus
3720 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3721 3: comp.emacs
3722 2: alt.religion.emacs
3723 Naughty Emacs
3724 452: alt.sex.emacs
3725 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3726 Misc
3727 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3728 13: comp.sources.unix
3729 @end example
3730
3731 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3732 @kindex t (Group)
3733 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3734 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3735 is a toggling command.)
3736
3737 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3738 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3739 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3740 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3741 Hot and bothered?
3742
3743 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3744 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3745 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3746
3747 @lisp
3748 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3749 @end lisp
3750
3751 @menu
3752 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3753 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3754 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3755 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3756 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3757 @end menu
3758
3759
3760 @node Topic Commands
3761 @subsection Topic Commands
3762 @cindex topic commands
3763
3764 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3765 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3766 definitions slightly.
3767
3768 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3769 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3770 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3771 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3772 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3773 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3774
3775 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3776 the way you like.
3777
3778 @table @kbd
3779
3780 @item T n
3781 @kindex T n (Topic)
3782 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3783 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3784 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3785
3786 @item T TAB
3787 @itemx TAB
3788 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3789 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3790 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3791 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3792 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3793 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3794
3795 @item M-TAB
3796 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3797 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3798 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3799 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3800
3801 @end table
3802
3803 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3804 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3805 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3806 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3807
3808 @table @kbd
3809
3810 @item C-k
3811 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3812 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3813 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3814 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3815
3816 @item C-y
3817 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3818 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3819 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3820 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3821 before all groups.
3822
3823 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3824 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3825 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3826 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3827 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3828
3829 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3830 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3831
3832 @end table
3833
3834 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3835 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3836 key.
3837
3838 @table @kbd
3839
3840 @item RET
3841 @kindex RET (Topic)
3842 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3843 @itemx SPACE
3844 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3845 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3846 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3847 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3848 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3849 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3850
3851 @end table
3852
3853 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3854
3855 @table @kbd
3856
3857 @item T m
3858 @kindex T m (Topic)
3859 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3860 Move the current group to some other topic
3861 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3862 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3863
3864 @item T j
3865 @kindex T j (Topic)
3866 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3867 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3868
3869 @item T c
3870 @kindex T c (Topic)
3871 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3872 Copy the current group to some other topic
3873 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3874 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3875
3876 @item T h
3877 @kindex T h (Topic)
3878 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3879 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3880 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3881
3882 @item T s
3883 @kindex T s (Topic)
3884 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3885 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3886 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3887
3888 @item T D
3889 @kindex T D (Topic)
3890 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3891 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3892 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3893 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3894 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3895 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3896 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3897 topic.
3898
3899 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3900 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3901
3902 @item T M
3903 @kindex T M (Topic)
3904 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3905 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3906 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3907
3908 @item T C
3909 @kindex T C (Topic)
3910 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3911 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3912 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3913
3914 @item T H
3915 @kindex T H (Topic)
3916 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3917 Toggle hiding empty topics
3918 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3919
3920 @item T #
3921 @kindex T # (Topic)
3922 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3923 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3924 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3925 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3926
3927 @item T M-#
3928 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3929 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3930 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3931 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3932 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3933
3934 @item C-c C-x
3935 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3936 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3937 @cindex expiring mail
3938 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3939 expiry process (if any)
3940 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3941
3942 @item T r
3943 @kindex T r (Topic)
3944 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3945 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3946
3947 @item T DEL
3948 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3949 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3950 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3951
3952 @item A T
3953 @kindex A T (Topic)
3954 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3955 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3956 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3957
3958 @item T M-n
3959 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3960 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3961 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3962
3963 @item T M-p
3964 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3965 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3966 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3967
3968 @item G p
3969 @kindex G p (Topic)
3970 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3971 @cindex group parameters
3972 @cindex topic parameters
3973 @cindex parameters
3974 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3975 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3976
3977 @end table
3978
3979
3980 @node Topic Variables
3981 @subsection Topic Variables
3982 @cindex topic variables
3983
3984 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3985 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3986
3987 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3988 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3989 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3990 Valid elements are:
3991
3992 @table @samp
3993 @item i
3994 Indentation.
3995 @item n
3996 Topic name.
3997 @item v
3998 Visibility.
3999 @item l
4000 Level.
4001 @item g
4002 Number of groups in the topic.
4003 @item a
4004 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4005 @item A
4006 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4007 @end table
4008
4009 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4010 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4011 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4012 The default is 2.
4013
4014 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4015 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4016
4017 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4018 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4019 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4020
4021
4022 @node Topic Sorting
4023 @subsection Topic Sorting
4024 @cindex topic sorting
4025
4026 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4027 commands:
4028
4029
4030 @table @kbd
4031 @item T S a
4032 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4033 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4034 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4035 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4036
4037 @item T S u
4038 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4039 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4040 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4041 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4042
4043 @item T S l
4044 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4045 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4046 Sort the current topic by group level
4047 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4048
4049 @item T S v
4050 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4051 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4052 Sort the current topic by group score
4053 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4054
4055 @item T S r
4056 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4057 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4058 Sort the current topic by group rank
4059 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4060
4061 @item T S m
4062 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4063 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4064 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4065 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4066
4067 @item T S e
4068 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4069 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4070 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4071 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4072
4073 @item T S s
4074 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4075 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4076 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4077 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4078 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4079
4080 @end table
4081
4082 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4083 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4084 sorting.
4085
4086
4087 @node Topic Topology
4088 @subsection Topic Topology
4089 @cindex topic topology
4090 @cindex topology
4091
4092 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4093
4094 @example
4095 @group
4096 Gnus
4097 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4098 3: comp.emacs
4099 2: alt.religion.emacs
4100 Naughty Emacs
4101 452: alt.sex.emacs
4102 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4103 Misc
4104 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4105 13: comp.sources.unix
4106 @end group
4107 @end example
4108
4109 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4110 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4111 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4112 follows:
4113
4114 @lisp
4115 (("Gnus" visible)
4116 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4117 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4118 (("Misc" visible)))
4119 @end lisp
4120
4121 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4122 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4123 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4124 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4125 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4126 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4127
4128 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4129 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4130 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4131
4132
4133 @node Topic Parameters
4134 @subsection Topic Parameters
4135 @cindex topic parameters
4136
4137 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4138 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4139 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4140 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4141 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4142
4143 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4144 parameters:
4145
4146 @table @code
4147 @item subscribe
4148 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4149 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4150 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4151 topic.
4152
4153 @item subscribe-level
4154 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4155 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4156 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4157
4158 @end table
4159
4160 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4161 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4162 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4163 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4164
4165 @example
4166 @group
4167 Gnus
4168 Emacs
4169 3: comp.emacs
4170 2: alt.religion.emacs
4171 452: alt.sex.emacs
4172 Relief
4173 452: alt.sex.emacs
4174 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4175 Misc
4176 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4177 13: comp.sources.unix
4178 452: alt.sex.emacs
4179 @end group
4180 @end example
4181
4182 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4183 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4184 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4185 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4186 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4187 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4188
4189 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4190 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4191 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4192 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4193 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4194
4195 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4196 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4197 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4198 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4199 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4200 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4201 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4202 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4203
4204
4205 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4206 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4207 @cindex non-ascii group names
4208
4209 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4210 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4211 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4212 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4213 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4214 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4215 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4216 back end.
4217
4218 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4219 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4220 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4221 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4222 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4223 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4224 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4225 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4226
4227 @table @code
4228 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4229 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4230 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4231 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4232 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4233
4234 @lisp
4235 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4236 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4237 @end lisp
4238
4239 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4240 ones specified for the same groups with the
4241 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4242
4243 A select method can be very long, like:
4244
4245 @lisp
4246 (nntp "gmane"
4247 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4248 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4249 (nntp-open-connection-function
4250 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4251 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4252 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4253 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4254 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4255 @end lisp
4256
4257 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4258 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4259 the server name.
4260
4261 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4262 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4263 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4264 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4265 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4266 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4267
4268 @lisp
4269 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4270 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4271 (".*" . utf-8)))
4272 @end lisp
4273
4274 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4275 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4276 @end table
4277
4278 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4279 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4280 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4281 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4282 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4283 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4284
4285 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4286 names:
4287
4288 @table @code
4289 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4290 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4291 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4292 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4293 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4294 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4295
4296 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4297 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4298 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4299 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4300 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4301
4302 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4303 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4304 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4305 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4306 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4307 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4308
4309 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4310 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4311 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4312 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4313
4314 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4315 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4316 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4317 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4318
4319 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4320 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4321 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4322 typical case where you have to customize
4323 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4324 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4325 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4326 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4327 @end table
4328
4329 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4330 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4331 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4332 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4333
4334
4335 @node Misc Group Stuff
4336 @section Misc Group Stuff
4337
4338 @menu
4339 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4340 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4341 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4342 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4343 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4344 @end menu
4345
4346 @table @kbd
4347
4348 @item v
4349 @kindex v (Group)
4350 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4351 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4352 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4353
4354 @lisp
4355 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4356 (lambda ()
4357 (interactive)
4358 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4359 @end lisp
4360
4361 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4362 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4363
4364 @item ^
4365 @kindex ^ (Group)
4366 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4367 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4368 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4369
4370 @item a
4371 @kindex a (Group)
4372 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4373 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4374 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4375 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4376 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4377 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4378 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4379
4380 @item m
4381 @kindex m (Group)
4382 @findex gnus-group-mail
4383 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4384 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4385 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4386 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4387
4388 @item i
4389 @kindex i (Group)
4390 @findex gnus-group-news
4391 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4392 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4393 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4394
4395 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4396 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4397 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4398 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4399 for this to work though.
4400
4401 @item G z
4402 @kindex G z (Group)
4403 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4404
4405 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4406 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4407 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4408 count.
4409
4410 @end table
4411
4412 Variables for the group buffer:
4413
4414 @table @code
4415
4416 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4417 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4418 is called after the group buffer has been
4419 created.
4420
4421 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4422 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4423 is called after the group buffer is
4424 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4425 unnatural way.
4426
4427 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4428 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4429 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4430 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4431
4432 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4433 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4434 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4435 whether they are empty or not.
4436
4437 @end table
4438
4439 @node Scanning New Messages
4440 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4441 @cindex new messages
4442 @cindex scanning new news
4443
4444 @table @kbd
4445
4446 @item g
4447 @kindex g (Group)
4448 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4449 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4450 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4451 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4452 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4453 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4454 back end(s).
4455
4456 @item M-g
4457 @kindex M-g (Group)
4458 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4459 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4460 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4461 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4462 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4463 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4464 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4465
4466 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4467 @cindex activating groups
4468 @item C-c M-g
4469 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4470 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4471
4472 @item R
4473 @kindex R (Group)
4474 @cindex restarting
4475 @findex gnus-group-restart
4476 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4477 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4478 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4479
4480 @end table
4481
4482 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4483 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4484
4485 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4486 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4487 news.
4488
4489
4490 @node Group Information
4491 @subsection Group Information
4492 @cindex group information
4493 @cindex information on groups
4494
4495 @table @kbd
4496
4497
4498 @item H d
4499 @itemx C-c C-d
4500 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4501 @kindex H d (Group)
4502 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4503 @cindex describing groups
4504 @cindex group description
4505 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4506 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4507 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4508
4509 @item M-d
4510 @kindex M-d (Group)
4511 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4512 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4513 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4514
4515 @item H v
4516 @itemx V
4517 @kindex V (Group)
4518 @kindex H v (Group)
4519 @cindex version
4520 @findex gnus-version
4521 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4522
4523 @item ?
4524 @kindex ? (Group)
4525 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4526 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4527
4528 @item C-c C-i
4529 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4530 @cindex info
4531 @cindex manual
4532 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4533 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4534 @end table
4535
4536
4537 @node Group Timestamp
4538 @subsection Group Timestamp
4539 @cindex timestamps
4540 @cindex group timestamps
4541
4542 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4543 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4544 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4545
4546 @lisp
4547 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4548 @end lisp
4549
4550 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4551
4552 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4553 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4554
4555 @lisp
4556 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4557 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4558 @end lisp
4559
4560 This will result in lines looking like:
4561
4562 @example
4563 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4564 0: custom 19961002T012713
4565 @end example
4566
4567 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4568 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4569 something like:
4570
4571 @lisp
4572 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4573 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4574 @end lisp
4575
4576 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4577 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4578 trick:
4579
4580 @lisp
4581 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4582 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4583 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4584 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4585 (if time
4586 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4587 "")))
4588 @end lisp
4589
4590 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4591 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4592 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4593 either.
4594
4595
4596 @node File Commands
4597 @subsection File Commands
4598 @cindex file commands
4599
4600 @table @kbd
4601
4602 @item r
4603 @kindex r (Group)
4604 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4605 @vindex gnus-init-file
4606 @cindex reading init file
4607 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4608 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4609
4610 @item s
4611 @kindex s (Group)
4612 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4613 @cindex saving .newsrc
4614 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4615 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4616 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4617
4618 @c @item Z
4619 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4620 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4621 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4622
4623 @end table
4624
4625
4626 @node Sieve Commands
4627 @subsection Sieve Commands
4628 @cindex group sieve commands
4629
4630 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4631 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4632 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4633 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4634 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4635
4636 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4637 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4638 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4639 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4640 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4641 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4642 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4643 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4644 regenerate the Sieve script.
4645
4646 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4647 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4648 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4649 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4650 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4651 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4652 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4653 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4654 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4655 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4656
4657 @example
4658 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4659 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4660 stop;
4661 @}
4662 @end example
4663
4664 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4665
4666 @table @kbd
4667
4668 @item D g
4669 @kindex D g (Group)
4670 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4671 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4672 @cindex generating sieve script
4673 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4674 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4675
4676 @item D u
4677 @kindex D u (Group)
4678 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4679 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4680 @cindex updating sieve script
4681 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4682 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4683 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4684
4685 @end table
4686
4687
4688 @node Summary Buffer
4689 @chapter Summary Buffer
4690 @cindex summary buffer
4691
4692 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4693 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4694
4695 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4696 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4697
4698 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4699
4700 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4701 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4702 available in Emacs.
4703
4704 @kindex v (Summary)
4705 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4706 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4707 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4708 @lisp
4709 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4710 @end lisp
4711
4712 @menu
4713 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4714 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4715 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4716 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4717 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4718 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4719 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4720 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4721 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4722 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4723 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4724 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4725 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4726 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4727 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4728 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4729 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4730 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4731 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4732 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4733 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4734 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4735 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4736 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4737 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4738 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4739 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4740 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4741 or reselecting the current group.
4742 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4743 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4744 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4745 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4746 @end menu
4747
4748
4749 @node Summary Buffer Format
4750 @section Summary Buffer Format
4751 @cindex summary buffer format
4752
4753 @iftex
4754 @iflatex
4755 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4756 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4757 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4758 }
4759 @end iflatex
4760 @end iftex
4761
4762 @menu
4763 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4764 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4765 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4766 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4767 @end menu
4768
4769 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4770 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4771 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4772 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4773 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4774 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4775 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4776 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4777 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4778 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4779 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4780
4781 @lisp
4782 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4783 'mail-extract-address-components)
4784 @end lisp
4785
4786 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4787 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4788 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4789 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4790
4791
4792 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4793 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4794
4795 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4796 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4797 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4798 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4799 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4800
4801 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4802 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4803 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4804 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4805 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4806 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4807
4808 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4809
4810 The following format specification characters and extended format
4811 specification(s) are understood:
4812
4813 @table @samp
4814 @item N
4815 Article number.
4816 @item S
4817 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4818 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4819 @item s
4820 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4821 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4822 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4823 @item F
4824 Full @code{From} header.
4825 @item n
4826 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4827 @item f
4828 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4829 From Newsgroups}).
4830 @item a
4831 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4832 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4833 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4834 may be more thorough.
4835 @item A
4836 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4837 the @code{a} spec.
4838 @item L
4839 Number of lines in the article.
4840 @item c
4841 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4842 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4843 @item k
4844 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4845 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4846 @item I
4847 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4848 @item B
4849 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4850 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4851
4852 @example
4853 >
4854 +->
4855 | +->
4856 | | \->
4857 | | \->
4858 | \->
4859 +->
4860 \->
4861 @end example
4862
4863 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4864 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4865 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4866 line-drawing glyphs.
4867 @table @code
4868 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4869 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4870 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4871 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4872
4873 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4874 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4875 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4876 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4877
4878 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4879 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4880 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4881 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4882
4883 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4884 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4885 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4886
4887 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4888 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4889 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4890
4891 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4892 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4893 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4894
4895 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4896 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4897 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4898
4899 @end table
4900
4901 @item T
4902 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4903 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4904 @item [
4905 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4906 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4907 @item ]
4908 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4909 for adopted articles.
4910 @item >
4911 One space for each thread level.
4912 @item <
4913 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4914 @item U
4915 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4916
4917 @item R
4918 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4919 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4920 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4921
4922 @item i
4923 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4924 @item z
4925 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4926 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4927 default level. If the difference between
4928 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4929 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4930 @item V
4931 Total thread score.
4932 @item x
4933 @code{Xref}.
4934 @item D
4935 @code{Date}.
4936 @item d
4937 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4938 @item o
4939 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4940 @item M
4941 @code{Message-ID}.
4942 @item r
4943 @code{References}.
4944 @item t
4945 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4946 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4947 @item e
4948 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4949 article has any children.
4950 @item P
4951 The line number.
4952 @item O
4953 Download mark.
4954 @item *
4955 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4956 @item &user-date;
4957 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4958 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4959 @item u
4960 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4961 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4962 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4963 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4964 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4965 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4966 @end table
4967
4968 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4969 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4970 There can only be one such area.
4971
4972 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4973 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4974 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4975 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4976 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4977 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4978
4979 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4980 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4981
4982 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4983
4984
4985 @node To From Newsgroups
4986 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4987 @cindex To
4988 @cindex Newsgroups
4989
4990 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4991 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4992 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4993 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4994 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4995
4996 @enumerate
4997 @item
4998 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4999 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5000 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5001 instance:
5002
5003 @lisp
5004 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5005 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5006 @end lisp
5007
5008 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5009 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5010
5011 @item
5012 @findex gnus-extra-header
5013 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5014 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5015 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5016
5017 @example
5018 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5019 @end example
5020
5021 @item
5022 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5023 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5024 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5025 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5026 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5027 headers are used instead.
5028
5029 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5030 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5031 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5032 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5033 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5034 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5035
5036 @end enumerate
5037
5038 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5039 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5040 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5041 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5042 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5043 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5044 regeneration.
5045
5046 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5047 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5048 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5049 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5050
5051 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5052 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5053
5054 @lisp
5055 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5056 '(To Newsgroups))
5057 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5058 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5059 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5060 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5061 "Your Name Here")
5062 @end lisp
5063
5064 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5065 to fit your needs.)
5066
5067 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5068 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5069 support:
5070
5071 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5072 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5073 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5074
5075 @example
5076 Newsgroups:full
5077 @end example
5078
5079 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5080 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5081
5082
5083 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5084 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5085
5086 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5087 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5088 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5089 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5090
5091 Here are the elements you can play with:
5092
5093 @table @samp
5094 @item G
5095 Group name.
5096 @item p
5097 Unprefixed group name.
5098 @item A
5099 Current article number.
5100 @item z
5101 Current article score.
5102 @item V
5103 Gnus version.
5104 @item U
5105 Number of unread articles in this group.
5106 @item e
5107 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5108 summary buffer.
5109 @item Z
5110 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5111 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5112 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5113 and no unselected ones.
5114 @item g
5115 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5116 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5117 @item S
5118 Subject of the current article.
5119 @item u
5120 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5121 @item s
5122 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5123 @item d
5124 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5125 @item t
5126 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5127 @item r
5128 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5129 @item E
5130 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5131 @end table
5132
5133
5134 @node Summary Highlighting
5135 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5136
5137 @table @code
5138
5139 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5140 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5141 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5142 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5143 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5144
5145 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5146 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5147 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5148 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5149
5150 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5151 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5152 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5153 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5154
5155 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5156 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5157 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5158 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5159 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5160 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5161 to something like
5162 @lisp
5163 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5164 ((> score default) . bold))
5165 @end lisp
5166 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5167 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5168 @end table
5169
5170
5171 @node Summary Maneuvering
5172 @section Summary Maneuvering
5173 @cindex summary movement
5174
5175 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5176 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5177
5178 None of these commands select articles.
5179
5180 @table @kbd
5181 @item G M-n
5182 @itemx M-n
5183 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5184 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5185 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5186 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5187 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5188
5189 @item G M-p
5190 @itemx M-p
5191 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5192 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5193 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5194 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5195 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5196
5197 @item G g
5198 @kindex G g (Summary)
5199 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5200 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5201 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5202 @end table
5203
5204 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5205 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5206 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5207 to the group buffer.
5208
5209 Variables related to summary movement:
5210
5211 @table @code
5212
5213 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5214 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5215 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5216 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5217 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5218 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5219 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5220 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5221 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5222 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5223 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5224 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5225 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5226 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5227
5228 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5229 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5230 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5231 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5232 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5233 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5234 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5235
5236 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5237
5238 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5239 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5240 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5241 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5242 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5243
5244 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5245 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5246 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5247 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5248 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5249 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5250 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5251 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5252 threads.
5253
5254 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5255 the given number of lines from the top.
5256
5257 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5258 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5259 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5260 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5261
5262 @end table
5263
5264
5265 @node Choosing Articles
5266 @section Choosing Articles
5267 @cindex selecting articles
5268
5269 @menu
5270 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5271 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5272 @end menu
5273
5274
5275 @node Choosing Commands
5276 @subsection Choosing Commands
5277
5278 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5279 and they all select and display an article.
5280
5281 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5282 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5283
5284 @table @kbd
5285 @item SPACE
5286 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5287 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5288 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5289 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5290
5291 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5292 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5293 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5294
5295 @item G n
5296 @itemx n
5297 @kindex n (Summary)
5298 @kindex G n (Summary)
5299 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5300 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5301 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5302
5303 @item G p
5304 @itemx p
5305 @kindex p (Summary)
5306 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5307 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5308 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5309
5310 @item G N
5311 @itemx N
5312 @kindex N (Summary)
5313 @kindex G N (Summary)
5314 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5315 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5316
5317 @item G P
5318 @itemx P
5319 @kindex P (Summary)
5320 @kindex G P (Summary)
5321 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5322 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5323
5324 @item G C-n
5325 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5326 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5327 Go to the next article with the same subject
5328 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5329
5330 @item G C-p
5331 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5332 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5333 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5334 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5335
5336 @item G f
5337 @itemx .
5338 @kindex G f (Summary)
5339 @kindex . (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5341 Go to the first unread article
5342 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5343
5344 @item G b
5345 @itemx ,
5346 @kindex G b (Summary)
5347 @kindex , (Summary)
5348 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5349 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5350 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5351 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5352
5353 @item G l
5354 @itemx l
5355 @kindex l (Summary)
5356 @kindex G l (Summary)
5357 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5358 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5359
5360 @item G o
5361 @kindex G o (Summary)
5362 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5363 @cindex history
5364 @cindex article history
5365 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5366 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5367 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5368 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5369 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5370 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5371
5372 @item G j
5373 @itemx j
5374 @kindex j (Summary)
5375 @kindex G j (Summary)
5376 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5377 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5378 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5379
5380 @end table
5381
5382
5383 @node Choosing Variables
5384 @subsection Choosing Variables
5385
5386 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5387
5388 @table @code
5389 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5390 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5391 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5392 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5393 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5394 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5395
5396 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5397 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5398 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5399 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5400 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5401 hook will do so.
5402
5403 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5404 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5405 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5406 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5407 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5408 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5409 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5410 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5411 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5412 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5413 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5414 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5415 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5416 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5417
5418 @end table
5419
5420
5421 @node Paging the Article
5422 @section Scrolling the Article
5423 @cindex article scrolling
5424
5425 @table @kbd
5426
5427 @item SPACE
5428 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5429 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5430 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5431 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5432 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5433
5434 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5435 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5436 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5437 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5438 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5439 what is considered uninteresting with
5440 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5441 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5442
5443 @item DEL
5444 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5445 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5446 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5447
5448 @item RET
5449 @kindex RET (Summary)
5450 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5451 Scroll the current article one line forward
5452 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5453
5454 @item M-RET
5455 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5456 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5457 Scroll the current article one line backward
5458 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5459
5460 @item A g
5461 @itemx g
5462 @kindex A g (Summary)
5463 @kindex g (Summary)
5464 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5465 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5466 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5467 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5468 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5469 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5470 treatment functions.
5471
5472 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5473 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5474 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5475 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5476
5477 @lisp
5478 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5479 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5480 (2 . big5)))
5481 @end lisp
5482
5483 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5484
5485 @item A <
5486 @itemx <
5487 @kindex < (Summary)
5488 @kindex A < (Summary)
5489 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5490 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5491 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5492
5493 @item A >
5494 @itemx >
5495 @kindex > (Summary)
5496 @kindex A > (Summary)
5497 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5498 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5499
5500 @item A s
5501 @itemx s
5502 @kindex A s (Summary)
5503 @kindex s (Summary)
5504 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5505 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5506 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5507
5508 @item h
5509 @kindex h (Summary)
5510 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5511 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5512
5513 @end table
5514
5515
5516 @node Reply Followup and Post
5517 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5518
5519 @menu
5520 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5521 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5522 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5523 * Canceling and Superseding::
5524 @end menu
5525
5526
5527 @node Summary Mail Commands
5528 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5529 @cindex mail
5530 @cindex composing mail
5531
5532 Commands for composing a mail message:
5533
5534 @table @kbd
5535
5536 @item S r
5537 @itemx r
5538 @kindex S r (Summary)
5539 @kindex r (Summary)
5540 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5541 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5542 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5543 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5544 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5545
5546 @item S R
5547 @itemx R
5548 @kindex R (Summary)
5549 @kindex S R (Summary)
5550 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5551 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5552 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5553 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5554 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5555
5556 @item S w
5557 @kindex S w (Summary)
5558 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5559 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5560 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5561 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5562 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5563 present, that's used instead.
5564
5565 @item S W
5566 @kindex S W (Summary)
5567 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5568 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5569 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5570 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5571 first article to determine the recipients.
5572
5573 @item S L
5574 @kindex S L (Summary)
5575 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5576 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5577 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5578 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5579
5580 @item S v
5581 @kindex S v (Summary)
5582 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5583 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5584 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5585 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5586 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5587 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5588
5589 @item S V
5590 @kindex S V (Summary)
5591 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5592 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5593 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5594 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5595
5596 @item S B r
5597 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5598 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5599 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5600 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5601 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5602 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5603 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5604 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5605
5606 @item S B R
5607 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5608 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5609 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5610 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5611 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5612
5613 @item S o m
5614 @itemx C-c C-f
5615 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5616 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5617 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5618 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5619 Forward the current article to some other person
5620 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5621 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5622 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5623 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5624 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5625 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5626 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5627 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5628 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5629 section.
5630
5631 @item S m
5632 @itemx m
5633 @kindex m (Summary)
5634 @kindex S m (Summary)
5635 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5636 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5637 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5638 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5639 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5640
5641 @item S i
5642 @kindex S i (Summary)
5643 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5644 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5645 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5646 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5647
5648 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5649 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5650 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5651 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5652 for this to work though.
5653
5654 @item S D b
5655 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5656 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5657 @cindex bouncing mail
5658 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5659 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5660 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5661 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5662 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5663 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5664 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5665 very well fail, though.
5666
5667 @item S D r
5668 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5669 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5670 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5671 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5672 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5673 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5674 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5675 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5676 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5677 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5678
5679 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5680 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5681 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5682 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5683 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5684
5685 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5686 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5687
5688 @item S D e
5689 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5690 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5691
5692 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5693 if it were a new message before resending.
5694
5695 @item S O m
5696 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5697 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5698 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5699 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5700 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5701
5702 @item S M-c
5703 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5704 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5705 @cindex crossposting
5706 @cindex excessive crossposting
5707 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5708 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5709
5710 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5711 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5712 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5713 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5714 command understands the process/prefix convention
5715 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5716
5717 @end table
5718
5719 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5720 Manual}, for more information.
5721
5722
5723 @node Summary Post Commands
5724 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5725 @cindex post
5726 @cindex composing news
5727
5728 Commands for posting a news article:
5729
5730 @table @kbd
5731 @item S p
5732 @itemx a
5733 @kindex a (Summary)
5734 @kindex S p (Summary)
5735 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5736 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5737 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5738 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5739 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5740
5741 @item S f
5742 @itemx f
5743 @kindex f (Summary)
5744 @kindex S f (Summary)
5745 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5746 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5747 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5748
5749 @item S F
5750 @itemx F
5751 @kindex S F (Summary)
5752 @kindex F (Summary)
5753 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5754 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5755 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5756 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5757 process/prefix convention.
5758
5759 @item S n
5760 @kindex S n (Summary)
5761 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5762 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5763 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5764
5765 @item S N
5766 @kindex S N (Summary)
5767 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5768 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5769 message through mail and include the original message
5770 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5771 the process/prefix convention.
5772
5773 @item S o p
5774 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5775 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5776 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5777 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5778 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5779 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5780 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5781 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5782 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5783 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5784 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5785 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5786 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5787
5788 @item S O p
5789 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5790 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5791 @cindex digests
5792 @cindex making digests
5793 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5794 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5795 process/prefix convention.
5796
5797 @item S u
5798 @kindex S u (Summary)
5799 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5800 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5801 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5802 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5803 @end table
5804
5805 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5806 Manual}, for more information.
5807
5808
5809 @node Summary Message Commands
5810 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5811
5812 @table @kbd
5813 @item S y
5814 @kindex S y (Summary)
5815 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5816 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5817 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5818 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5819 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5820
5821 @end table
5822
5823
5824 @node Canceling and Superseding
5825 @subsection Canceling Articles
5826 @cindex canceling articles
5827 @cindex superseding articles
5828
5829 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5830 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5831
5832 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5833
5834 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5835 @kindex C (Summary)
5836 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5837 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5838 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5839 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5840 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5841 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5842
5843 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5844 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5845 question.
5846
5847 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5848 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5849 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5850
5851 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5852 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5853 message, Message Manual}).
5854
5855 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5856 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5857 your original article.
5858
5859 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5860 @kindex S (Summary)
5861 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5862 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5863 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5864 usual way.
5865
5866 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5867 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5868 have posted almost the same article twice.
5869
5870 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5871 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5872 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5873 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5874 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5875 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5876 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5877 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5878 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5879 canceled/superseded.
5880
5881 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5882
5883 @node Delayed Articles
5884 @section Delayed Articles
5885 @cindex delayed sending
5886 @cindex send delayed
5887
5888 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5889 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5890 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5891 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5892
5893 @lisp
5894 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5895 @end lisp
5896
5897 @findex gnus-delay-article
5898 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5899 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5900 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5901 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5902
5903 @itemize @bullet
5904 @item
5905 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5906 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5907 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5908 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5909
5910 @item
5911 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5912 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5913 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5914
5915 @item
5916 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5917 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5918 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5919 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5920 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5921 that means a time tomorrow.
5922 @end itemize
5923
5924 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5925 couple of variables:
5926
5927 @table @code
5928 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5929 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5930 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5931 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5932
5933 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5934 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5935 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5936 formats described above.
5937
5938 @item gnus-delay-group
5939 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5940 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5941 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5942 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5943
5944 @item gnus-delay-header
5945 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5946 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5947 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5948 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5949 @end table
5950
5951 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5952 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5953 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5954 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5955 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5956
5957 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5958 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5959 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5960 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5961 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5962 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5963 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5964
5965 @table @code
5966 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5967 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5968 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5969 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5970 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5971 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5972 argument is ignored.
5973
5974 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5975 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5976 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5977 @end table
5978
5979 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5980 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5981 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5982 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5983 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5984
5985
5986 @node Marking Articles
5987 @section Marking Articles
5988 @cindex article marking
5989 @cindex article ticking
5990 @cindex marks
5991
5992 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5993
5994 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5995 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5996 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5997
5998 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5999
6000 @ifinfo
6001 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6002 @end ifinfo
6003
6004 @menu
6005 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6006 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6007 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6008 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6009 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6010 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6011 @end menu
6012
6013
6014 @node Unread Articles
6015 @subsection Unread Articles
6016
6017 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6018 other.
6019
6020 @table @samp
6021 @item !
6022 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6023 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6024
6025 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6026 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6027 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6028 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6029 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6030 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6031 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6032
6033 @item ?
6034 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6035 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6036
6037 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6038 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6039 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6040 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6041 messages.
6042
6043 @item SPACE
6044 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6045 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6046
6047 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6048 @end table
6049
6050
6051 @node Read Articles
6052 @subsection Read Articles
6053 @cindex expirable mark
6054
6055 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6056
6057 @table @samp
6058
6059 @item r
6060 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6061 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6062 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6063
6064 @item R
6065 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6066 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6067
6068 @item O
6069 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6070 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6071 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6072
6073 @item K
6074 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6075 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6076
6077 @item X
6078 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6079 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6080
6081 @item Y
6082 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6083 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6084
6085 @item C
6086 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6087 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6088
6089 @item G
6090 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6091 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6092
6093 @item Q
6094 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6095 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6096 Threading}.
6097
6098 @item M
6099 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6100 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6101 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6102
6103 @end table
6104
6105 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6106 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6107
6108 One more special mark, though:
6109
6110 @table @samp
6111 @item E
6112 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6113 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6114
6115 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6116 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6117 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6118 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6119 any time.
6120 @end table
6121
6122
6123 @node Other Marks
6124 @subsection Other Marks
6125 @cindex process mark
6126 @cindex bookmarks
6127
6128 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6129 read or not.
6130
6131 @itemize @bullet
6132
6133 @item
6134 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6135 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6136 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6137 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6138 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6139
6140 @item
6141 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6142 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6143 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6144 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6145
6146 @item
6147 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6148 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6149 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6150
6151 @item
6152 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6153 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6154 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6155
6156 @item
6157 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6158 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6159 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6160 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6161
6162 @item
6163 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6164 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6165 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6166
6167 @item
6168 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6169 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6170 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6171 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6172 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6173 use.)
6174
6175 @item
6176 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6177 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6178 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6179 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6180 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6181 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6182
6183 @item
6184 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6185 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6186 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6187 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6188 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6189 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6190 use.)
6191
6192 @item
6193 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6194 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6195 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6196 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6197 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6198
6199 @item
6200 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6201 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6202 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6203 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6204 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6205 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6206
6207 @end itemize
6208
6209 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6210 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6211 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6212
6213 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6214 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6215 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6216
6217
6218 @node Setting Marks
6219 @subsection Setting Marks
6220 @cindex setting marks
6221
6222 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6223
6224 @table @kbd
6225 @item M c
6226 @itemx M-u
6227 @kindex M c (Summary)
6228 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6229 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6230 @cindex mark as unread
6231 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6232 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6233 article as unread.
6234
6235 @item M t
6236 @itemx !
6237 @kindex ! (Summary)
6238 @kindex M t (Summary)
6239 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6240 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6241 @xref{Article Caching}.
6242
6243 @item M ?
6244 @itemx ?
6245 @kindex ? (Summary)
6246 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6247 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6248 Mark the current article as dormant
6249 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6250
6251 @item M d
6252 @itemx d
6253 @kindex M d (Summary)
6254 @kindex d (Summary)
6255 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6256 Mark the current article as read
6257 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6258
6259 @item D
6260 @kindex D (Summary)
6261 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6262 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6263 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6264
6265 @item M k
6266 @itemx k
6267 @kindex k (Summary)
6268 @kindex M k (Summary)
6269 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6270 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6271 and then select the next unread article
6272 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6273
6274 @item M K
6275 @itemx C-k
6276 @kindex M K (Summary)
6277 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6278 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6279 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6280 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6281
6282 @item M C
6283 @kindex M C (Summary)
6284 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6285 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6286 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6287
6288 @item M C-c
6289 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6290 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6291 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6292 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6293
6294 @item M H
6295 @kindex M H (Summary)
6296 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6297 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6298 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6299
6300 @item M h
6301 @kindex M h (Summary)
6302 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6303 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6304 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6305
6306 @item C-w
6307 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6308 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6309 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6310 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6311
6312 @item M V k
6313 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6314 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6315 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6316 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6317
6318 @item M e
6319 @itemx E
6320 @kindex M e (Summary)
6321 @kindex E (Summary)
6322 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6323 Mark the current article as expirable
6324 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6325
6326 @item M b
6327 @kindex M b (Summary)
6328 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6329 Set a bookmark in the current article
6330 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6331
6332 @item M B
6333 @kindex M B (Summary)
6334 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6335 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6336 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6337
6338 @item M V c
6339 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6340 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6341 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6342 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6343
6344 @item M V u
6345 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6346 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6347 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6348 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6349
6350 @item M V m
6351 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6352 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6353 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6354 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6355 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6356 @end table
6357
6358 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6359 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6360 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6361 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6362 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6363 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6364 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6365 The default is @code{t}.
6366
6367
6368 @node Generic Marking Commands
6369 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6370
6371 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6372 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6373 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6374 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6375 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6376 well.
6377
6378 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6379 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6380 command should do.
6381
6382 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6383 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6384 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6385 to list in this manual.
6386
6387 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6388 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6389 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6390 article, you could say something like:
6391
6392 @lisp
6393 @group
6394 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6395 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6396 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6397 @end group
6398 @end lisp
6399
6400 @noindent
6401 or
6402
6403 @lisp
6404 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6405 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6406 @end lisp
6407
6408
6409 @node Setting Process Marks
6410 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6411 @cindex setting process marks
6412
6413 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6414 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6415 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6416 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6417 articles into the cache. For more information,
6418 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6419
6420 @table @kbd
6421
6422 @item M P p
6423 @itemx #
6424 @kindex # (Summary)
6425 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6426 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6427 Mark the current article with the process mark
6428 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6429 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6430
6431 @item M P u
6432 @itemx M-#
6433 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6434 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6435 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6436 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6437
6438 @item M P U
6439 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6440 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6441 Remove the process mark from all articles
6442 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6443
6444 @item M P i
6445 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6446 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6447 Invert the list of process marked articles
6448 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6449
6450 @item M P R
6451 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6452 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6453 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6454 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6455
6456 @item M P G
6457 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6458 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6459 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6460 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6461
6462 @item M P r
6463 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6464 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6465 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6466
6467 @item M P g
6468 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6470 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6471
6472 @item M P t
6473 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6474 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6475 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6476 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6477
6478 @item M P T
6479 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6480 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6481 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6482 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6483
6484 @item M P v
6485 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6486 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6487 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6488 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6489
6490 @item M P s
6491 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6492 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6493 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6494
6495 @item M P S
6496 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6497 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6498 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6499 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6500
6501 @item M P a
6502 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6503 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6504 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6505
6506 @item M P b
6507 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6508 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6509 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6510 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6511
6512 @item M P k
6513 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6514 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6515 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6516 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6517
6518 @item M P y
6519 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6520 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6521 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6522 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6523
6524 @item M P w
6525 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6526 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6527 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6528 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6529
6530 @end table
6531
6532 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6533 set process marks based on article body contents.
6534
6535
6536 @node Limiting
6537 @section Limiting
6538 @cindex limiting
6539
6540 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6541 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6542 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6543 buffer.
6544
6545 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6546 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6547 articles.
6548
6549 @table @kbd
6550
6551 @item / /
6552 @itemx / s
6553 @kindex / / (Summary)
6554 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6555 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6556 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6557 matching articles.
6558
6559 @item / a
6560 @kindex / a (Summary)
6561 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6562 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6563 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6564 matching articles.
6565
6566 @item / R
6567 @kindex / R (Summary)
6568 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6569 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6570 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6571 matching articles.
6572
6573 @item / A
6574 @kindex / A (Summary)
6575 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6576 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6577 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6578 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6579
6580 @item / S
6581 @kindex / S (Summary)
6582 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6583 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6584 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6585 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6586
6587 @item / x
6588 @kindex / x (Summary)
6589 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6590 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6591 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6592 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6593 matching articles.
6594
6595 @item / u
6596 @itemx x
6597 @kindex / u (Summary)
6598 @kindex x (Summary)
6599 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6600 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6601 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6602 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6603 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6604
6605 @item / m
6606 @kindex / m (Summary)
6607 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6608 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6609 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6610
6611 @item / t
6612 @kindex / t (Summary)
6613 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6614 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6615 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6616 articles younger than that number of days.
6617
6618 @item / n
6619 @kindex / n (Summary)
6620 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6621 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6622 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6623 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6624
6625 @item / w
6626 @kindex / w (Summary)
6627 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6628 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6629 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6630 the stack.
6631
6632 @item / .
6633 @kindex / . (Summary)
6634 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6635 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6636 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6637
6638 @item / v
6639 @kindex / v (Summary)
6640 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6641 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6642 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6643
6644 @item / p
6645 @kindex / p (Summary)
6646 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6647 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6648 group parameter predicate
6649 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6650 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6651
6652 @item / r
6653 @kindex / r (Summary)
6654 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6655 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6656 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6657 replied articles.
6658
6659 @item / E
6660 @itemx M S
6661 @kindex M S (Summary)
6662 @kindex / E (Summary)
6663 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6664 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6665 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6666
6667 @item / D
6668 @kindex / D (Summary)
6669 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6670 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6671 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6672
6673 @item / *
6674 @kindex / * (Summary)
6675 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6676 Include all cached articles in the limit
6677 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6678
6679 @item / d
6680 @kindex / d (Summary)
6681 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6682 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6683 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6684
6685 @item / M
6686 @kindex / M (Summary)
6687 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6688 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6689
6690 @item / T
6691 @kindex / T (Summary)
6692 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6693 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6694
6695 @item / c
6696 @kindex / c (Summary)
6697 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6698 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6699 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6700
6701 @item / C
6702 @kindex / C (Summary)
6703 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6704 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6705 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6706 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6707
6708 @item / b
6709 @kindex / b (Summary)
6710 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6711 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6712 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6713 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6714 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6715
6716 @item / h
6717 @kindex / h (Summary)
6718 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6719 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6720 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6721
6722 @end table
6723
6724
6725 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6726 prefix as well.
6727
6728 @table @kbd
6729 @item / N
6730 @kindex / N (Summary)
6731 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6732 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6733 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6734
6735 @item / o
6736 @kindex / o (Summary)
6737 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6738 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6739 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6740
6741 @end table
6742
6743
6744 @node Threading
6745 @section Threading
6746 @cindex threading
6747 @cindex article threading
6748
6749 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6750 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6751 hierarchical fashion.
6752
6753 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6754 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6755 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6756 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6757 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6758 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6759 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6760
6761 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6762
6763 @table @dfn
6764 @item root
6765 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6766
6767 @item thread
6768 A tree-like article structure.
6769
6770 @item sub-thread
6771 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6772
6773 @item loose threads
6774 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6775 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6776 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6777 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6778 called loose threads.
6779
6780 @item thread gathering
6781 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6782
6783 @item sparse threads
6784 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6785 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6786
6787 @end table
6788
6789
6790 @menu
6791 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6792 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6793 @end menu
6794
6795
6796 @node Customizing Threading
6797 @subsection Customizing Threading
6798 @cindex customizing threading
6799
6800 @menu
6801 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6802 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6803 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6804 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6805 @end menu
6806
6807
6808 @node Loose Threads
6809 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6810 @cindex <
6811 @cindex >
6812 @cindex loose threads
6813
6814 @table @code
6815 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6816 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6817 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6818 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6819 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6820 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6821
6822 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6823 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6824 There are four possible values:
6825
6826 @iftex
6827 @iflatex
6828 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6829 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6830 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6831 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6832 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6833 }
6834 @end iflatex
6835 @end iftex
6836
6837 @cindex adopting articles
6838
6839 @table @code
6840
6841 @item adopt
6842 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6843 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6844 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6845 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6846
6847 @item dummy
6848 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6849 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6850 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6851 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6852 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6853 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6854 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6855 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6856 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6857 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6858
6859 @item empty
6860 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6861 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6862 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6863 Buffer Format}).)
6864
6865 @item none
6866 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6867 display them after one another.
6868
6869 @item nil
6870 Don't gather loose threads.
6871 @end table
6872
6873 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6874 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6875 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6876 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6877 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6878 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6879 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6880 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6881 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6882 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6883 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6884
6885 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6886 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6887 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6888 Matching}).
6889
6890 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6891 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6892 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6893 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6894 simplification is used.
6895
6896 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6897 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6898 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6899 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6900
6901 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6902 @lisp
6903 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6904 (concat
6905 "\\`\\[?\\("
6906 (mapconcat
6907 'identity
6908 '("looking"
6909 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6910 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6911 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6912 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6913 ;; ...
6914 )
6915 "\\|")
6916 "\\)\\s *\\("
6917 (mapconcat 'identity
6918 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6919 "\\|")
6920 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6921 @end lisp
6922
6923 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6924 subjects.
6925
6926 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6927 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6928 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6929 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6930 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6931 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6932
6933 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6934
6935 @table @code
6936 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6937 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6938 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6939
6940 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6941 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6942 Simplify fuzzily.
6943
6944 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6945 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6946 Remove excessive whitespace.
6947
6948 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6949 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6950 Remove all whitespace.
6951 @end table
6952
6953 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6954
6955
6956 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6957 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6958 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6959 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6960 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6961 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6962 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6963 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6964
6965 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6966 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6967 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6968 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6969 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6970 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6971 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6972 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6973 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6974 cholera:
6975
6976 @table @code
6977 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6978 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6979 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6980 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6981
6982 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6983 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6984 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6985 @end table
6986
6987 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6988 something like:
6989
6990 @lisp
6991 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6992 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6993 @end lisp
6994
6995 @end table
6996
6997
6998 @node Filling In Threads
6999 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
7000
7001 @table @code
7002 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7003 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7004 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7005 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7006 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7007 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7008 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7009 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7010 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7011 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7012 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7013 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7014 do about that.
7015
7016 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7017 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7018 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7019
7020 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7021
7022 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7023 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7024 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7025 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7026 slow summary generation.
7027
7028 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7029 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7030 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7031 newsgroups.
7032
7033 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7034 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7035 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7036 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7037 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7038 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7039 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7040 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7041 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7042 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7043 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7044 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7045 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7046 @code{nil} by default.
7047
7048 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7049 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7050 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7051 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7052 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7053 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7054 web-based groups.
7055
7056 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7057 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7058 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7059
7060 @end table
7061
7062
7063 @node More Threading
7064 @subsubsection More Threading
7065
7066 @table @code
7067 @item gnus-show-threads
7068 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7069 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7070 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7071 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7072 slower and more awkward.
7073
7074 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7075 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7076 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7077 generated.
7078
7079 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7080 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7081 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7082
7083 Here's an example:
7084
7085 @lisp
7086 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7087 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7088 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7089 @end lisp
7090
7091 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7092 unread, but you get my drift.)
7093
7094
7095 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7096 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7097 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7098 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7099 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7100 threads are expunged.
7101
7102 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7103 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7104 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7105 will be hidden.
7106
7107 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7108 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7109 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7110 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7111 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7112 result in a new thread.
7113
7114 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7115 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7116 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7117 The default is 4.
7118
7119 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7120 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7121 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7122 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7123 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7124 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7125 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7126 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7127 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7128 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7129 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7130
7131 @end table
7132
7133
7134 @node Low-Level Threading
7135 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7136
7137 @table @code
7138
7139 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7140 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7141 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7142
7143 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7144 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7145 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7146 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7147 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7148 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7149 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7150 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7151 meaningful. Here's one example:
7152
7153 @lisp
7154 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7155
7156 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7157 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7158 (when (string-match
7159 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7160 (mail-header-set-id
7161 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7162 header))))
7163 @end lisp
7164
7165 @end table
7166
7167
7168 @node Thread Commands
7169 @subsection Thread Commands
7170 @cindex thread commands
7171
7172 @table @kbd
7173
7174 @item T k
7175 @itemx C-M-k
7176 @kindex T k (Summary)
7177 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7178 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7179 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7180 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7181 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7182 articles instead.
7183
7184 @item T l
7185 @itemx C-M-l
7186 @kindex T l (Summary)
7187 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7188 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7189 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7190 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7191
7192 @item T i
7193 @kindex T i (Summary)
7194 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7195 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7196 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7197
7198 @item T #
7199 @kindex T # (Summary)
7200 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7201 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7202 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7203
7204 @item T M-#
7205 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7206 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7207 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7208 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7209
7210 @item T T
7211 @kindex T T (Summary)
7212 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7213 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7214
7215 @item T s
7216 @kindex T s (Summary)
7217 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7218 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7219 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7220
7221 @item T h
7222 @kindex T h (Summary)
7223 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7224 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7225
7226 @item T S
7227 @kindex T S (Summary)
7228 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7229 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7230
7231 @item T H
7232 @kindex T H (Summary)
7233 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7234 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7235
7236 @item T t
7237 @kindex T t (Summary)
7238 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7239 Re-thread the current article's thread
7240 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7241 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7242
7243 @item T ^
7244 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7245 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7246 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7247 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7248
7249 @item T M-^
7250 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7251 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7252 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7253 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7254
7255 @end table
7256
7257 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7258 understand the numeric prefix.
7259
7260 @table @kbd
7261
7262 @item T n
7263 @kindex T n (Summary)
7264 @itemx C-M-f
7265 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7266 @itemx M-down
7267 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7268 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7269 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7270
7271 @item T p
7272 @kindex T p (Summary)
7273 @itemx C-M-b
7274 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7275 @itemx M-up
7276 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7277 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7278 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7279
7280 @item T d
7281 @kindex T d (Summary)
7282 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7283 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7284
7285 @item T u
7286 @kindex T u (Summary)
7287 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7288 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7289
7290 @item T o
7291 @kindex T o (Summary)
7292 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7293 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7294 @end table
7295
7296 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7297 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7298 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7299 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7300 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7301 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7302 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7303 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7304 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7305 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7306 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7307 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7308 Matching}).
7309
7310
7311 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7312 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7313
7314 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7315 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7316 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7317 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7318 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7319 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7320 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7321 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7322 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7323 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7324 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7325 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7326 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7327 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7328 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7329
7330 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7331 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7332 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7333 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7334 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7335 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7336 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7337 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7338 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7339 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7340
7341 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7342 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7343 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7344 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7345 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7346
7347 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7348 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7349 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7350 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7351 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7352 ascending article order.
7353
7354 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7355 by number, you could do something like:
7356
7357 @lisp
7358 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7359 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7360 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7361 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7362 @end lisp
7363
7364 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7365 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7366 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7367 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7368 which the articles arrived.
7369
7370 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7371 say something like:
7372
7373 @lisp
7374 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7375 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7376 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7377 @end lisp
7378
7379 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7380 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7381 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7382 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7383 tickles your fancy.
7384
7385 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7386 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7387 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7388 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7389 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7390 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7391 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7392 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7393 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7394 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7395 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7396 variable. It is very similar to the
7397 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7398 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7399 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7400 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7401 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7402 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7403 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7404
7405 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7406 say something like:
7407
7408 @lisp
7409 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7410 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7411 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7412 @end lisp
7413
7414 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7415 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7416
7417
7418 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7419 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7420 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7421 @cindex article pre-fetch
7422 @cindex pre-fetch
7423
7424 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7425 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7426 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7427 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7428 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7429
7430 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7431 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7432
7433 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7434 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7435 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7436 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7437 connection is blocked.
7438
7439 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7440 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7441 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7442 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7443
7444 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7445 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7446 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7447 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7448 extra connection.
7449
7450 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7451 you really want to.
7452
7453 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7454 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7455 happen automatically.
7456
7457 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7458 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7459 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7460 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7461 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7462 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7463 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7464
7465 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7466 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7467 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7468 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7469 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7470 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7471 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7472 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7473 article data structure as the only parameter.
7474
7475 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7476 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7477
7478 @lisp
7479 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7480 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7481 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7482 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7483 100)))
7484
7485 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7486 @end lisp
7487
7488 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7489 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7490 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7491
7492 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7493 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7494 After an article has been prefetched, this
7495 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7496 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7497 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7498 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7499 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7500 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7501
7502 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7503 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7504 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7505 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7506
7507 @table @code
7508 @item read
7509 Remove articles when they are read.
7510
7511 @item exit
7512 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7513 @end table
7514
7515 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7516
7517 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7518 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7519 @c from the next group.
7520
7521
7522 @node Article Caching
7523 @section Article Caching
7524 @cindex article caching
7525 @cindex caching
7526
7527 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7528 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7529 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7530 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7531 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7532
7533 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7534
7535 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7536 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7537 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7538 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7539 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7540 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7541 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7542 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7543
7544 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7545 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7546 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7547 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7548 as dormant, and don't worry.
7549
7550 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7551
7552 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7553 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7554 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7555 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7556 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7557 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7558 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7559 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7560 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7561 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7562
7563 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7564 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7565 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7566 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7567 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7568 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7569 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7570 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7571 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7572 not then be downloaded by this command.
7573
7574 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7575 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7576 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7577 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7578 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7579 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7580
7581 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7582 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7583 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7584 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7585 variables, the group is not cached.
7586
7587 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7588 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7589 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7590 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7591 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7592 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7593 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7594 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7595 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7596 file.
7597
7598 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7599 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7600 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7601 where, isn't that cool?
7602
7603 @node Persistent Articles
7604 @section Persistent Articles
7605 @cindex persistent articles
7606
7607 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7608 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7609 useful in my opinion.
7610
7611 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7612 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7613 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7614 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7615 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7616 the expiry going on at the news server.
7617
7618 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7619 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7620 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7621
7622 @table @kbd
7623
7624 @item *
7625 @kindex * (Summary)
7626 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7627 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7628
7629 @item M-*
7630 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7631 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7632 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7633 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7634 article.
7635 @end table
7636
7637 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7638
7639 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7640 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7641 interested in persistent articles:
7642
7643 @lisp
7644 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7645 @end lisp
7646
7647 @node Sticky Articles
7648 @section Sticky Articles
7649 @cindex sticky articles
7650
7651 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7652 according to the value of the variable
7653 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7654 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7655 has its own article buffer.
7656
7657 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7658 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7659 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7660 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7661
7662 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7663 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7664 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7665
7666 @table @kbd
7667 @item A S
7668 @kindex A S (Summary)
7669 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7670 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7671 name for this sticky article buffer.
7672 @end table
7673
7674 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7675
7676 @table @kbd
7677 @item q
7678 @kindex q (Article)
7679 @findex bury-buffer
7680 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7681
7682 @item k
7683 @kindex k (Article)
7684 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7685 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7686 @end table
7687
7688 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7689
7690 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7691 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7692 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7693 @end defun
7694
7695 @node Article Backlog
7696 @section Article Backlog
7697 @cindex backlog
7698 @cindex article backlog
7699
7700 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7701 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7702 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7703 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7704 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7705 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7706 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7707 increase memory usage some.
7708
7709 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7710 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7711 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7712 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7713 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7714 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7715 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7716
7717 The default value is 20.
7718
7719
7720 @node Saving Articles
7721 @section Saving Articles
7722 @cindex saving articles
7723
7724 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7725 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7726 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7727 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7728 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7729
7730 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7731 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7732 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7733
7734 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7735 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7736 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7737
7738 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7739 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7740 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7741 deleted before saving.
7742
7743 @table @kbd
7744
7745 @item O o
7746 @itemx o
7747 @kindex O o (Summary)
7748 @kindex o (Summary)
7749 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7750 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7751 Save the current article using the default article saver
7752 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7753
7754 @item O m
7755 @kindex O m (Summary)
7756 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7757 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7758 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7759
7760 @item O r
7761 @kindex O r (Summary)
7762 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7763 Save the current article in Rmail format
7764 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7765 Babyl in older versions.
7766
7767 @item O f
7768 @kindex O f (Summary)
7769 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7770 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7771 Save the current article in plain file format
7772 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7773
7774 @item O F
7775 @kindex O F (Summary)
7776 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7777 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7778 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7779
7780 @item O b
7781 @kindex O b (Summary)
7782 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7783 Save the current article body in plain file format
7784 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7785
7786 @item O h
7787 @kindex O h (Summary)
7788 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7789 Save the current article in mh folder format
7790 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7791
7792 @item O v
7793 @kindex O v (Summary)
7794 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7795 Save the current article in a VM folder
7796 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7797
7798 @item O p
7799 @itemx |
7800 @kindex O p (Summary)
7801 @kindex | (Summary)
7802 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7803 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7804 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7805 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7806 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7807 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7808 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7809 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7810 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7811 @code{nil}).
7812
7813 @item O P
7814 @kindex O P (Summary)
7815 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7816 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7817 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7818 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7819 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7820 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7821 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7822
7823 @end table
7824
7825 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7826 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7827 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7828 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7829 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7830 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7831 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7832 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7833 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7834 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7835 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7836 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7837 files.
7838
7839
7840 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7841 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7842 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7843 functions below, or you can create your own.
7844
7845 @table @code
7846
7847 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7848 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7849 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7850 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7851 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7852 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7853 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7854 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7855 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7856 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7857 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7858
7859 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7860 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7861 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7862 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7863 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7864 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7865
7866 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7867 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7868 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7869 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7870 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7871 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7872 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7873
7874 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7875 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7876 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7877 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7878 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7879 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7880
7881 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7882 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7883 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7884 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7885 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7886
7887 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7888 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7889 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7890 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7891 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7892 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7893
7894 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7895 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7896 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7897 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7898 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7899 @cindex rcvstore
7900 @cindex MH folders
7901 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7902 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7903 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7904 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7905 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7906
7907 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7908 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7909 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7910 reader to use this setting.
7911
7912 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7913 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7914 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7915 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7916
7917 @itemize @bullet
7918 @item a string@*
7919 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7920 @item @code{nil}@*
7921 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7922 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7923 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7924 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7925 last used for saving.
7926 @end itemize
7927
7928 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7929 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7930 headers will be piped.
7931 @end table
7932
7933 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7934
7935 @table @code
7936 @item :decode
7937 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7938 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7939 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7940 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7941 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7942 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7943
7944 @item :function
7945 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7946 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7947 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7948 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7949 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7950 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7951
7952 @item :headers
7953 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7954 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7955 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7956 headers should be saved.
7957 @end table
7958
7959 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7960 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7961 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7962 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7963 default.
7964
7965 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7966 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7967 available functions that generate names:
7968
7969 @table @code
7970
7971 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7972 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7973 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7974
7975 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7976 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7977 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7978
7979 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7980 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7981 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7982
7983 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7984 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7985 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7986
7987 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7988 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7989 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7990 @end table
7991
7992 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7993 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7994 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7995 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7996 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7997 like:
7998
7999 @lisp
8000 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8001 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8002 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8003 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8004 @end lisp
8005
8006 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8007 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8008 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8009 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8010 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8011 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8012 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8013 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8014 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8015
8016 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8017 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8018 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8019 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8020
8021 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8022 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8023 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8024 name.
8025
8026 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8027 lots of mail groups called things like
8028 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8029 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8030 following will do just that:
8031
8032 @lisp
8033 (defun my-save-name (group)
8034 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8035 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8036
8037 (setq gnus-split-methods
8038 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8039 (my-save-name)))
8040 @end lisp
8041
8042
8043 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8044 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8045 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8046 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8047 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8048 all the files in the top level directory
8049 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8050 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8051 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8052 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8053
8054 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8055 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8056 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8057 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8058 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8059 for kill files.
8060
8061 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8062 a spool, you could
8063
8064 @lisp
8065 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8066 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8067 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8068 @end lisp
8069
8070 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8071 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8072 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8073 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8074
8075
8076 @node Decoding Articles
8077 @section Decoding Articles
8078 @cindex decoding articles
8079
8080 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8081 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8082
8083 @menu
8084 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8085 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8086 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8087 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8088 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8089 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8090 @end menu
8091
8092 @cindex series
8093 @cindex article series
8094 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8095 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8096 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8097 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8098 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8099
8100 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8101 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8102 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8103
8104 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8105 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8106 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8107
8108 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8109 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8110 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8111
8112
8113 @node Uuencoded Articles
8114 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8115 @cindex uudecode
8116 @cindex uuencoded articles
8117
8118 @table @kbd
8119
8120 @item X u
8121 @kindex X u (Summary)
8122 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8123 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8124 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8125
8126 @item X U
8127 @kindex X U (Summary)
8128 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8129 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8130 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8131
8132 @item X v u
8133 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8134 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8135 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8136
8137 @item X v U
8138 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8139 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8140 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8141 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8142
8143 @end table
8144
8145 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8146 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8147 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8148 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8149 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8150
8151 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8152 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8153 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8154 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8155 @kbd{X u}.
8156
8157 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8158 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8159 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8160 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8161 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8162 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8163 off.
8164
8165
8166 @node Shell Archives
8167 @subsection Shell Archives
8168 @cindex unshar
8169 @cindex shell archives
8170 @cindex shared articles
8171
8172 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8173 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8174 some commands to deal with these:
8175
8176 @table @kbd
8177
8178 @item X s
8179 @kindex X s (Summary)
8180 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8181 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8182
8183 @item X S
8184 @kindex X S (Summary)
8185 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8186 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8187
8188 @item X v s
8189 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8190 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8191 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8192
8193 @item X v S
8194 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8195 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8196 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8197 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8198 @end table
8199
8200
8201 @node PostScript Files
8202 @subsection PostScript Files
8203 @cindex PostScript
8204
8205 @table @kbd
8206
8207 @item X p
8208 @kindex X p (Summary)
8209 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8210 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8211
8212 @item X P
8213 @kindex X P (Summary)
8214 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8215 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8216 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8217
8218 @item X v p
8219 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8220 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8221 View the current PostScript series
8222 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8223
8224 @item X v P
8225 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8226 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8227 View and save the current PostScript series
8228 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8229 @end table
8230
8231
8232 @node Other Files
8233 @subsection Other Files
8234
8235 @table @kbd
8236 @item X o
8237 @kindex X o (Summary)
8238 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8239 Save the current series
8240 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8241
8242 @item X b
8243 @kindex X b (Summary)
8244 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8245 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8246 doesn't really work yet.
8247
8248 @item X Y
8249 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8250 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8251 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8252 @end table
8253
8254
8255 @node Decoding Variables
8256 @subsection Decoding Variables
8257
8258 Adjective, not verb.
8259
8260 @menu
8261 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8262 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8263 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8264 @end menu
8265
8266
8267 @node Rule Variables
8268 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8269 @cindex rule variables
8270
8271 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8272 variables are of the form
8273
8274 @lisp
8275 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8276 '(regexp2 command2)
8277 ...)
8278 @end lisp
8279
8280 @table @code
8281
8282 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8283 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8284 @cindex sox
8285 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8286 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8287 say something like:
8288 @lisp
8289 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8290 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8291 @end lisp
8292
8293 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8294 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8295 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8296 user and default view rules.
8297
8298 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8299 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8300 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8301 archives.
8302 @end table
8303
8304
8305 @node Other Decode Variables
8306 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8307
8308 @table @code
8309 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8310
8311 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8312 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8313 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8314 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8315 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8316
8317 @table @code
8318
8319 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8320 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8321 View the file.
8322
8323 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8324 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8325 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8326 @end table
8327
8328 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8329 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8330 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8331 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8332 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8333 time.
8334
8335 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8336 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8337 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8338
8339 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8340 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8341 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8342 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8343 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8344 kludgy.
8345
8346 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8347 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8348 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8349
8350 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8351 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8352 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8353 looking for files to display.
8354
8355 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8356 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8357 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8358 after viewing it.
8359
8360 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8361 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8362 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8363 rules.
8364
8365 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8366 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8367 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8368 unpacking commands.
8369
8370 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8371 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8372 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8373 from articles.
8374
8375 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8376 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8377 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8378 decoded articles as unread.
8379
8380 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8381 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8382 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8383 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8384
8385 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8386 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8387 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8388
8389 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8390 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8391 @cindex metamail
8392 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8393 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8394 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8395 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8396
8397 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8398 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8399 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8400 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8401 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8402 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8403 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8404 simply dropped them.
8405
8406 @end table
8407
8408
8409 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8410 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8411
8412 @table @code
8413
8414 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8415 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8416 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8417 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8418 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8419 for you when you post the article.
8420
8421 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8422 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8423 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8424 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8425
8426 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8427 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8428 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8429 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8430 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8431 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8432 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8433
8434 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8435 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8436 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8437 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8438 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8439 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8440 Default is @code{t}.
8441
8442 @end table
8443
8444
8445 @node Viewing Files
8446 @subsection Viewing Files
8447 @cindex viewing files
8448 @cindex pseudo-articles
8449
8450 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8451 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8452 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8453 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8454 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8455 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8456 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8457
8458 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8459 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8460 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8461 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8462
8463 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8464 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8465 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8466
8467 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8468 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8469 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8470 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8471 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8472
8473 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8474 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8475 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8476 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8477 a list of parameters to that command.
8478
8479 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8480 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8481 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8482
8483 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8484 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8485 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8486
8487
8488 @node Article Treatment
8489 @section Article Treatment
8490
8491 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8492 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8493 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8494 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8495 these articles easier.
8496
8497 @menu
8498 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8499 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8500 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8501 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8502 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8503 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8504 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8505 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8506 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8507 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8508 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8509 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8510 @end menu
8511
8512
8513 @node Article Highlighting
8514 @subsection Article Highlighting
8515 @cindex highlighting
8516
8517 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8518 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8519
8520 @table @kbd
8521
8522 @item W H a
8523 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8524 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8525 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8526 Do much highlighting of the current article
8527 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8528 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8529
8530 @item W H h
8531 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8532 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8533 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8534 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8535 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8536 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8537 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8538 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8539 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8540 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8541 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8542 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8543
8544 @item W H c
8545 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8546 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8547 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8548
8549 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8550
8551 @table @code
8552 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8553
8554 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8555 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8556 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8557
8558 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8559 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8560 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8561
8562 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8563 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8564 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8565 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8566 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8567 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8568
8569 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8570 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8571 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8572
8573 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8574 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8575 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8576
8577 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8578 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8579 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8580 that it's a citation.
8581
8582 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8583 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8584 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8585
8586 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8587 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8588 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8589
8590 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8591 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8592 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8593 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8594
8595 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8596 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8597 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8598 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8599 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8600 is @code{t}.
8601
8602 @end table
8603
8604
8605 @item W H s
8606 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8607 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8608 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8609 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8610 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8611 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8612 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8613 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8614 default.
8615
8616 @end table
8617
8618 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8619
8620
8621 @node Article Fontisizing
8622 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8623 @cindex emphasis
8624 @cindex article emphasis
8625
8626 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8627 @kindex W e (Summary)
8628 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8629 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8630 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8631 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8632
8633 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8634 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8635 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8636 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8637 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8638 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8639 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8640 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8641 highlighting.
8642
8643 @lisp
8644 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8645 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8646 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8647 @end lisp
8648
8649 @cindex slash
8650 @cindex asterisk
8651 @cindex underline
8652 @cindex /
8653 @cindex *
8654
8655 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8656 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8657 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8658 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8659 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8660 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8661 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8662 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8663 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8664 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8665 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8666 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8667 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8668
8669 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8670 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8671 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8672 say something like:
8673
8674 @lisp
8675 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8676 @end lisp
8677
8678 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8679
8680 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8681 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8682 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8683 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8684
8685 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8686
8687
8688 @node Article Hiding
8689 @subsection Article Hiding
8690 @cindex article hiding
8691
8692 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8693 too much cruft in most articles.
8694
8695 @table @kbd
8696
8697 @item W W a
8698 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8699 @findex gnus-article-hide
8700 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8701 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8702 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8703
8704 @item W W h
8705 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8706 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8707 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8708 Headers}.
8709
8710 @item W W b
8711 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8712 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8713 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8714 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8715
8716 @item W W s
8717 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8718 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8719 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8720 Signature}.
8721
8722 @item W W l
8723 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8724 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8725 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8726 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8727 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8728 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8729 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8730 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8731
8732 @table @code
8733
8734 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8735 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8736 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8737 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8738
8739 @end table
8740
8741 @item W W P
8742 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8743 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8744 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8745 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8746
8747 @item W W B
8748 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8749 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8750 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8751 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8752 @cindex banner
8753 @cindex OneList
8754 @cindex stripping advertisements
8755 @cindex advertisements
8756 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8757 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8758 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8759 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8760 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8761 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8762 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8763 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8764 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8765 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8766 used.
8767
8768 For instance:
8769
8770 @lisp
8771 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8772 ((googleGroups .
8773 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8774 @end lisp
8775
8776 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8777 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8778 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8779
8780 @table @code
8781
8782 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8783 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8784 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8785 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8786 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8787 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8788 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8789 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8790 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8791 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8792 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8793
8794 @lisp
8795 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8796 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8797 @end lisp
8798
8799 @end table
8800
8801 @item W W c
8802 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8803 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8804 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8805 customizing the hiding:
8806
8807 @table @code
8808
8809 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8810 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8811 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8812 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8813 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8814 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8815 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8816 specs are valid:
8817
8818 @table @samp
8819 @item b
8820 Starting point of the hidden text.
8821 @item e
8822 Ending point of the hidden text.
8823 @item l
8824 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8825 @item n
8826 Number of lines of hidden text.
8827 @end table
8828
8829 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8830 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8831 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8832 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8833 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8834
8835 @end table
8836
8837 @item W W C-c
8838 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8839 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8840
8841 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8842 following two variables:
8843
8844 @table @code
8845 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8846 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8847 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8848 50), hide the cited text.
8849
8850 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8851 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8852 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8853 is hidden.
8854 @end table
8855
8856 @item W W C
8857 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8858 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8859 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8860 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8861 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8862 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8863
8864 @end table
8865
8866 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8867 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8868 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8869
8870 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8871 citation customization.
8872
8873 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8874 automatically.
8875
8876
8877 @node Article Washing
8878 @subsection Article Washing
8879 @cindex washing
8880 @cindex article washing
8881
8882 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8883 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8884
8885 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8886 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8887 Cleaner, perhaps.
8888
8889 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8890 articles by default.
8891
8892 @table @kbd
8893
8894 @item C-u g
8895 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8896 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8897 the server.
8898
8899 @item g
8900 Force redisplaying of the current article
8901 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8902 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8903 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8904 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8905
8906 @item W l
8907 @kindex W l (Summary)
8908 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8909 Remove page breaks from the current article
8910 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8911 delimiters.
8912
8913 @item W r
8914 @kindex W r (Summary)
8915 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8916 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8917 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8918 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8919 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8920 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8921
8922 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8923 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8924 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8925 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8926
8927 @item W m
8928 @kindex W m (Summary)
8929 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8930 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8931
8932 @item W i
8933 @kindex W i (Summary)
8934 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8935 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8936 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8937 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8938 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8939 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8940 to work.
8941
8942 @item W t
8943 @item t
8944 @kindex W t (Summary)
8945 @kindex t (Summary)
8946 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8947 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8948 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8949
8950 @item W v
8951 @kindex W v (Summary)
8952 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8953 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8954 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8955
8956 @item W o
8957 @kindex W o (Summary)
8958 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8959 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8960
8961 @item W d
8962 @kindex W d (Summary)
8963 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8964 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8965 @cindex Smartquotes
8966 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8967 @cindex Latin 1
8968 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8969 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8970 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8971 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8972 interactively.
8973
8974 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8975 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8976 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8977 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8978
8979 @item W U
8980 @kindex W U (Summary)
8981 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8982 @cindex Unicode
8983 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8984 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8985 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8986 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8987 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8988 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8989
8990 @item W Y f
8991 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8992 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8993 @cindex Outlook Express
8994 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8995 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8996 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8997
8998 @item W Y u
8999 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
9000 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9001 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9002 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9003 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9004 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9005 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9006 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9007 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9008 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9009
9010 @item W Y a
9011 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9012 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9013 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9014 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9015
9016 @item W Y c
9017 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9018 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9019 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9020 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9021
9022 @item W w
9023 @kindex W w (Summary)
9024 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9025 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9026
9027 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9028 when filling.
9029
9030 @item W Q
9031 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9032 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9033 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9034
9035 @item W C
9036 @kindex W C (Summary)
9037 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9038 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9039 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9040
9041 @item W c
9042 @kindex W c (Summary)
9043 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9044 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9045 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9046 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9047 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9048
9049 @item W q
9050 @kindex W q (Summary)
9051 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9052 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9053 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9054 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9055 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9056 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9057 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9058 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9059 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9060
9061 @item W 6
9062 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9063 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9064 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9065 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9066 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9067 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9068 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9069 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9070
9071 @item W Z
9072 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9073 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9074 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9075 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9076 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9077
9078 @item W A
9079 @kindex W A (Summary)
9080 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9081 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9082 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9083 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9084 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9085
9086 @item W u
9087 @kindex W u (Summary)
9088 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9089 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9090 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9091 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9092 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9093
9094 @item W h
9095 @kindex W h (Summary)
9096 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9097 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9098 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9099 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9100
9101 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9102 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9103 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9104
9105 The default is to use the function specified by
9106 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9107 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9108 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9109
9110 @table @code
9111 @item shr
9112 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9113
9114 @item gnus-w3m
9115 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9116
9117 @item w3
9118 Use Emacs/W3.
9119
9120 @item w3m
9121 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9122
9123 @item w3m-standalone
9124 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9125
9126 @item links
9127 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9128
9129 @item lynx
9130 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9131
9132 @item html2text
9133 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9134
9135 @end table
9136
9137 @item W b
9138 @kindex W b (Summary)
9139 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9140 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9141 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9142
9143 @item W B
9144 @kindex W B (Summary)
9145 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9146 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9147 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9148
9149 @item W p
9150 @kindex W p (Summary)
9151 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9152 Verify a signed control message
9153 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9154 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9155 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9156 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9157 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9158 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9159
9160 @item W s
9161 @kindex W s (Summary)
9162 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9163 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9164 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9165 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9166
9167 @item W a
9168 @kindex W a (Summary)
9169 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9170 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9171 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9172
9173 @item W E l
9174 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9175 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9176 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9177 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9178
9179 @item W E m
9180 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9181 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9182 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9183 lines with a single empty line.
9184 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9185
9186 @item W E t
9187 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9188 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9189 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9190 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9191
9192 @item W E a
9193 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9194 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9195 Do all the three commands above
9196 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9197
9198 @item W E A
9199 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9200 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9201 Remove all blank lines
9202 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9203
9204 @item W E s
9205 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9206 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9207 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9208 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9209
9210 @item W E e
9211 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9212 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9213 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9214 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9215
9216 @end table
9217
9218 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9219
9220
9221 @node Article Header
9222 @subsection Article Header
9223
9224 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9225
9226 @table @kbd
9227
9228 @item W G u
9229 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9230 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9231 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9232
9233 @item W G n
9234 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9235 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9236 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9237 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9238
9239 @item W G f
9240 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9241 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9242 Fold all the message headers
9243 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9244
9245 @item W E w
9246 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9247 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9248 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9249 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9250
9251 @end table
9252
9253
9254 @node Article Buttons
9255 @subsection Article Buttons
9256 @cindex buttons
9257
9258 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9259 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9260 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9261 button on these references.
9262
9263 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9264 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9265 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9266 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9267 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9268
9269 @table @code
9270
9271 @item gnus-button-alist
9272 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9273 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9274
9275 @lisp
9276 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9277 @end lisp
9278
9279 @table @var
9280
9281 @item regexp
9282 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9283 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9284 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9285 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9286 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9287
9288 @item button-par
9289 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9290 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9291 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9292
9293 @item use-p
9294 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9295 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9296 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9297 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9298 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9299
9300 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9301
9302 @item function
9303 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9304
9305 @item data-par
9306 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9307 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9308
9309 @end table
9310
9311 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9312
9313 @lisp
9314 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9315 @end lisp
9316
9317 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9318 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9319 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9320 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9321 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9322
9323 @lisp
9324 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9325 @end lisp
9326
9327 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9328 @end table
9329
9330 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9331
9332 @table @code
9333 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9334 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9335
9336 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9337
9338 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9339 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9340 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9341 default values of the variables above.
9342
9343 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9344
9345 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9346 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9347 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9348 argument with a string naming the man page.
9349
9350 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9351
9352 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9353 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9354 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9355
9356 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9357 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9358 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9359 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9360 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9361 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9362 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9363 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9364 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9365 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9366 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9367 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9368
9369 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9370 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9371 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9372 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9373 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9374 string is invalid.
9375
9376 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9377 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9378 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9379 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9380
9381 @c Misc stuff
9382
9383 @item gnus-article-button-face
9384 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9385 Face used on buttons.
9386
9387 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9388 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9389 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9390
9391 @end table
9392
9393 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9394
9395
9396 @node Article Button Levels
9397 @subsection Article button levels
9398 @cindex button levels
9399 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9400 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9401 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9402 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9403 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9404 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9405 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9406 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9407
9408 @lisp
9409 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9410 (setq gnus-parameters
9411 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9412 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9413 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9414 @end lisp
9415
9416 @table @code
9417
9418 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9419 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9420 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9421 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9422 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9423 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9424
9425 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9426 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9427 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9428 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9429 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9430 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9431 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9432 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9433 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9434 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9435 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9436 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9437 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9438
9439 @item gnus-button-man-level
9440 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9441 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9442 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9443
9444 @item gnus-button-message-level
9445 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9446 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9447 Related variables and functions include
9448 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9449 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9450 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9451 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9452
9453 @end table
9454
9455
9456 @node Article Date
9457 @subsection Article Date
9458
9459 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9460 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9461 when the article was sent.
9462
9463 @table @kbd
9464
9465 @item W T u
9466 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9467 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9468 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9469 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9470
9471 @item W T i
9472 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9473 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9474 @cindex ISO 8601
9475 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9476 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9477
9478 @item W T l
9479 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9480 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9481 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9482
9483 @item W T p
9484 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9485 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9486 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9487 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9488
9489 @item W T s
9490 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9491 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9492 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9493 @findex format-time-string
9494 Display the date using a user-defined format
9495 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9496 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9497 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9498 for a list of possible format specs.
9499
9500 @item W T e
9501 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9502 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9503 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9504 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9505 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9506 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9507
9508 @example
9509 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9510 @end example
9511
9512 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9513 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9514 variable.
9515
9516 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9517
9518 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9519 @lisp
9520 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9521 @end lisp
9522
9523 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9524
9525 @item W T o
9526 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9527 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9528 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9529 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9530 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9531 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9532 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9533
9534 @end table
9535
9536 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9537 preferred format automatically.
9538
9539
9540 @node Article Display
9541 @subsection Article Display
9542 @cindex picons
9543 @cindex x-face
9544 @cindex smileys
9545 @cindex gravatars
9546
9547 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9548 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9549
9550 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9551 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9552
9553 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9554 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9555
9556 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9557 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9558
9559 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9560 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9561
9562 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9563 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9564
9565 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9566 they'll be removed.
9567
9568 @table @kbd
9569 @item W D x
9570 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9571 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9572 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9573 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9574
9575 @item W D d
9576 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9577 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9578 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9579 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9580
9581 @item W D s
9582 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9583 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9584 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9585
9586 @item W D f
9587 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9588 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9589 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9590
9591 @item W D m
9592 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9593 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9594 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9595 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9596
9597 @item W D n
9598 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9599 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9600 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9601 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9602
9603 @item W D g
9604 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9605 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9606 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9607
9608 @item W D h
9609 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9610 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9611 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9612 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9613
9614 @item W D D
9615 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9616 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9617 Remove all images from the article buffer
9618 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9619
9620 @item W D W
9621 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9622 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9623 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9624 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9625 the buffer with this command.
9626 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9627
9628 @end table
9629
9630
9631
9632 @node Article Signature
9633 @subsection Article Signature
9634 @cindex signatures
9635 @cindex article signature
9636
9637 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9638 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9639 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9640 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9641 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9642 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9643 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9644 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9645 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9646
9647 @lisp
9648 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9649 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9650 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9651 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9652 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9653 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9654 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9655 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9656 @end lisp
9657
9658 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9659 positives.
9660
9661 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9662 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9663 signature when displaying articles.
9664
9665 @enumerate
9666 @item
9667 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9668 that integer.
9669 @item
9670 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9671 than that number.
9672 @item
9673 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9674 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9675 @item
9676 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9677 in question is not a signature.
9678 @end enumerate
9679
9680 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9681 listed above. Here's an example:
9682
9683 @lisp
9684 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9685 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9686 @end lisp
9687
9688 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9689 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9690 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9691 signature after all.
9692
9693
9694 @node Article Miscellanea
9695 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9696
9697 @table @kbd
9698 @item A t
9699 @kindex A t (Summary)
9700 @findex gnus-article-babel
9701 Translate the article from one language to another
9702 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9703
9704 @end table
9705
9706
9707 @node MIME Commands
9708 @section MIME Commands
9709 @cindex MIME decoding
9710 @cindex attachments
9711 @cindex viewing attachments
9712
9713 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9714 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9715
9716 @table @kbd
9717 @item b
9718 @itemx K v
9719 @kindex b (Summary)
9720 @kindex K v (Summary)
9721 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9722
9723 @item K o
9724 @kindex K o (Summary)
9725 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9726
9727 @item K O
9728 @kindex K O (Summary)
9729 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9730 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9731 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9732
9733 @item K r
9734 @kindex K r (Summary)
9735 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9736
9737 @item K d
9738 @kindex K d (Summary)
9739 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9740 removed part.
9741
9742 @item K c
9743 @kindex K c (Summary)
9744 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9745
9746 @item K e
9747 @kindex K e (Summary)
9748 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9749
9750 @item K i
9751 @kindex K i (Summary)
9752 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9753
9754 @item K |
9755 @kindex K | (Summary)
9756 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9757 @end table
9758
9759 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9760 the same manner:
9761
9762 @table @kbd
9763 @item K H
9764 @kindex K H (Summary)
9765 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9766 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9767 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9768 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9769 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9770 unless the prefix argument is given.
9771
9772 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9773 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9774 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9775 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9776 trusted senders.
9777
9778 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9779 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9780
9781 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9782 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9783 the group (if you want).
9784
9785 @item K b
9786 @kindex K b (Summary)
9787 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9788 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9789 parts.
9790
9791 @item K m
9792 @kindex K m (Summary)
9793 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9794 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9795 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9796 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9797 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9798
9799 @item X m
9800 @kindex X m (Summary)
9801 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9802 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9803 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9804 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9805
9806 @item M-t
9807 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9808 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9809 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9810 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9811
9812 @item W M w
9813 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9814 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9815 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9816 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9817
9818 @item W M c
9819 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9820 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9821 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9822 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9823
9824 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9825 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9826 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9827 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9828 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9829 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9830
9831 @item W M v
9832 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9833 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9834 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9835 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9836
9837 @end table
9838
9839 Relevant variables:
9840
9841 @table @code
9842 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9843 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9844 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9845 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9846 @code{nil}.
9847
9848 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9849
9850 @lisp
9851 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9852 '("text/x-vcard"))
9853 @end lisp
9854
9855 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9856 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9857 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9858 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9859 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9860 default is @code{t}.
9861
9862 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9863 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9864 @cindex uuencode
9865 @cindex yEnc
9866 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9867 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9868 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9869 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9870 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9871 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9872 for encoding in Gnus.
9873
9874 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9875 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9876 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9877 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9878 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9879 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9880 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9881 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9882
9883 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9884 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9885 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9886 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9887 displayed. This variable overrides
9888 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9889 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9890 is @code{nil}.
9891
9892 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9893 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9894 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9895
9896 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9897 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9898 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9899 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9900 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9901
9902 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9903 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9904 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9905 default value is @code{nil}.
9906
9907 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9908 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9909 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9910 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9911 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9912 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9913 save all jpegs into some directory).
9914
9915 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9916
9917 @lisp
9918 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9919 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9920 (with-temp-buffer
9921 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9922 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9923 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9924 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9925 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9926 @end lisp
9927
9928 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9929 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9930 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9931
9932 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9933 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9934 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9935
9936 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9937 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9938 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9939
9940 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9941 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9942 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9943 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9944 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9945
9946 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9947 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9948 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9949 overrides @code{nil} values of
9950 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9951 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9952
9953 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9954 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9955 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9956 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9957
9958 Ready-made functions include@*
9959 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9960 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9961 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9962 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9963 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9964 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9965 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9966 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9967 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9968 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9969 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9970 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9971
9972 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9973 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9974
9975 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9976 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9977 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9978
9979 @lisp
9980 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9981 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9982 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9983 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9984 @end lisp
9985
9986 @noindent
9987 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9988
9989 @end table
9990
9991
9992 @node Charsets
9993 @section Charsets
9994 @cindex charsets
9995
9996 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9997 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9998 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9999 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10000 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10001 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10002 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10003
10004 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10005 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10006 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10007 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10008
10009 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10010 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10011 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10012 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10013 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10014 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10015 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10016 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10017 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10018
10019 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10020 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10021 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10022 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10023 quoted-printable header encoding.
10024
10025 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10026 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10027 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10028
10029 @table @var
10030 @item test
10031 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10032 variable to query,
10033 @item header
10034 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10035 means encode all charsets),
10036 @item body-list
10037 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10038 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10039 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10040 @end table
10041
10042 @cindex Russian
10043 @cindex koi8-r
10044 @cindex koi8-u
10045 @cindex iso-8859-5
10046 @cindex coding system aliases
10047 @cindex preferred charset
10048
10049 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10050 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10051 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10052
10053 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10054
10055 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10056 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10057
10058 @lisp
10059 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10060 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10061 @end lisp
10062
10063 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10064 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10065
10066 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10067
10068 @lisp
10069 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10070 @end lisp
10071
10072 This will almost do the right thing.
10073
10074 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10075 something like
10076
10077 @lisp
10078 (codepage-setup 1251)
10079 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10080 @end lisp
10081
10082
10083 @node Article Commands
10084 @section Article Commands
10085
10086 @table @kbd
10087
10088 @item A P
10089 @cindex PostScript
10090 @cindex printing
10091 @kindex A P (Summary)
10092 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10093 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10094 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10095 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10096 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10097 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10098
10099 @item A C
10100 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10101 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10102 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10103 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10104 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10105 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10106 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10107 do so.
10108
10109 @end table
10110
10111
10112 @node Summary Sorting
10113 @section Summary Sorting
10114 @cindex summary sorting
10115
10116 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10117 can't really see why you'd want that.
10118
10119 @table @kbd
10120
10121 @item C-c C-s C-n
10122 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10123 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10124 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10125
10126 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10127 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10128 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10129 Sort by most recent article number
10130 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10131
10132 @item C-c C-s C-a
10133 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10134 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10135 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10136
10137 @item C-c C-s C-t
10138 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10139 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10140 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10141
10142 @item C-c C-s C-s
10143 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10144 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10145 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10146
10147 @item C-c C-s C-d
10148 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10149 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10150 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10151
10152 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10153 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10154 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10155 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10156
10157 @item C-c C-s C-l
10158 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10159 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10160 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10161
10162 @item C-c C-s C-c
10163 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10164 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10165 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10166
10167 @item C-c C-s C-i
10168 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10169 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10170 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10171
10172 @item C-c C-s C-r
10173 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10174 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10175 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10176
10177 @item C-c C-s C-o
10178 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10179 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10180 Sort using the default sorting method
10181 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10182 @end table
10183
10184 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10185 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10186 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10187 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10188 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10189 Commands}).
10190
10191 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10192
10193
10194 @node Finding the Parent
10195 @section Finding the Parent
10196 @cindex parent articles
10197 @cindex referring articles
10198
10199 @table @kbd
10200 @item ^
10201 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10202 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10203 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10204 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10205 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10206 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10207 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10208 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10209 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10210 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10211
10212 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10213 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10214 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10215 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10216 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10217 article.
10218
10219 @item A R (Summary)
10220 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10221 @kindex A R (Summary)
10222 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10223 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10224
10225 @item A T (Summary)
10226 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10227 @kindex A T (Summary)
10228 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10229 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10230 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10231 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10232 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10233 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10234 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10235
10236 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10237 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10238 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10239 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10240 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10241 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10242
10243 @item M-^ (Summary)
10244 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10245 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10246 @cindex Message-ID
10247 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10248 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10249 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10250 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10251 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10252 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10253
10254 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10255 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10256 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10257 @end table
10258
10259 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10260 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10261 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10262 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10263 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10264 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10265 necessary.
10266
10267 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10268 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10269 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10270 match.
10271
10272 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10273 then ask Google if that fails:
10274
10275 @lisp
10276 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10277 '(current
10278 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10279 @end lisp
10280
10281 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10282 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10283 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10284 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10285 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10286 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10287
10288 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10289 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10290 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10291 registry}).
10292
10293 @node Alternative Approaches
10294 @section Alternative Approaches
10295
10296 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10297 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10298
10299 @menu
10300 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10301 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10302 @end menu
10303
10304
10305 @node Pick and Read
10306 @subsection Pick and Read
10307 @cindex pick and read
10308
10309 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10310 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10311 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10312 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10313
10314 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10315 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10316 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10317 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10318 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10319 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10320
10321 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10322
10323 @table @kbd
10324 @item .
10325 @kindex . (Pick)
10326 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10327 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10328 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10329 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10330 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10331 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10332 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10333 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10334
10335 @item SPACE
10336 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10337 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10338 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10339 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10340
10341 @item u
10342 @kindex u (Pick)
10343 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10344 Unpick the thread or article
10345 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10346 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10347 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10348 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10349 the thread or article at that line.
10350
10351 @item RET
10352 @kindex RET (Pick)
10353 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10354 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10355 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10356 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10357 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10358 will still be visible when you are reading.
10359
10360 @end table
10361
10362 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10363 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10364 which is mapped to the same function
10365 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10366
10367 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10368
10369 @lisp
10370 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10371 @end lisp
10372
10373 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10374 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10375
10376 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10377 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10378 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10379
10380 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10381 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10382 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10383 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10384 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10385 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10386 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10387
10388
10389 @node Binary Groups
10390 @subsection Binary Groups
10391 @cindex binary groups
10392
10393 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10394 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10395 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10396 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10397 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10398 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10399 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10400
10401 @kindex g (Binary)
10402 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10403 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10404 command, when you have turned on this mode
10405 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10406
10407 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10408 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10409
10410
10411 @node Tree Display
10412 @section Tree Display
10413 @cindex trees
10414
10415 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10416 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10417 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10418 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10419 in the tree buffer.
10420
10421 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10422
10423 @table @code
10424 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10425 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10426 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10427
10428 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10429 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10430 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10431 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10432 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10433
10434 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10435 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10436 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10437 default is @code{modeline}.
10438
10439 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10440 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10441 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10442 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10443 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10444 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10445 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10446
10447 Valid specs are:
10448
10449 @table @samp
10450 @item n
10451 The name of the poster.
10452 @item f
10453 The @code{From} header.
10454 @item N
10455 The number of the article.
10456 @item [
10457 The opening bracket.
10458 @item ]
10459 The closing bracket.
10460 @item s
10461 The subject.
10462 @end table
10463
10464 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10465
10466 Variables related to the display are:
10467
10468 @table @code
10469 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10470 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10471 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10472 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10473 @example
10474 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10475 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10476 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10477 @end example
10478 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10479
10480 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10481 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10482 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10483 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10484
10485 @end table
10486
10487 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10488 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10489 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10490 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10491 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10492 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10493 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10494 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10495 other windows displayed next to it.
10496
10497 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10498 at all times:
10499
10500 @lisp
10501 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10502 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10503 @end lisp
10504
10505 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10506 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10507 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10508 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10509 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10510 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10511 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10512
10513 @end table
10514
10515 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10516
10517 @example
10518 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10519 | \[Jan]
10520 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10521 | \(***)-[Eri]
10522 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10523 \[Bjo]
10524 \[Gun]
10525 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10526 @end example
10527
10528 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10529
10530 @example
10531 @group
10532 @{***@}
10533 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10534 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10535 |--\-----\-----\ |
10536 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10537 | | |--\
10538 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10539 |
10540 [Paa]
10541 @end group
10542 @end example
10543
10544 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10545 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10546 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10547
10548 @lisp
10549 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10550 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10551 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10552 (gnus-add-configuration
10553 '(article
10554 (vertical 1.0
10555 (horizontal 0.25
10556 (summary 0.75 point)
10557 (tree 1.0))
10558 (article 1.0))))
10559 @end lisp
10560
10561 @xref{Window Layout}.
10562
10563
10564 @node Mail Group Commands
10565 @section Mail Group Commands
10566 @cindex mail group commands
10567
10568 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10569 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10570
10571 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10572 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10573
10574 @table @kbd
10575
10576 @item B e
10577 @kindex B e (Summary)
10578 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10579 @cindex expiring mail
10580 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10581 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10582 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10583 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10584
10585 @item B C-M-e
10586 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10587 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10588 @cindex expiring mail
10589 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10590 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10591 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10592 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10593
10594 @item B DEL
10595 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10596 @cindex deleting mail
10597 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10598 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10599 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10600 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10601 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10602
10603 @item B m
10604 @kindex B m (Summary)
10605 @cindex move mail
10606 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10607 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10608 Move the article from one mail group to another
10609 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10610 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10611
10612 @item B c
10613 @kindex B c (Summary)
10614 @cindex copy mail
10615 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10616 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10617 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10618 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10619 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10620
10621 @item B B
10622 @kindex B B (Summary)
10623 @cindex crosspost mail
10624 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10625 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10626 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10627 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10628 be properly updated.
10629
10630 @item B i
10631 @kindex B i (Summary)
10632 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10633 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10634 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10635 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10636
10637 @item B I
10638 @kindex B I (Summary)
10639 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10640 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10641 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10642 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10643
10644 @item B r
10645 @kindex B r (Summary)
10646 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10647 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10648 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10649 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10650 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10651 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10652 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10653 (which is the default).
10654
10655 @item B w
10656 @itemx e
10657 @kindex B w (Summary)
10658 @kindex e (Summary)
10659 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10660 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10661 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10662 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10663 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10664 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10665 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10666
10667 @item B q
10668 @kindex B q (Summary)
10669 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10670 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10671 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10672 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10673
10674 @item B t
10675 @kindex B t (Summary)
10676 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10677 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10678 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10679
10680 @item B p
10681 @kindex B p (Summary)
10682 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10683 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10684 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10685 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10686 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10687 article from your news server (or rather, from
10688 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10689 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10690 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10691 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10692 just not have arrived yet.
10693
10694 @item K E
10695 @kindex K E (Summary)
10696 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10697 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10698 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10699 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10700 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10701
10702 @end table
10703
10704 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10705 @cindex moving articles
10706 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10707 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10708 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10709 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10710 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10711 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10712 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10713
10714 @lisp
10715 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10716 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10717 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10718 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10719 @end lisp
10720
10721
10722 @node Various Summary Stuff
10723 @section Various Summary Stuff
10724
10725 @menu
10726 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10727 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10728 * Summary Generation Commands::
10729 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10730 @end menu
10731
10732 @table @code
10733 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10734 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10735 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10736 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10737 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10738 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10739
10740 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10741 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10742 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10743 current article.
10744
10745 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10746 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10747 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10748
10749 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10750 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10751 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10752 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10753 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10754 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10755 have been set.
10756
10757 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10758 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10759 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10760 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10761 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10762
10763 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10764 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10765 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10766 generated.
10767
10768 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10769 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10770 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10771 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10772 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10773 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10774 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10775 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10776 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10777 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10778
10779 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10780 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10781 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10782 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10783 list of articles to be selected.
10784
10785 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10786 the list in one particular group:
10787
10788 @lisp
10789 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10790 (if (string= group "some.group")
10791 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10792 articles))
10793 @end lisp
10794
10795 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10796 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10797 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10798 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10799 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10800 buffer is active.
10801
10802 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10803 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10804 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10805 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10806 variable will be used instead.
10807
10808 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10809 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10810 buffers. For example:
10811
10812 @lisp
10813 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10814 '(message-use-followup-to
10815 (gnus-visible-headers .
10816 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10817 @end lisp
10818
10819 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10820
10821 @end table
10822
10823
10824 @node Summary Group Information
10825 @subsection Summary Group Information
10826
10827 @table @kbd
10828
10829 @item H d
10830 @kindex H d (Summary)
10831 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10832 Give a brief description of the current group
10833 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10834 rereading the description from the server.
10835
10836 @item H h
10837 @kindex H h (Summary)
10838 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10839 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10840 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10841
10842 @item H i
10843 @kindex H i (Summary)
10844 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10845 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10846 @end table
10847
10848
10849 @node Searching for Articles
10850 @subsection Searching for Articles
10851
10852 @table @kbd
10853
10854 @item M-s
10855 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10856 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10857 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10858 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10859
10860 @item M-r
10861 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10862 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10863 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10864 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10865
10866 @item M-S
10867 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10868 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10869 Repeat the previous search forwards
10870 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10871
10872 @item M-R
10873 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10874 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10875 Repeat the previous search backwards
10876 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10877
10878 @item &
10879 @kindex & (Summary)
10880 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10881 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10882 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10883 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10884 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10885 search backward instead.
10886
10887 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10888 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10889
10890 @item M-&
10891 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10892 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10893 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10894 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10895 @end table
10896
10897 @node Summary Generation Commands
10898 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10899
10900 @table @kbd
10901
10902 @item Y g
10903 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10904 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10905 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10906
10907 @item Y c
10908 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10909 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10910 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10911 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10912
10913 @item Y d
10914 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10915 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10916 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10917 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10918
10919 @item Y t
10920 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10921 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10922 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10923 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10924
10925 @end table
10926
10927
10928 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10929 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10930
10931 @table @kbd
10932
10933 @item A D
10934 @itemx C-d
10935 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10936 @kindex A D (Summary)
10937 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10938 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10939 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10940 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10941 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10942 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10943 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10944 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10945 fashion.
10946
10947 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10948 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10949 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10950 include:
10951
10952 @table @code
10953 @item next
10954 Select the next article.
10955
10956 @item next-unread
10957 Select the next unread article.
10958
10959 @item next-noselect
10960 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10961
10962 @item next-unread-noselect
10963 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10964 @end table
10965
10966 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10967 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10968
10969 @item C-M-d
10970 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10971 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10972 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10973 several documents into one biiig group
10974 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10975 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10976 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10977 command understands the process/prefix convention
10978 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10979
10980 @item C-t
10981 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10982 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10983 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10984 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10985 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10986 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10987
10988 @item =
10989 @kindex = (Summary)
10990 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10991 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10992 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10993
10994 @item C-M-e
10995 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10996 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10997 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10998 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10999
11000 @item C-M-a
11001 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11002 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11003 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11004 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11005
11006 @end table
11007
11008
11009 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11010 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11011 @cindex summary exit
11012 @cindex exiting groups
11013
11014 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11015 group and return you to the group buffer.
11016
11017 @table @kbd
11018
11019 @item Z Z
11020 @itemx Z Q
11021 @itemx q
11022 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11023 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11024 @kindex q (Summary)
11025 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11026 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11027 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11028 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11029 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11030 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11031 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11032 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11033 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11034 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11035 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11036 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11037
11038 @item Z E
11039 @itemx Q
11040 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11041 @kindex Q (Summary)
11042 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11043 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11044 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11045
11046 @item Z c
11047 @itemx c
11048 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11049 @kindex c (Summary)
11050 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11051 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11052 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11053 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11054
11055 @item Z C
11056 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11057 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11058 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11059 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11060
11061 @item Z n
11062 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11063 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11064 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11065 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11066
11067 @item Z p
11068 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11069 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11070 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11071 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11072
11073 @item Z R
11074 @itemx C-x C-s
11075 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11076 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11077 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11078 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11079 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11080 all articles, both read and unread.
11081
11082 @item Z G
11083 @itemx M-g
11084 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11085 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11086 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11087 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11088 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11089 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11090 articles, both read and unread.
11091
11092 @item Z N
11093 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11094 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11095 Exit the group and go to the next group
11096 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11097
11098 @item Z P
11099 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11100 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11101 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11102 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11103
11104 @item Z s
11105 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11106 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11107 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11108 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11109 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11110 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11111 @end table
11112
11113 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11114 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11115 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11116 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11117
11118 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11119 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11120 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11121 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11122 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11123 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11124 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11125 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11126 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11127 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11128 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11129 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11130
11131 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11132
11133 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11134 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11135 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11136 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11137 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11138 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11139 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11140 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11141 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11142
11143
11144 @node Crosspost Handling
11145 @section Crosspost Handling
11146
11147 @cindex velveeta
11148 @cindex spamming
11149 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11150 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11151 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11152 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11153 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11154 heinous crime.
11155
11156 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11157 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11158 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11159 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11160 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11161
11162 @cindex cross-posting
11163 @cindex Xref
11164 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11165 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11166 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11167 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11168 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11169 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11170 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11171 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11172 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11173 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11174 the cross reference mechanism.
11175
11176 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11177 @cindex overview.fmt
11178 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11179 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11180 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11181 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11182 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11183 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11184 overview files.
11185
11186 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11187 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11188 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11189
11190 C'est la vie.
11191
11192 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11193
11194
11195 @node Duplicate Suppression
11196 @section Duplicate Suppression
11197
11198 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11199 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11200 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11201 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11202 reasons.
11203
11204 @enumerate
11205 @item
11206 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11207 is evil and not very common.
11208
11209 @item
11210 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11211 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11212
11213 @item
11214 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11215 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11216
11217 @item
11218 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11219 @end enumerate
11220
11221 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11222 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11223
11224 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11225 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11226 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11227 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11228 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11229 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11230 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11231 once.
11232
11233 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11234 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11235 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11236 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11237 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11238 saw the article in.
11239
11240 @table @code
11241 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11242 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11243 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11244
11245 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11246 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11247 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11248 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11249 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11250 session are suppressed.
11251
11252 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11253 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11254 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11255 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11256
11257 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11258 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11259 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11260 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11261 @end table
11262
11263 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11264 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11265 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11266 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11267 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11268 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11269 to you to figure out, I think.
11270
11271 @node Security
11272 @section Security
11273
11274 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11275 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11276 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11277 things to work:
11278
11279 @enumerate
11280 @item
11281 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11282 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11283 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11284 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11285 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11286
11287 @item
11288 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11289 or newer is recommended.
11290
11291 @end enumerate
11292
11293 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11294 messages include:
11295
11296 @table @code
11297 @item mm-verify-option
11298 @vindex mm-verify-option
11299 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11300 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11301 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11302
11303 @item mm-decrypt-option
11304 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11305 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11306 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11307 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11308
11309 @item mm-sign-option
11310 @vindex mm-sign-option
11311 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11312 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11313
11314 @item mm-encrypt-option
11315 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11316 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11317 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11318 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11319
11320 @item mml1991-use
11321 @vindex mml1991-use
11322 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11323 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11324 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11325 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11326 this order.
11327
11328 @item mml2015-use
11329 @vindex mml2015-use
11330 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11331 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11332 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11333 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11334 interface in this order.
11335
11336 @end table
11337
11338 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11339 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11340 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11341 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11342 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11343 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11344 how to customize these variables to always display security
11345 information.
11346
11347 @cindex snarfing keys
11348 @cindex importing PGP keys
11349 @cindex PGP key ring import
11350 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11351 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11352 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11353 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11354 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11355 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11356 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11357 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11358 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11359
11360 @example
11361 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11362 @end example
11363 @noindent
11364 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11365 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11366
11367 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11368 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11369 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11370
11371 @node Mailing List
11372 @section Mailing List
11373 @cindex mailing list
11374 @cindex RFC 2396
11375
11376 @kindex A M (summary)
11377 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11378 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11379 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11380 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11381 summary buffer.
11382
11383 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11384
11385 @table @kbd
11386
11387 @item C-c C-n h
11388 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11389 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11390 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11391
11392 @item C-c C-n s
11393 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11394 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11395 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11396
11397 @item C-c C-n u
11398 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11399 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11400 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11401 field exists.
11402
11403 @item C-c C-n p
11404 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11405 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11406 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11407
11408 @item C-c C-n o
11409 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11410 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11411 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11412
11413 @item C-c C-n a
11414 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11415 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11416 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11417
11418 @end table
11419
11420
11421 @node Article Buffer
11422 @chapter Article Buffer
11423 @cindex article buffer
11424
11425 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11426 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11427 tell Gnus otherwise.
11428
11429 @menu
11430 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11431 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11432 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11433 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11434 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11435 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11436 @end menu
11437
11438
11439 @node Hiding Headers
11440 @section Hiding Headers
11441 @cindex hiding headers
11442 @cindex deleting headers
11443
11444 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11445 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11446
11447 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11448 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11449 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11450 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11451 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11452 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11453 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11454 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11455 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11456
11457 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11458
11459 @table @code
11460
11461 @item gnus-visible-headers
11462 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11463 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11464 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11465 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11466
11467 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11468 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11469
11470 @lisp
11471 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11472 @end lisp
11473
11474 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11475 remain visible.
11476
11477 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11478 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11479 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11480 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11481 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11482 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11483
11484 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11485 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11486
11487 @lisp
11488 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11489 @end lisp
11490
11491 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11492 be removed.
11493
11494 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11495 variable will have no effect.
11496
11497 @end table
11498
11499 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11500 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11501 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11502 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11503 the headers are to be displayed.
11504
11505 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11506 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11507
11508 @lisp
11509 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11510 @end lisp
11511
11512 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11513 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11514
11515 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11516 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11517 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11518 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11519 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11520 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11521 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11522 from sight.
11523
11524 These conditions are:
11525 @table @code
11526 @item empty
11527 Remove all empty headers.
11528 @item followup-to
11529 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11530 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11531 @item reply-to
11532 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11533 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11534 parameter is set.
11535 @item newsgroups
11536 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11537 name.
11538 @item to-address
11539 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11540 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11541 @item to-list
11542 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11543 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11544 @item cc-list
11545 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11546 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11547 @item date
11548 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11549 old.
11550 @item long-to
11551 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11552 @item many-to
11553 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11554 @end table
11555
11556 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11557
11558 @lisp
11559 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11560 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11561 @end lisp
11562
11563 This is also the default value for this variable.
11564
11565
11566 @node Using MIME
11567 @section Using MIME
11568 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11569
11570 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11571 while people stand around yawning.
11572
11573 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11574 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11575
11576 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11577 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11578 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11579
11580 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11581 @findex gnus-display-mime
11582 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11583 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11584 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11585 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11586
11587 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11588 @acronym{MIME} button:
11589
11590 @table @kbd
11591 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11592 @item RET (Article)
11593 @kindex RET (Article)
11594 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11595 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11596 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11597 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11598 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11599 object is displayed inline.
11600
11601 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11602 @item M-RET (Article)
11603 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11604 @itemx v (Article)
11605 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11606 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11607
11608 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11609 @item t (Article)
11610 @kindex t (Article)
11611 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11612 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11613
11614 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11615 @item C (Article)
11616 @kindex C (Article)
11617 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11618 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11619
11620 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11621 @item o (Article)
11622 @kindex o (Article)
11623 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11624 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11625
11626 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11627 @item C-o (Article)
11628 @kindex C-o (Article)
11629 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11630 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11631 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11632 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11633 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11634 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11635
11636 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11637 @item r (Article)
11638 @kindex r (Article)
11639 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11640 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11641 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11642
11643 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11644 @item d (Article)
11645 @kindex d (Article)
11646 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11647 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11648 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11649
11650 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11651
11652 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11653 @item c (Article)
11654 @kindex c (Article)
11655 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11656 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11657 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11658 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11659 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11660 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11661 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11662 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11663
11664 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11665 @item p (Article)
11666 @kindex p (Article)
11667 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11668 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11669 @file{.mailcap} file.
11670
11671 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11672 @item i (Article)
11673 @kindex i (Article)
11674 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11675 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11676 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11677 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11678 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11679 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11680 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11681 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11682 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11683
11684 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11685 @item E (Article)
11686 @kindex E (Article)
11687 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11688 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11689 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11690
11691 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11692 @item e (Article)
11693 @kindex e (Article)
11694 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11695 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11696
11697 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11698 @item | (Article)
11699 @kindex | (Article)
11700 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11701
11702 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11703 @item . (Article)
11704 @kindex . (Article)
11705 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11706 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11707
11708 @end table
11709
11710 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11711 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11712 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11713
11714 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11715 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11716 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11717 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11718 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11719 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11720 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11721 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11722 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11723
11724 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11725
11726 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11727
11728
11729 @node HTML
11730 @section @acronym{HTML}
11731 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11732
11733 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11734 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11735 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11736 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11737
11738 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11739 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11740 section only describes the default method.
11741
11742 @table @code
11743 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11744 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11745 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11746 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11747
11748 @item gnus-blocked-images
11749 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11750 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11751 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11752 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11753
11754 @lisp
11755 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11756 @end lisp
11757
11758 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11759 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11760 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11761 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11762 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11763 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11764
11765 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11766
11767 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11768 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11769 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11770 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11771 this directory.
11772
11773 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11774 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11775 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11776 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11777
11778 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11779 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11780 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11781
11782 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11783 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11784 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11785 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11786 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11787 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11788 fit these criteria.
11789
11790 @end table
11791
11792 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11793 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11794 automatically.
11795
11796
11797
11798 @node Customizing Articles
11799 @section Customizing Articles
11800 @cindex article customization
11801
11802 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11803 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11804 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11805 called automatically when you select the articles.
11806
11807 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11808 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11809 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11810 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11811
11812 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11813 for sensible values.
11814
11815 @enumerate
11816 @item
11817 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11818
11819 @item
11820 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11821
11822 @item
11823 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11824
11825 @item
11826 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11827
11828 @item
11829 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11830
11831 @item
11832 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11833 than this number.
11834
11835 @item
11836 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11837 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11838 regexps in the list.
11839
11840 @item
11841 A list where the first element is not a string:
11842
11843 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11844 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11845 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11846
11847 @lisp
11848 (or last
11849 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11850 @end lisp
11851
11852 @end enumerate
11853
11854 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11855 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11856 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11857 considered to contain just a single part.
11858
11859 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11860 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11861 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11862 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11863 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11864 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11865 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11866
11867 @ifinfo
11868 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11869 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11870 @c `i foo-bar'.
11871 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11872 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11873 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11874 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11875 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11876 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11877 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11878 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11908 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11909 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11910 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11911 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11912 @end ifinfo
11913
11914 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11915 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11916 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11917 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11918
11919 @table @code
11920 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11921 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11922
11923 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11924
11925 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11926 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11927 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11928 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11930 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11931 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11932 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11933 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11934 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11935
11936 @xref{Article Washing}.
11937
11938 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11939
11940 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11941 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11942 headers to display. The formats available are:
11943
11944 @table @code
11945 @item ut
11946 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11947
11948 @item local
11949 The user's local time zone.
11950
11951 @item english
11952 A semi-readable English sentence.
11953
11954 @item lapsed
11955 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11956
11957 @item combined-lapsed
11958 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11959
11960 @item original
11961 The original date header.
11962
11963 @item iso8601
11964 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11965
11966 @item user-defined
11967 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11968 variable.
11969
11970 @end table
11971
11972 @xref{Article Date}.
11973
11974 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11975 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11976 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11977
11978 @xref{Picons}.
11979
11980 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11981 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11982
11983 @xref{Gravatars}.
11984
11985 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11986
11987 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11988
11989 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11990 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11991 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11992
11993 @xref{Smileys}.
11994
11995 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11996 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11997
11998 @xref{X-Face}.
11999
12000 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12001 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12002
12003 @xref{Face}.
12004
12005 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12006 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12007 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12008 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12009 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12010 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12011 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12012 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12013 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12014 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12015 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12016 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12017 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12018 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12019 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12020 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12021 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12022 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12023 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12024 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12025
12026 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12027
12028 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12029 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12030 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12031 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12032 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12033 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12034
12035 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12036
12037 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12038 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12039 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12040 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12041 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12042
12043 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12044 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12045 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12046 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12047 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12048 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12049 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12050 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12051
12052 @xref{Article Header}.
12053
12054
12055 @end table
12056
12057 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12058 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12059 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12060 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12061 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12062 everything.
12063
12064
12065 @node Article Keymap
12066 @section Article Keymap
12067
12068 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12069 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12070 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12071 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12072 buffer.
12073
12074 @kindex v (Article)
12075 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12076 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12077 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12078
12079 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12080
12081 @table @kbd
12082
12083 @item SPACE
12084 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12085 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12086 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12087 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12088
12089 @item DEL
12090 @kindex DEL (Article)
12091 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12092 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12093 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12094
12095 @item C-c ^
12096 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12097 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12098 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12099 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12100 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12101
12102 @item C-c C-m
12103 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12104 @findex gnus-article-mail
12105 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12106 given a prefix, include the mail.
12107
12108 @item s
12109 @kindex s (Article)
12110 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12111 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12112 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12113
12114 @item ?
12115 @kindex ? (Article)
12116 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12117 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12118 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12119
12120 @item TAB
12121 @kindex TAB (Article)
12122 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12123 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12124 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12125
12126 @item M-TAB
12127 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12128 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12129 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12130
12131 @item R
12132 @kindex R (Article)
12133 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12134 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12135 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12136 only yank the text in the region.
12137
12138 @item S W
12139 @kindex S W (Article)
12140 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12141 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12142 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12143 active, only yank the text in the region.
12144
12145 @item F
12146 @kindex F (Article)
12147 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12148 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12149 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12150 only yank the text in the region.
12151
12152
12153 @end table
12154
12155
12156 @node Misc Article
12157 @section Misc Article
12158
12159 @table @code
12160
12161 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12162 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12163 @cindex article buffers, several
12164 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12165 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12166 article buffer.
12167
12168 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12169 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12170 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12171 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12172
12173 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12174 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12175 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12176 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12177 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12178
12179 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12180 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12181 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12182 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12183 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12184 the contents of the article buffer.
12185
12186 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12187 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12188 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12189
12190 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12191 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12192 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12193 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12194
12195 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12196 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12197 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12198 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12199
12200 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12201 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12202 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12203 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12204 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12205 with two extensions:
12206
12207 @table @samp
12208
12209 @item w
12210 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12211 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12212 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12213
12214 @table @samp
12215
12216 @item c
12217 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12218
12219 @item h
12220 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12221
12222 @item p
12223 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12224 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12225 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12226
12227 @item s
12228 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12229
12230 @item o
12231 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12232
12233 @item e
12234 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12235
12236 @end table
12237
12238 @item m
12239 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12240
12241 @end table
12242
12243 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12244
12245 @item gnus-break-pages
12246 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12247 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12248 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12249 paging will not be done.
12250
12251 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12252 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12253 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12254 (formfeed).
12255
12256 @cindex IDNA
12257 @cindex internationalized domain names
12258 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12259 @item gnus-use-idna
12260 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12261 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12262 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12263 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12264 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12265 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12266
12267 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12268 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12269 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12270 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12271 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12272 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12273 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12274 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12275
12276 @end table
12277
12278
12279 @node Composing Messages
12280 @chapter Composing Messages
12281 @cindex composing messages
12282 @cindex messages
12283 @cindex mail
12284 @cindex sending mail
12285 @cindex reply
12286 @cindex followup
12287 @cindex post
12288 @cindex using gpg
12289 @cindex using s/mime
12290 @cindex using smime
12291
12292 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12293 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12294 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12295 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12296 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12297 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12298
12299 @menu
12300 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12301 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12302 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12303 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12304 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12305 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12306 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12307 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12308 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12309 @end menu
12310
12311 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12312 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12313
12314
12315 @node Mail
12316 @section Mail
12317
12318 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12319
12320 @table @code
12321 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12322 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12323 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12324 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12325 @code{nil} include all headers.
12326
12327 @item gnus-add-to-list
12328 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12329 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12330 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12331
12332 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12333 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12334 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12335 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12336 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12337 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12338 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12339 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12340
12341 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12342 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12343
12344 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12345 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12346 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12347 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12348 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12349
12350 @end table
12351
12352
12353 @node Posting Server
12354 @section Posting Server
12355
12356 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12357 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12358
12359 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12360
12361 It can be quite complicated.
12362
12363 @vindex gnus-post-method
12364 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12365 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12366 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12367 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12368 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12369 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12370 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12371 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12372 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12373
12374 @lisp
12375 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12376 @end lisp
12377
12378 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12379 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12380 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12381 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12382
12383 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12384 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12385
12386 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12387 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12388 for posting.
12389
12390 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12391 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12392
12393 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12394 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12395 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12396 value suitable for your system.
12397 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12398 information.
12399
12400
12401 @node POP before SMTP
12402 @section POP before SMTP
12403 @cindex pop before smtp
12404 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12405
12406 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12407 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12408 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12409 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12410
12411 @lisp
12412 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12413 @end lisp
12414
12415 @noindent
12416 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12417 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12418 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12419
12420 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12421 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12422 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12423 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12424 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12425 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12426
12427 @lisp
12428 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12429 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12430 :password "secret"))
12431 @end lisp
12432
12433 @noindent
12434 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12435 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12436
12437 @lisp
12438 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12439 (lambda ()
12440 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12441 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12442 :password "secret")))
12443 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12444 @end lisp
12445
12446
12447 @node Mail and Post
12448 @section Mail and Post
12449
12450 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12451 posting:
12452
12453 @table @code
12454 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12455 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12456 @cindex mailing lists
12457
12458 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12459 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12460 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12461 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12462 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12463 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12464 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12465 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12466 still a pain, though.
12467
12468 @item gnus-user-agent
12469 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12470 @cindex User-Agent
12471
12472 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12473 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12474 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12475 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12476 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12477 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12478 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12479
12480 @end table
12481
12482 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12483 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12484 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12485
12486 @cindex ispell
12487 @findex ispell-message
12488 @lisp
12489 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12490 @end lisp
12491
12492 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12493 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12494
12495 @lisp
12496 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12497 (lambda ()
12498 (cond
12499 ((string-match
12500 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12501 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12502 (t
12503 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12504 @end lisp
12505
12506 Modify to suit your needs.
12507
12508 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12509 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12510 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12511 mode buffers.
12512
12513 @node Archived Messages
12514 @section Archived Messages
12515 @cindex archived messages
12516 @cindex sent messages
12517
12518 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12519 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12520 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12521 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12522 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12523
12524 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12525 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12526 Group Commands}).
12527
12528 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12529 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12530 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12531 actually being used it is expanded into:
12532
12533 @lisp
12534 (nnfolder "archive"
12535 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12536 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12537 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12538 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12539 @end lisp
12540
12541 @quotation
12542 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12543 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12544 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12545 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12546 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12547 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12548 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12549 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12550 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12551 saved method to reflect always the value of
12552 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12553 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12554 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12555 @end quotation
12556
12557 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12558 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12559 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12560 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12561
12562 @lisp
12563 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12564 '(nnfolder "archive"
12565 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12566 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12567 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12568 @end lisp
12569
12570 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12571 @cindex Gcc
12572 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12573 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12574 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12575
12576 This variable can be used to do the following:
12577
12578 @table @asis
12579 @item a string
12580 Messages will be saved in that group.
12581
12582 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12583 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12584 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12585 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12586 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12587 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12588 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12589 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12590 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12591
12592 @item a list of strings
12593 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12594
12595 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12596 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12597
12598 @item @code{nil}
12599 No message archiving will take place.
12600 @end table
12601
12602 Let's illustrate:
12603
12604 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12605 @lisp
12606 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12607 @end lisp
12608
12609 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12610 @lisp
12611 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12612 @end lisp
12613
12614 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12615 @lisp
12616 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12617 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12618 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12619 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12620 @end lisp
12621
12622 More complex stuff:
12623 @lisp
12624 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12625 '((if (message-news-p)
12626 "misc-news"
12627 "misc-mail")))
12628 @end lisp
12629
12630 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12631 messages in one file per month:
12632
12633 @lisp
12634 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12635 '((if (message-news-p)
12636 "misc-news"
12637 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12638 @end lisp
12639
12640 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12641 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12642 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12643 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12644 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12645 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12646 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12647 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12648 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12649 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12650
12651 @table @code
12652 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12653 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12654 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12655
12656 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12657 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12658 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12659 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12660 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12661 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12662 changed in the future.
12663
12664 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12665 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12666 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12667 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12668 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12669 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12670
12671 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12672 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12673 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12674 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12675 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12676 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12677 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12678 except for the current group.
12679
12680 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12681 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12682 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12683 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12684
12685 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12686 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12687 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12688 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12689 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12690 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12691 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12692
12693 @end table
12694
12695
12696 @node Posting Styles
12697 @section Posting Styles
12698 @cindex posting styles
12699 @cindex styles
12700
12701 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12702
12703 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12704 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12705 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12706 on?
12707
12708 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12709 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12710 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12711 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12712 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12713 variable:
12714
12715 @lisp
12716 ((".*"
12717 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12718 (organization "What me?"))
12719 ("^comp"
12720 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12721 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12722 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12723 @end lisp
12724
12725 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12726 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12727 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12728 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12729 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12730 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12731 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12732 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12733
12734 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12735 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12736 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12737 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12738 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12739 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12740 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12741 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12742 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12743 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12744 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12745 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12746 said to @dfn{match}.
12747
12748 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12749 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12750 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12751 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12752 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12753 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12754 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12755 name can be one of:
12756
12757 @itemize @bullet
12758 @item @code{signature}
12759 @item @code{signature-file}
12760 @item @code{x-face-file}
12761 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12762 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12763 @item @code{body}
12764 @end itemize
12765
12766 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12767 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12768
12769 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12770 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12771 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12772 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12773 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12774
12775 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12776 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12777 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12778 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12779 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12780 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12781 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12782 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12783
12784 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12785 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12786 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12787 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12788 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12789
12790 @vindex message-reply-headers
12791
12792 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12793 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12794 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12795
12796 @findex message-mail-p
12797 @findex message-news-p
12798
12799 So here's a new example:
12800
12801 @lisp
12802 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12803 '((".*"
12804 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12805 (name "User Name")
12806 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12807 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12808 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12809 ("^rec.humor"
12810 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12811 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12812 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12813 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12814 (signature my-news-signature))
12815 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12816 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12817 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12818 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12819 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12820 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12821 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12822 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12823 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12824 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12825 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12826 ("nnml:.*"
12827 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12828 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12829 ("^nn.+:"
12830 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12831 @end lisp
12832
12833 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12834 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12835 if you fill many roles.
12836 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12837 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12838
12839 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12840 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12841 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12842 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12843 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12844
12845
12846 @node Drafts
12847 @section Drafts
12848 @cindex drafts
12849
12850 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12851 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12852 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12853 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12854 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12855
12856 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12857 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12858 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12859 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12860 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12861 group.)
12862
12863 @cindex nndraft
12864 @vindex nndraft-directory
12865 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12866 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12867 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12868 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12869 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12870 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12871
12872 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12873 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12874 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12875 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12876 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12877 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12878 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12879 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12880 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12881
12882 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12883 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12884 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12885 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12886 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12887 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12888 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12889 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12890 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12891 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12892 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12893 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12894 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12895 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12896 @c
12897 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12898 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12899 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12900
12901 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12902 @kindex D e (Draft)
12903 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12904 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12905 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12906
12907 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12908 Articles}).
12909
12910 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12911 @kindex D s (Draft)
12912 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12913 @kindex D S (Draft)
12914 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12915 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12916 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12917 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12918 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12919 in the buffer.
12920
12921 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12922 @kindex D t (Draft)
12923 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12924 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12925 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12926
12927 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12928 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12929
12930
12931 @node Rejected Articles
12932 @section Rejected Articles
12933 @cindex rejected articles
12934
12935 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12936 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12937 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12938 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12939
12940 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12941 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12942 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12943 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12944 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12945
12946 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12947 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12948 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12949
12950 @node Signing and encrypting
12951 @section Signing and encrypting
12952 @cindex using gpg
12953 @cindex using s/mime
12954 @cindex using smime
12955
12956 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12957 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12958 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12959 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12960
12961 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12962 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12963 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12964 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12965 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12966 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12967 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12968 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12969 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12970 automatically encrypted messages.
12971
12972 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12973 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12974 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12975
12976 @table @kbd
12977
12978 @item C-c C-m s s
12979 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12980 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12981
12982 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12983
12984 @item C-c C-m s o
12985 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12986 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12987
12988 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12989
12990 @item C-c C-m s p
12991 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12992 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12993
12994 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12995
12996 @item C-c C-m c s
12997 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12998 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12999
13000 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13001
13002 @item C-c C-m c o
13003 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13004 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13005
13006 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13007
13008 @item C-c C-m c p
13009 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13010 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13011
13012 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13013
13014 @item C-c C-m C-n
13015 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13016 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13017 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13018
13019 @end table
13020
13021 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13022
13023 @node Select Methods
13024 @chapter Select Methods
13025 @cindex foreign groups
13026 @cindex select methods
13027
13028 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13029 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13030 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13031 personal mail group.
13032
13033 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13034 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13035 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13036 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13037 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13038 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13039
13040 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13041 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13042
13043 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13044 group as.
13045
13046 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13047 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13048 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13049 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13050 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13051
13052 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13053
13054 @menu
13055 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13056 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13057 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13058 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13059 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13060 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13061 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13062 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13063 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13064 @end menu
13065
13066
13067 @node Server Buffer
13068 @section Server Buffer
13069
13070 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13071 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13072 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13073 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13074 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13075 back end represents a virtual server.
13076
13077 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13078 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13079 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13080 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13081
13082 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13083 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13084 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13085 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13086 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13087 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13088 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13089
13090 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13091 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13092
13093 @menu
13094 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13095 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13096 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13097 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13098 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13099 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13100 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13101 @end menu
13102
13103 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13104 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13105
13106
13107 @node Server Buffer Format
13108 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13109 @cindex server buffer format
13110
13111 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13112 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13113 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13114 variable, with some simple extensions:
13115
13116 @table @samp
13117
13118 @item h
13119 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13120
13121 @item n
13122 The name of this server.
13123
13124 @item w
13125 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13126
13127 @item s
13128 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13129
13130 @item a
13131 Whether this server is agentized.
13132 @end table
13133
13134 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13135 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13136 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13137 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13138
13139 @table @samp
13140 @item S
13141 Server name.
13142
13143 @item M
13144 Server method.
13145 @end table
13146
13147 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13148
13149
13150 @node Server Commands
13151 @subsection Server Commands
13152 @cindex server commands
13153
13154 @table @kbd
13155
13156 @item v
13157 @kindex v (Server)
13158 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13159 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13160 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13161
13162 @item a
13163 @kindex a (Server)
13164 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13165 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13166
13167 @item e
13168 @kindex e (Server)
13169 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13170 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13171
13172 @item S
13173 @kindex S (Server)
13174 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13175 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13176
13177 @item SPACE
13178 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13179 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13180 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13181
13182 @item q
13183 @kindex q (Server)
13184 @findex gnus-server-exit
13185 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13186
13187 @item k
13188 @kindex k (Server)
13189 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13190 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13191
13192 @item y
13193 @kindex y (Server)
13194 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13195 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13196
13197 @item c
13198 @kindex c (Server)
13199 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13200 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13201
13202 @item l
13203 @kindex l (Server)
13204 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13205 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13206
13207 @item s
13208 @kindex s (Server)
13209 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13210 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13211 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13212 servers.
13213
13214 @item g
13215 @kindex g (Server)
13216 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13217 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13218 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13219 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13220
13221 @item z
13222 @kindex z (Server)
13223 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13224
13225 Compact all groups in the server under point
13226 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13227 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13228 hence getting a correct total article count.
13229
13230 @end table
13231
13232 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13233 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13234
13235
13236 @node Example Methods
13237 @subsection Example Methods
13238
13239 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13240
13241 @lisp
13242 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13243 @end lisp
13244
13245 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13246
13247 @lisp
13248 (nnspool "")
13249 @end lisp
13250
13251 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13252 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13253 will.
13254
13255 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13256 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13257
13258 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13259 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13260 look like then:
13261
13262 @lisp
13263 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13264 @end lisp
13265
13266 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13267 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13268
13269 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13270 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13271 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13272 your private mail:
13273
13274 @lisp
13275 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13276 @end lisp
13277
13278 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13279 that.)
13280
13281 Here's the method for a public spool:
13282
13283 @lisp
13284 (nnmh "public"
13285 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13286 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13287 @end lisp
13288
13289 @cindex proxy
13290 @cindex firewall
13291
13292 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13293 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13294 on the firewall machine and connect with
13295 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13296 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13297 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13298 should probably look something like this:
13299
13300 @lisp
13301 (nntp "firewall"
13302 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13303 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13304 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13305 @end lisp
13306
13307 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13308 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13309 configuration to the example above:
13310
13311 @lisp
13312 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13313 @end lisp
13314
13315 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13316 an indirect connection:
13317
13318 @lisp
13319 (setq gnus-select-method
13320 '(nntp "indirect"
13321 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13322 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13323 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13324 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13325 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13326 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13327 @end lisp
13328
13329 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13330 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13331
13332 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13333 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13334 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13335
13336 @lisp
13337 (nntp "outside"
13338 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13339 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13340 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13341 @end lisp
13342
13343
13344 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13345 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13346
13347 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13348 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13349
13350 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13351 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13352 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13353
13354 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13355
13356 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13357 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13358 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13359 will contain the following:
13360
13361 @lisp
13362 (nnml "cache")
13363 @end lisp
13364
13365 Change that to:
13366
13367 @lisp
13368 (nnml "cache"
13369 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13370 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13371 @end lisp
13372
13373 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13374 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13375 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13376
13377
13378 @node Server Variables
13379 @subsection Server Variables
13380 @cindex server variables
13381 @cindex server parameters
13382
13383 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13384 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13385 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13386 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13387 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13388
13389 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13390 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13391 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13392 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13393 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13394 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13395 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13396 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13397 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13398
13399 @lisp
13400 (nnml "public"
13401 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13402 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13403 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13404 @end lisp
13405
13406 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13407
13408 @node Servers and Methods
13409 @subsection Servers and Methods
13410
13411 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13412 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13413 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13414 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13415 over.
13416
13417
13418 @node Unavailable Servers
13419 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13420
13421 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13422 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13423 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13424 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13425 actually the case or not.
13426
13427 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13428 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13429 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13430 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13431 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13432 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13433 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13434 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13435
13436 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13437 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13438
13439 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13440 with the following commands:
13441
13442 @table @kbd
13443
13444 @item O
13445 @kindex O (Server)
13446 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13447 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13448 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13449
13450 @item C
13451 @kindex C (Server)
13452 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13453 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13454 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13455
13456 @item D
13457 @kindex D (Server)
13458 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13459 Mark the current server as unreachable
13460 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13461
13462 @item M-o
13463 @kindex M-o (Server)
13464 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13465 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13466 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13467
13468 @item M-c
13469 @kindex M-c (Server)
13470 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13471 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13472 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13473
13474 @item R
13475 @kindex R (Server)
13476 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13477 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13478 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13479
13480 @item c
13481 @kindex c (Server)
13482 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13483 Copy a server and give it a new name
13484 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13485 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13486 a different (physical) server.
13487
13488 @item L
13489 @kindex L (Server)
13490 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13491 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13492
13493 @end table
13494
13495
13496 @node Getting News
13497 @section Getting News
13498 @cindex reading news
13499 @cindex news back ends
13500
13501 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13502 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13503 or it can read from a local spool.
13504
13505 @menu
13506 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13507 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13508 @end menu
13509
13510
13511 @node NNTP
13512 @subsection NNTP
13513 @cindex nntp
13514
13515 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13516 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13517 server as the, uhm, address.
13518
13519 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13520 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13521 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13522 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13523
13524 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13525 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13526 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13527
13528 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13529 server:
13530
13531 @table @code
13532
13533 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13534 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13535 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13536 @cindex authinfo
13537 @cindex authentication
13538 @cindex nntp authentication
13539 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13540 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13541 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13542 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13543 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13544 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13545 present in this hook.
13546
13547 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13548 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13549 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13550 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13551 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13552 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13553 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13554 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13555 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13556 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13557 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13558 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13559
13560 @enumerate
13561 @item
13562 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13563
13564 @item
13565 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13566
13567 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13568 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13569 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13570 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13571 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13572 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13573 @samp{force} is explained below.
13574
13575 @end enumerate
13576
13577 Here's an example file:
13578
13579 @example
13580 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13581 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13582 @end example
13583
13584 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13585 have to be first, for instance.
13586
13587 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13588 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13589 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13590 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13591 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13592 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13593 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13594
13595 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13596 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13597
13598 @example
13599 default force yes
13600 @end example
13601
13602 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13603 previously mentioned.
13604
13605 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13606
13607 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13608 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13609 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13610 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13611 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13612
13613 @lisp
13614 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13615 '(("innd" (ding))))
13616 @end lisp
13617
13618 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13619
13620 The default value is
13621
13622 @lisp
13623 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13624 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13625 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13626 @end lisp
13627
13628 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13629 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13630
13631 @item nntp-maximum-request
13632 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13633 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13634 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13635 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13636 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13637 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13638 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13639
13640 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13641 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13642 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13643 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13644 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13645 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13646 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13647 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13648 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13649 no timeouts are done.
13650
13651 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13652 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13653 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13654 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13655 can be used.
13656
13657 @item nntp-xover-commands
13658 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13659 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13660 @cindex XOVER
13661 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13662 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13663 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13664
13665 @item nntp-nov-gap
13666 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13667 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13668 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13669 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
13670 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13671 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13672 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13673 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13674 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13675 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13676 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13677
13678 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13679 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13680 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13681 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13682 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13683 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13684 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13685 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13686 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13687 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13688 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13689 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13690 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13691 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13692 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13693 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13694 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13695
13696 @lisp
13697 (setq gnus-select-method
13698 '(nntp "newszilla"
13699 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13700 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13701 @dots{}))
13702 @end lisp
13703
13704 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13705
13706 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13707 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13708 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13709
13710 @item nntp-record-commands
13711 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13712 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13713 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13714 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13715 that doesn't seem to work.
13716
13717 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13718 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13719 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13720 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13721 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13722 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13723 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13724 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13725
13726 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13727 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13728 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13729 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13730 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13731 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13732 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13733 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13734 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13735
13736 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13737 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13738 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13739 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13740 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13741 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13742 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13743
13744 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13745 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13746 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13747 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13748 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13749 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13750 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13751
13752 @lisp
13753 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13754 @end lisp
13755
13756 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13757 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13758
13759 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13760 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13761 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13762 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13763
13764
13765 @end table
13766
13767 @menu
13768 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13769 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13770 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13771 @end menu
13772
13773
13774 @node Direct Functions
13775 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13776 @cindex direct connection functions
13777
13778 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13779 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13780 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13781 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13782
13783 @table @code
13784 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13785 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13786 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13787 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13788 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13789 connection automatically.
13790
13791 @item network-only
13792 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13793
13794 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13795 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13796 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13797 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13798 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13799
13800 @lisp
13801 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13802 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13803 ;;
13804 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13805 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13806 (nntp-port-number 563)
13807 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13808 @end lisp
13809
13810 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13811 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13812 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13813 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13814 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13815 then define a server as follows:
13816
13817 @lisp
13818 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13819 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13820 ;;
13821 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13822 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13823 (nntp-port-number 563)
13824 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13825 @end lisp
13826
13827 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13828 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13829 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13830 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13831 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13832 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13833 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13834 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13835
13836 @lisp
13837 (nntp "socksified"
13838 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13839 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13840 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13841 @end lisp
13842
13843 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13844 session, which is not a good idea.
13845
13846 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13847 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13848 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13849 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13850 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13851 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13852
13853 @lisp
13854 (nntp "socksified"
13855 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13856 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13857 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13858 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13859 @end lisp
13860 @end table
13861
13862
13863 @node Indirect Functions
13864 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13865 @cindex indirect connection functions
13866
13867 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13868 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13869 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13870 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13871 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13872 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13873
13874 @table @code
13875 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13876 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13877 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13878 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13879 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13880
13881 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13882
13883 @table @code
13884 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13885 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13886 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13887 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13888
13889 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13890 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13891 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13892 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13893 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13894 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13895 @end table
13896
13897 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13898 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13899 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13900 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13901 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13902 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13903
13904 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13905
13906 @table @code
13907 @item nntp-telnet-command
13908 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13909 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13910 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13911
13912 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13913 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13914 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13915 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13916
13917 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13918 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13919 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13920 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13921
13922 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13923 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13924 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13925 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13926 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13927 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13928 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13929 @end table
13930
13931 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13932 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13933
13934 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13935 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13936 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13937 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13938
13939 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13940
13941 @table @code
13942 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13943 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13944 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13945 @samp{telnet}.
13946
13947 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13948 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13949 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13950 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13951
13952 @item nntp-via-user-password
13953 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13954 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13955
13956 @item nntp-via-envuser
13957 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13958 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13959 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13960 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13961
13962 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13963 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13964 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13965 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13966
13967 @end table
13968
13969 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13970 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13971 @end table
13972
13973
13974 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13975 functions:
13976
13977 @table @code
13978
13979 @item nntp-via-user-name
13980 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13981 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13982
13983 @item nntp-via-address
13984 @vindex nntp-via-address
13985 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13986
13987 @end table
13988
13989
13990 @node Common Variables
13991 @subsubsection Common Variables
13992
13993 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13994 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13995 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13996 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13997 variables individually).
13998
13999 @table @code
14000
14001 @item nntp-pre-command
14002 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14003 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14004 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14005 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14006 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14007
14008 @item nntp-address
14009 @vindex nntp-address
14010 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14011
14012 @item nntp-port-number
14013 @vindex nntp-port-number
14014 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14015 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14016 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14017 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14018 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14019 not work with named ports.
14020
14021 @item nntp-end-of-line
14022 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14023 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14024 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14025 using a non native telnet connection function.
14026
14027 @item nntp-netcat-command
14028 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14029 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14030 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14031 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14032 @samp{nc}.
14033
14034 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14035 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14036 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14037 is @samp{()}.
14038
14039 @end table
14040
14041 @node News Spool
14042 @subsection News Spool
14043 @cindex nnspool
14044 @cindex news spool
14045
14046 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14047 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14048 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14049 instance.
14050
14051 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14052 anything else) as the address.
14053
14054 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14055 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14056 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14057 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14058
14059 @table @code
14060
14061 @item nnspool-inews-program
14062 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14063 Program used to post an article.
14064
14065 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14066 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14067 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14068
14069 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14070 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14071 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14072 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14073
14074 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14075 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14076 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14077 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14078
14079 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14080 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14081 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14082
14083 @item nnspool-active-file
14084 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14085 The name of the active file.
14086
14087 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14088 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14089 The name of the group descriptions file.
14090
14091 @item nnspool-history-file
14092 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14093 The name of the news history file.
14094
14095 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14096 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14097 The name of the active date file.
14098
14099 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14100 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14101 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14102 that it finds.
14103
14104 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14105 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14106 @cindex sed
14107 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14108 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14109 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14110 there.
14111
14112 @end table
14113
14114
14115 @node Using IMAP
14116 @section Using IMAP
14117 @cindex imap
14118
14119 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14120 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14121 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14122 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14123 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14124
14125 @menu
14126 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14127 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14128 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14129 @end menu
14130
14131
14132 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14133 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14134
14135 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14136 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14137 something like:
14138
14139 @example
14140 (setq gnus-select-method
14141 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14142 @end example
14143
14144 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14145 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14146
14147 @example
14148 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14149 @end example
14150
14151 That should basically be it for most users.
14152
14153
14154 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14155 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14156
14157 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14158
14159 @example
14160 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14161 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14162 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14163 (nnimap-expunge t)
14164 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14165 @end example
14166
14167 @table @code
14168 @item nnimap-address
14169 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14170
14171 @item nnimap-server-port
14172 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14173 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14174
14175 @item nnimap-stream
14176 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14177
14178 @table @code
14179 @item undecided
14180 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14181 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14182
14183 @item ssl
14184 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14185
14186 @item network
14187 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14188 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14189 supports it.
14190
14191 @item starttls
14192 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14193
14194 @item shell
14195 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14196 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14197 what you need.
14198
14199 @end table
14200
14201 @item nnimap-authenticator
14202 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14203 this should be set to @code{anonymous}.
14204
14205 @item nnimap-expunge
14206 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14207 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14208 servers that doesn't support that command.
14209
14210 @item nnimap-streaming
14211 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14212 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14213 @code{nil}.
14214
14215 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14216 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14217 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14218 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14219 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14220
14221 @item nnimap-record-commands
14222 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14223 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14224
14225 @end table
14226
14227
14228 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14229 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14230
14231 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14232 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14233 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14234
14235 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14236 variables are relevant:
14237
14238 @table @code
14239 @item nnimap-inbox
14240 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14241
14242 @item nnimap-split-methods
14243 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14244 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14245 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14246
14247 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14248 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14249
14250 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14251 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14252 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14253 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14254
14255 @end table
14256
14257 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14258 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14259
14260 @example
14261 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14262 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14263 (nnimap-split-methods
14264 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14265 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14266 "undecided")))
14267 @end example
14268
14269
14270 @node Getting Mail
14271 @section Getting Mail
14272 @cindex reading mail
14273 @cindex mail
14274
14275 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14276 course.
14277
14278 @menu
14279 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14280 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14281 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14282 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14283 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14284 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14285 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14286 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14287 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14288 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14289 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14290 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14291 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14292 @end menu
14293
14294
14295 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14296 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14297
14298 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14299 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14300 of a culture shock.
14301
14302 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14303 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14304
14305 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14306 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14307 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14308 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14309
14310 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14311
14312 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14313 deleted? How awful!
14314
14315 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14316 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14317 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14318 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14319 Mail}.
14320
14321 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14322 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14323 they want to treat a message.
14324
14325 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14326 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14327 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14328 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14329 archived somewhere else.
14330
14331 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14332 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14333 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14334 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14335 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14336
14337 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14338 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14339 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14340
14341 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14342 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14343 differently.
14344
14345 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14346 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14347 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14348 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14349 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14350
14351 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14352 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14353 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14354 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14355 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14356 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14357 You Do.)
14358
14359
14360 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14361 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14362
14363 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14364 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14365 and things will happen automatically.
14366
14367 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14368 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14369
14370 @lisp
14371 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14372 @end lisp
14373
14374 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14375 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14376 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14377 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14378 like any other group.
14379
14380 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14381
14382 @lisp
14383 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14384 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14385 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14386 ("other" "")))
14387 @end lisp
14388
14389 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14390 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14391 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14392 last group.
14393
14394 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14395 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14396 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14397
14398
14399 @node Splitting Mail
14400 @subsection Splitting Mail
14401 @cindex splitting mail
14402 @cindex mail splitting
14403 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14404
14405 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14406 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14407 to be split into groups.
14408
14409 @lisp
14410 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14411 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14412 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14413 ("mail.other" "")))
14414 @end lisp
14415
14416 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14417 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14418 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14419 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14420 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14421 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14422 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14423
14424 @lisp
14425 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14426 @end lisp
14427
14428 @noindent
14429 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14430 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14431
14432 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14433 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14434 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14435 mail belongs in that group.
14436
14437 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14438 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14439 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14440 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14441 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14442 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14443 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14444 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14445 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14446 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14447
14448 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14449 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14450 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14451 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14452 thinks should carry this mail message.
14453
14454 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14455 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14456
14457 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14458 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14459 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14460 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14461
14462 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14463 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14464 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14465 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14466 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14467
14468 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14469 @cindex crosspost
14470 @cindex links
14471 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14472 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14473 links. If that's the case for you, set
14474 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14475 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14476
14477 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14478 @findex nnmail-split-history
14479 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14480 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14481 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14482 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14483 Group Commands}).
14484
14485 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14486 Header lines longer than the value of
14487 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14488 function.
14489
14490 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14491 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14492 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14493 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14494 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14495 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14496 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14497 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14498 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14499 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14500 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14501 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14502
14503 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14504 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14505 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14506 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14507 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14508 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14509 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14510 other kinds of entries.)
14511
14512 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14513 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14514 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14515 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14516 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14517 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14518 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14519 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14520 month's rent money.
14521
14522
14523 @node Mail Sources
14524 @subsection Mail Sources
14525
14526 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14527 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14528 maildir, for instance.
14529
14530 @menu
14531 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14532 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14533 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14534 @end menu
14535
14536
14537 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14538 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14539 @cindex POP
14540 @cindex mail server
14541 @cindex procmail
14542 @cindex mail spool
14543 @cindex mail source
14544
14545 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14546 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14547
14548 Here's an example:
14549
14550 @lisp
14551 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14552 @end lisp
14553
14554 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14555 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14556 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14557 default values.
14558
14559 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14560 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14561 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14562 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14563 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14564 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14565 group might look like this:
14566
14567 @lisp
14568 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14569 @end lisp
14570
14571 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14572 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14573
14574 The following mail source types are available:
14575
14576 @table @code
14577 @item file
14578 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14579
14580 Keywords:
14581
14582 @table @code
14583 @item :path
14584 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14585 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14586 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14587
14588 @item :prescript
14589 @itemx :postscript
14590 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14591 @end table
14592
14593 An example file mail source:
14594
14595 @lisp
14596 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14597 @end lisp
14598
14599 Or using the default file name:
14600
14601 @lisp
14602 (file)
14603 @end lisp
14604
14605 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14606 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14607 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14608 mail spool while moving the mail.
14609
14610 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14611
14612 @lisp
14613 (setq mail-sources
14614 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14615 @end lisp
14616
14617 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14618
14619 @example
14620 #!/bin/sh
14621 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14622 # flu@@iki.fi
14623
14624 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14625 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14626 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14627 @end example
14628
14629 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14630 file you want to use.
14631
14632
14633 @item directory
14634 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14635 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14636 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14637 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14638 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14639 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14640 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14641 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14642 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14643 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14644
14645 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14646 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14647 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14648 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14649
14650 Keywords:
14651
14652 @table @code
14653 @item :path
14654 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14655 value.
14656
14657 @item :suffix
14658 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14659 @samp{.spool}.
14660
14661 @item :predicate
14662 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14663 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14664 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14665 predicate are considered.
14666
14667 @item :prescript
14668 @itemx :postscript
14669 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14670
14671 @end table
14672
14673 An example directory mail source:
14674
14675 @lisp
14676 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14677 :suffix ".prcml")
14678 @end lisp
14679
14680 @item pop
14681 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14682
14683 Keywords:
14684
14685 @table @code
14686 @item :server
14687 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14688 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14689
14690 @item :port
14691 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14692 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14693 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14694 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14695 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14696
14697 @item :user
14698 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14699 name.
14700
14701 @item :password
14702 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14703 the user is prompted.
14704
14705 @item :program
14706 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14707 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14708
14709 @example
14710 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14711 @end example
14712
14713 The valid format specifier characters are:
14714
14715 @table @samp
14716 @item t
14717 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14718 included in this string.
14719
14720 @item s
14721 The name of the server.
14722
14723 @item P
14724 The port number of the server.
14725
14726 @item u
14727 The user name to use.
14728
14729 @item p
14730 The password to use.
14731 @end table
14732
14733 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14734 corresponding keywords.
14735
14736 @item :prescript
14737 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14738 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14739
14740 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14741 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14742
14743 @lisp
14744 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14745 :port 1234
14746 :user "foo"
14747 :password "secret"
14748 :prescript
14749 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14750 @end lisp
14751
14752 @item :postscript
14753 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14754 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14755
14756 @item :function
14757 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14758 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14759 mail should be moved to.
14760
14761 @item :authentication
14762 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14763 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14764 @code{password}.
14765
14766 @item :leave
14767 Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14768 after fetching. Mails once fetched will never be fetched again by the
14769 @acronym{UIDL} control. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program
14770 (the default) supports this keyword.
14771
14772 If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails will be left on
14773 the server. If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this
14774 many days since you first checked new mails. If this is @code{nil}
14775 (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right after fetching.
14776
14777 @vindex pop3-uidl-file
14778 The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14779 @acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14780 @file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14781
14782 Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14783 sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14784 there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14785 mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14786 mailbox.
14787
14788 @end table
14789
14790 @findex pop3-movemail
14791 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14792 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14793 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
14794
14795 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14796
14797 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14798 name, and default fetcher:
14799
14800 @lisp
14801 (pop)
14802 @end lisp
14803
14804 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14805
14806 @lisp
14807 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14808 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14809 @end lisp
14810
14811 Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14812
14813 @lisp
14814 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14815 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14816 :leave 14)
14817 @end lisp
14818
14819 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14820
14821 @lisp
14822 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14823 @end lisp
14824
14825 @item maildir
14826 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14827 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14828 contains exactly one mail.
14829
14830 Keywords:
14831
14832 @table @code
14833 @item :path
14834 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14835 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14836 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14837 @item :subdirs
14838 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14839 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14840
14841 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14842 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14843 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14844 @c below.
14845
14846 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14847 from locking problems).
14848
14849 @end table
14850
14851 Two example maildir mail sources:
14852
14853 @lisp
14854 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14855 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14856 @end lisp
14857
14858 @lisp
14859 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14860 :subdirs ("new"))
14861 @end lisp
14862
14863 @item imap
14864 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14865 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14866 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14867 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14868 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14869
14870 Keywords:
14871
14872 @table @code
14873 @item :server
14874 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14875 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14876
14877 @item :port
14878 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14879 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14880
14881 @item :user
14882 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14883 name.
14884
14885 @item :password
14886 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14887 prompted.
14888
14889 @item :stream
14890 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14891 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14892 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14893 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14894
14895 @item :authentication
14896 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14897 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14898 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14899 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14900
14901 @item :program
14902 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14903 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14904 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14905
14906 @example
14907 ssh %s imapd
14908 @end example
14909
14910 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14911 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14912 specifier characters are:
14913
14914 @table @samp
14915 @item s
14916 The name of the server.
14917
14918 @item l
14919 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14920
14921 @item p
14922 The port number of the server.
14923 @end table
14924
14925 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14926 corresponding keywords.
14927
14928 @item :mailbox
14929 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14930 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14931
14932 @item :predicate
14933 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14934 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14935 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14936 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14937 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14938 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14939
14940 @item :fetchflag
14941 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14942 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14943 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14944 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14945
14946 @item :dontexpunge
14947 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14948 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14949
14950 @end table
14951
14952 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14953
14954 @lisp
14955 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14956 :stream kerberos4
14957 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14958 @end lisp
14959
14960 @item group
14961 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14962 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14963
14964 @end table
14965
14966 @table @dfn
14967 @item Common Keywords
14968 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14969
14970 Keywords:
14971
14972 @table @code
14973 @item :plugged
14974 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14975 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14976 example:
14977
14978 @lisp
14979 (setq mail-sources
14980 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14981 :suffix ""
14982 :plugged t)))
14983 @end lisp
14984
14985 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14986 useful when you use local mail and news.
14987
14988 @end table
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @subsubsection Function Interface
14992
14993 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14994 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14995 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14996 consider the following mail-source setting:
14997
14998 @lisp
14999 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15000 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15001 @end lisp
15002
15003 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15004 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15005 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15006 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15007 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15008
15009 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15010
15011
15012 @node Mail Source Customization
15013 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15014
15015 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15016 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15017 variables.
15018
15019 @table @code
15020 @item mail-source-crash-box
15021 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15022 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15023 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15024
15025 @cindex Incoming*
15026 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15027 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15028 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15029 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15030 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15031 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15032 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15033 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15034 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15035 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15036
15037 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15038 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15039 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15040 files. This variable only applies when
15041 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15042
15043 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15044 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15045 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15046
15047 @item mail-source-directory
15048 @vindex mail-source-directory
15049 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15050 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15051 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15052 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15053
15054 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15055 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15056 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15057 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15058 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15059 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15060 number.
15061
15062 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15063 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15064 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15065
15066 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15067 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15068 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15069 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15070
15071 @end table
15072
15073
15074 @node Fetching Mail
15075 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15076
15077 @vindex mail-sources
15078 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15079 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15080 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15081
15082 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15083 fetch mail by themselves.
15084
15085 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15086 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15087
15088 @lisp
15089 (setq mail-sources
15090 '((file)
15091 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15092 :password "secret")))
15093 @end lisp
15094
15095 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15096
15097 @lisp
15098 (setq mail-sources
15099 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15100 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15101 :user "user-name"
15102 :port "pop3"
15103 :password "secret")))
15104 @end lisp
15105
15106
15107 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15108 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15109 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15110 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15111 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15112 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15113
15114
15115
15116 @node Mail Back End Variables
15117 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15118
15119 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15120 mail back ends.
15121
15122 @table @code
15123 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15124 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15125 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15126 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15127
15128 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15129 @item nnmail-split-hook
15130 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15131 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15132 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15133 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15134 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15135 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15136 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15137 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15138 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15139 to this hook.
15140
15141 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15142 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15143 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15144 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15145 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15146 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15147 starting to handle the new mail) and
15148 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15149 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15150 default file modes the new mail files get:
15151
15152 @lisp
15153 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15154 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15155
15156 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15157 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15158 @end lisp
15159
15160 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15161 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15162 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15163 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15164 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15165 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15166 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15167
15168 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15169 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15170 @findex delete-file
15171 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15172
15173 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15174 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15175 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15176 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15177 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15178
15179 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15180 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15181 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15182 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15183 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15184
15185 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15186 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15187 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15188
15189 @end table
15190
15191
15192 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15193 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15194 @cindex mail splitting
15195 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15196
15197 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15198 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15199 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15200 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15201 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15202 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15203
15204 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15205
15206 @lisp
15207 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15208 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15209 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15210 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15211 "mail.misc"))
15212 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15213 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15214 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15215 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15216 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15217 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15218 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15219 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15220 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15221 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15222 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15223 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15224 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15225 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15226 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15227 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15228 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15229 "misc.misc")
15230 @end lisp
15231
15232 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15233 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15234 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15235
15236 @table @code
15237
15238 @item group
15239 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15240 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15241
15242 @c Don't fold this line.
15243 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15244 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15245 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15246 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15247 @var{split}.
15248
15249 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15250 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15251 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15252 @var{split} is processed.
15253
15254 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15255 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15256 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15257 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15258
15259 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15260 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15261 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15262 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15263 stored in one or more groups.
15264
15265 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15266 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15267 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15268
15269 @item junk
15270 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15271 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15272
15273 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15274 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15275 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15276 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15277
15278 @cindex body split
15279 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15280 body of the messages:
15281
15282 @lisp
15283 (defun split-on-body ()
15284 (save-excursion
15285 (save-restriction
15286 (widen)
15287 (goto-char (point-min))
15288 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15289 "string.group"))))
15290 @end lisp
15291
15292 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15293 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15294 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15295 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15296 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15297 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15298 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15299
15300 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15301 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15302 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15303 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15304 should return a split.
15305
15306 @item nil
15307 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15308
15309 @end table
15310
15311 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15312
15313 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15314 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15315 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15316 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15317 for example,
15318
15319 @example
15320 (any "joe" "joemail")
15321 @end example
15322
15323 @noindent
15324 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15325 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15326 of the following three ways:
15327
15328 @enumerate
15329 @item
15330 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15331 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15332 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15333 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15334 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15335 @code{nil}.
15336
15337 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15338
15339 @item
15340 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15341 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15342 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15343 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15344 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15345
15346 @item
15347 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15348 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15349 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15350 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15351 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15352 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15353 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15354 @end enumerate
15355
15356 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15357 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15358 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15359 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15360 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15361 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15362 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15363
15364 @table @code
15365 @item from
15366 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15367 @item to
15368 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15369 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15370 @item any
15371 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15372 @end table
15373
15374 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15375 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15376 when all this splitting is performed.
15377
15378 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15379 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15380 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15381
15382 @example
15383 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15384 @end example
15385
15386 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15387 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15388
15389 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15390 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15391 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15392 groupings 1 through 9.
15393
15394 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15395 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15396 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15397 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15398 groups when users send to an address using different case
15399 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15400 is @code{t}.
15401
15402 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15403 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15404 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15405 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15406 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15407 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15408 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15409 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15410 it once per thread.
15411
15412 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15413 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15414 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15415 using the colon feature, like so:
15416 @lisp
15417 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15418 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15419 nnmail-split-fancy
15420 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15421 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15422 ))
15423 @end lisp
15424
15425 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15426 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15427 in the file specified by the variable
15428 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15429 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15430 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15431 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15432 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15433 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15434 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15435 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15436 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15437 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15438 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15439 300 kBytes in size.)
15440 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15441 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15442 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15443 messages goes into the new group.
15444
15445 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15446 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15447 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15448 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15449 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15450 ``outgoing'' group.
15451
15452
15453 @node Group Mail Splitting
15454 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15455 @cindex mail splitting
15456 @cindex group mail splitting
15457
15458 @findex gnus-group-split
15459 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15460 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15461 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15462 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15463 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15464 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15465 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15466 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15467
15468 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15469 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15470 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15471 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15472
15473 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15474 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15475 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15476 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15477 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15478 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15479 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15480
15481 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15482 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15483 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15484 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15485 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15486 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15487 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15488
15489 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15490 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15491 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15492 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15493 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15494 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15495 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15496 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15497 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15498 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15499 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15500 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15501 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15502
15503 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15504 been defined:
15505
15506 @example
15507 nnml:mail.bar:
15508 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15509 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15510 nnml:mail.foo:
15511 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15512 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15513 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15514 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15515 nnml:mail.others:
15516 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15517 @end example
15518
15519 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15520 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15521 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15522
15523 @lisp
15524 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15525 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15526 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15527 "mail.others")
15528 @end lisp
15529
15530 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15531 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15532 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15533 splits like this:
15534
15535 @lisp
15536 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15537 @end lisp
15538
15539 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15540 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15541 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15542 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15543 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15544 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15545 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15546 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15547 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15548
15549 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15550 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15551 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15552 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15553 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15554 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15555 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15556 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15557 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15558
15559 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15560 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15561 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15562 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15563 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15564 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15565
15566 @lisp
15567 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15568 @end lisp
15569
15570 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15571 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15572 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15573 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15574 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15575 value.
15576
15577 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15578 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15579 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15580 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15581
15582 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15583 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15584 @cindex incorporating old mail
15585 @cindex import old mail
15586
15587 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15588 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15589 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15590 your mail groups.
15591
15592 Doing so can be quite easy.
15593
15594 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15595 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15596 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15597 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15598 your @code{nnml} groups.
15599
15600 Here's how:
15601
15602 @enumerate
15603 @item
15604 Go to the group buffer.
15605
15606 @item
15607 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15608 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15609
15610 @item
15611 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15612
15613 @item
15614 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15615 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15616
15617 @item
15618 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15619 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15620 @end enumerate
15621
15622 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15623 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15624 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15625 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15626 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15627
15628 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15629 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15630 using the new mail back end.
15631
15632
15633 @node Expiring Mail
15634 @subsection Expiring Mail
15635 @cindex article expiry
15636 @cindex expiring mail
15637
15638 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15639 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15640 different approach to mail reading.
15641
15642 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15643 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15644 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15645 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15646 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15647 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15648 course.
15649
15650 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15651 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15652 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15653 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15654 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15655 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15656 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15657 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15658 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15659
15660 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15661 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15662 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15663 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15664 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15665 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15666 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15667 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15668 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15669 these marks.
15670
15671 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15672 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15673 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15674 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15675 into its own group.)
15676
15677 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15678 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15679 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15680 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15681 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15682 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15683 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15684 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15685 scoring.
15686
15687 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15688 Groups that match the regular expression
15689 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15690 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15691 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15692
15693 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15694 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15695 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15696 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15697 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15698
15699 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15700 @lisp
15701 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15702 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15703 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15704 @end lisp
15705
15706 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15707 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15708 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15709 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15710 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15711
15712 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15713 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15714
15715 @lisp
15716 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15717 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15718 @end lisp
15719
15720 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15721 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15722
15723 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15724 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15725 don't really mix very well.
15726
15727 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15728 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15729 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15730 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15731 days.
15732
15733 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15734 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15735 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15736 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15737 everywhere else:
15738
15739 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15740 @lisp
15741 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15742 (lambda (group)
15743 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15744 31)
15745 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15746 1)
15747 ((string= group "important")
15748 'never)
15749 (t
15750 6))))
15751 @end lisp
15752
15753 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15754 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15755
15756 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15757 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15758 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15759 @code{never}.
15760
15761 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15762 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15763
15764 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15765 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15766 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15767 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15768 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15769 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15770 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15771 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15772 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15773 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15774 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15775 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15776 name or @code{delete}.
15777
15778 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15779 @lisp
15780 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15781 @end lisp
15782
15783 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15784 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15785 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15786 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15787 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15788
15789 @lisp
15790 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15791 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15792 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15793 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15794 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15795 @end lisp
15796
15797 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15798 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15799 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15800 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15801 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15802 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15803
15804 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15805 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15806 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15807 easier for procmail users.
15808
15809 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15810 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15811 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15812 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15813 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15814 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15815 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15816 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15817 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15818 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15819 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15820 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15821 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15822 with! So there!
15823
15824 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15825
15826 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15827 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15828 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15829 auto-expire turned on.
15830
15831 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15832 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15833 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15834 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15835 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15836 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15837 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15838 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15839 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15840 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15841 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15842 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15843 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15844 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15845 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15846 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15847
15848
15849 @node Washing Mail
15850 @subsection Washing Mail
15851 @cindex mail washing
15852 @cindex list server brain damage
15853 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15854
15855 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15856 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15857 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15858 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15859 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15860 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15861
15862 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15863 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15864 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15865 laugh.
15866
15867 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15868 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15869 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15870 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15871
15872 @table @code
15873 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15874 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15875 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15876 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15877 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15878
15879 @table @code
15880 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15881 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15882 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15883 Emacs running on MS machines.
15884
15885 @end table
15886
15887 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15888 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15889 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15890 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15891
15892 @table @code
15893 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15894 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15895 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15896 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15897
15898 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15899 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15900 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15901 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15902 into a feature by documenting it.)
15903
15904 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15905 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15906 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15907 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15908 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15909 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15910 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15911 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15912
15913 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15914 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15915
15916 @lisp
15917 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15918 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15919 @end lisp
15920
15921 This can also be done non-destructively with
15922 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15923
15924 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15925 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15926 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15927
15928 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15929 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15930 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15931 @cindex Eudora
15932 @cindex Pegasus
15933 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15934 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15935 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15936 contain a line matching the regular expression
15937 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15938
15939 @end table
15940
15941 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15942 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15943 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15944 include:
15945
15946 @table @code
15947 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15948 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15949 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15950
15951 @end table
15952 @end table
15953
15954
15955 @node Duplicates
15956 @subsection Duplicates
15957
15958 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15959 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15960 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15961 @cindex duplicate mails
15962 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15963 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15964 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15965 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
15966 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15967 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15968 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15969 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15970 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15971 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15972 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15973 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15974 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15975
15976 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15977 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15978 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15979 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15980
15981 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15982 @code{nil}.
15983
15984 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15985 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15986 methods:
15987
15988 @lisp
15989 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15990 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15991 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15992 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15993 (any mail "mail.misc")
15994 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15995 [...] ))
15996 @end lisp
15997 @noindent
15998 Or something like:
15999 @lisp
16000 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16001 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16002 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16003 [...]))
16004 @end lisp
16005
16006 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16007 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16008 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16009 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16010 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16011
16012
16013 @node Not Reading Mail
16014 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16015
16016 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16017 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16018 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16019
16020 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16021 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16022 mail, which should help.
16023
16024 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16025 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16026 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16027 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16028 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16029 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16030 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16031 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16032 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16033 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16034 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16035
16036 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16037 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16038 incoming mail.
16039
16040
16041 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16042 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16043
16044 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16045 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16046 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16047
16048 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16049 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16050 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16051 Spool}).
16052
16053 @menu
16054 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16055 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16056 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16057 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16058 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16059 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16060 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16061 @end menu
16062
16063
16064
16065 @node Unix Mail Box
16066 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16067 @cindex nnmbox
16068 @cindex unix mail box
16069
16070 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16071 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16072 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16073 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16074 which group it belongs in.
16075
16076 Virtual server settings:
16077
16078 @table @code
16079 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16080 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16081 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16082 @file{~/mbox}.
16083
16084 @item nnmbox-active-file
16085 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16086 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16087 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16088
16089 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16090 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16091 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16092 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16093 @end table
16094
16095
16096 @node Babyl
16097 @subsubsection Babyl
16098 @cindex nnbabyl
16099
16100 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16101 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16102 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16103 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16104 group it belongs in.
16105
16106 Virtual server settings:
16107
16108 @table @code
16109 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16110 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16111 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16112
16113 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16114 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16115 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16116 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16117
16118 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16119 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16120 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16121 @code{t}
16122 @end table
16123
16124
16125 @node Mail Spool
16126 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16127 @cindex nnml
16128 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16129
16130 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16131 format. It should be used with some caution.
16132
16133 @vindex nnml-directory
16134 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16135 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16136 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16137 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16138
16139 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16140 care of all that.
16141
16142 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16143 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16144 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16145 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16146 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16147 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16148 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16149 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16150
16151 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16152 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16153 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16154 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16155
16156 Virtual server settings:
16157
16158 @table @code
16159 @item nnml-directory
16160 @vindex nnml-directory
16161 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16162 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16163 is @file{~/Mail}).
16164
16165 @item nnml-active-file
16166 @vindex nnml-active-file
16167 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16168 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16169
16170 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16171 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16172 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16173 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16174
16175 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16176 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16177 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16178 @code{t}.
16179
16180 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16181 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16182 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16183 default is @code{nil}.
16184
16185 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16186 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16187 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16188
16189 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16190 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16191 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16192
16193 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16194 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16195 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16196 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16197 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16198 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16199 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16200 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16201 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16202
16203 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16204 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16205 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16206 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16207 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16208
16209 @end table
16210
16211 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16212 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16213 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16214 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16215 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16216 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16217 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16218 Commands}).
16219
16220
16221 @node MH Spool
16222 @subsubsection MH Spool
16223 @cindex nnmh
16224 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16225
16226 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16227 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16228 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16229 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16230 for.
16231
16232 Virtual server settings:
16233
16234 @table @code
16235 @item nnmh-directory
16236 @vindex nnmh-directory
16237 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16238 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16239 @file{~/Mail})
16240
16241 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16242 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16243 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16244 @code{t}.
16245
16246 @item nnmh-be-safe
16247 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16248 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16249 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16250 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16251 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16252 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16253 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16254 @end table
16255
16256
16257 @node Maildir
16258 @subsubsection Maildir
16259 @cindex nnmaildir
16260 @cindex maildir
16261
16262 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16263 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16264 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16265 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16266 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16267 within a maildir.
16268
16269 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16270 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16271 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16272 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16273 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16274 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16275 that appear as group in Gnus.
16276
16277 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16278 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16279 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16280
16281 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16282 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16283 another, and you will keep your marks.
16284
16285 Virtual server settings:
16286
16287 @table @code
16288 @item directory
16289 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16290 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16291 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16292 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16293 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16294 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16295 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16296 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16297 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16298 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16299
16300 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16301 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16302 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16303 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16304 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16305 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16306 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16307 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16308 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16309 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16310 value.
16311
16312 @item target-prefix
16313 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16314 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16315 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16316 closed.
16317
16318 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16319 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16320 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16321 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16322 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16323 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16324 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16325 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16326 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16327
16328 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16329 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16330 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16331 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16332 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16333
16334 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16335 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16336 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16337 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16338 @code{force} argument.
16339
16340 @item directory-files
16341 This should be a function with the same interface as
16342 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16343 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16344 parameter is optional; the default is
16345 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16346 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16347 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16348 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16349 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16350 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16351
16352 @item get-new-mail
16353 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16354 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16355 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16356 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16357 value is @code{nil}.
16358
16359 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16360 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16361 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16362 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16363 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16364 @end table
16365
16366 @subsubsection Group parameters
16367
16368 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16369 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16370 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16371 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16372 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16373 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16374 another back end.
16375
16376 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16377 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16378 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16379 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16380 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16381 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16382 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16383 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16384 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16385
16386 @table @code
16387 @item expire-age
16388 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16389 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16390 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16391 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16392 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16393 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16394 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16395 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16396 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16397 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16398 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16399 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16400 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16401
16402 @item expire-group
16403 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16404 @example
16405 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16406 @end example
16407 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16408 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16409 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16410 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16411 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16412 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16413 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16414 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16415 article. So that form can refer to
16416 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16417 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16418 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16419 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16420
16421 @item read-only
16422 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16423 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16424 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16425 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16426 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16427 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16428 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16429 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16430 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16431 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16432 contain extra copies of the articles.
16433
16434 @item directory-files
16435 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16436 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16437 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16438 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16439
16440 @item distrust-Lines:
16441 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16442 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16443 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16444
16445 @item always-marks
16446 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16447 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16448 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16449 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16450 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16451 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16452
16453 @item never-marks
16454 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16455 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16456 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16457 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16458 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16459 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16460 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16461
16462 @item nov-cache-size
16463 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16464 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16465 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16466 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16467 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16468 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16469 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16470 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16471 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16472 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16473 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16474 @end table
16475
16476 @subsubsection Article identification
16477 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16478 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16479 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16480 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16481 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16482 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16483 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16484 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16485 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16486 request the article in the summary buffer.
16487
16488 @subsubsection NOV data
16489 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16490 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16491 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16492 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16493 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16494 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16495 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16496 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16497 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16498 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16499 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16500
16501 @subsubsection Article marks
16502 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16503 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16504 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16505 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16506 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16507 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16508 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16509 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16510
16511 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16512 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16513 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16514 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16515 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16516 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16517 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16518 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16519 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16520
16521
16522 @node Mail Folders
16523 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16524 @cindex nnfolder
16525 @cindex mbox folders
16526 @cindex mail folders
16527
16528 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16529 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16530 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16531 numbers and arrival dates.
16532
16533 Virtual server settings:
16534
16535 @table @code
16536 @item nnfolder-directory
16537 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16538 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16539 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16540 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16541
16542 @item nnfolder-active-file
16543 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16544 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16545
16546 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16547 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16548 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16549 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16550
16551 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16552 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16553 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16554 default is @code{t}
16555
16556 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16557 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16558 @cindex backup files
16559 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16560 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16561 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16562 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16563
16564 @lisp
16565 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16566 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16567
16568 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16569 @end lisp
16570
16571 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16572 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16573 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16574 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16575 extract some information from it before removing it.
16576
16577 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16578 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16579 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16580 default is @code{nil}.
16581
16582 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16583 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16584 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16585
16586 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16587 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16588 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16589 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16590
16591 @end table
16592
16593
16594 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16595 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16596 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16597 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16598 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16599 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16600 though.
16601
16602 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16603 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16604
16605 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16606 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16607 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16608 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16609 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16610
16611 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16612 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16613 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16614 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16615 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16616 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16617 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16618 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16619 via NFS).
16620
16621 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16622 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16623 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16624 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16625
16626 @table @code
16627 @item nnmbox
16628
16629 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
16630 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16631 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16632 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16633 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16634 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16635 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16636 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16637 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16638 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16639 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16640 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16641 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16642 what's where.
16643
16644 @item nnbabyl
16645
16646 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16647 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16648 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16649 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16650 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16651 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16652 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16653 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16654 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16655 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16656 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16657 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16658 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16659 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16660 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16661
16662 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16663 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16664 look at your mail.
16665
16666 @item nnml
16667
16668 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16669 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16670 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16671 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16672 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16673 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16674 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16675 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16676 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16677 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16678 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16679 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16680 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16681 provided by the active file and overviews.
16682
16683 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16684 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16685 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16686 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16687 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16688 wins big.
16689
16690 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16691 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16692 tiny files.
16693
16694 @item nnmh
16695
16696 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16697 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16698 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16699 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16700 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16701 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16702 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16703
16704 @item nnfolder
16705
16706 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16707 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16708 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16709 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16710 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16711 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16712 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16713 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16714 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16715
16716 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16717 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16718 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16719 friendly mail back end all over.
16720
16721 @item nnmaildir
16722
16723 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16724 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16725 mail back ends.
16726
16727 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16728 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16729 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16730 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16731 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16732 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16733 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16734 file system.
16735
16736 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16737 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16738 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16739 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16740 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16741 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16742 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16743 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16744 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16745 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16746 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16747
16748 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16749 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16750 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16751 else, and still have your marks.
16752
16753 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16754 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16755 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16756 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16757 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16758 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16759 removed in the future.
16760
16761 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16762 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16763 on your file system.
16764
16765 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16766 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16767
16768 @end table
16769
16770
16771 @node Browsing the Web
16772 @section Browsing the Web
16773 @cindex web
16774 @cindex browsing the web
16775 @cindex www
16776 @cindex http
16777
16778 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16779 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16780 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16781 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16782 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16783 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16784 even know what a news group is.
16785
16786 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16787 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16788 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16789 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16790 you mad in the end.
16791
16792 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16793 to do it instead?
16794
16795 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16796 interfaces to these sources.
16797
16798 @menu
16799 * Archiving Mail::
16800 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16801 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16802 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16803 @end menu
16804
16805 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16806 alternatives to work.
16807
16808 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16809 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16810 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16811 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16812 though, you should be ok.
16813
16814 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16815 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16816 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16817 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16818 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16819
16820 @node Archiving Mail
16821 @subsection Archiving Mail
16822 @cindex archiving mail
16823 @cindex backup of mail
16824
16825 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16826 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16827 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16828 marks is fairly simple.
16829
16830 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16831 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16832 though.)
16833
16834 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16835 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16836 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16837 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16838 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16839 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16840 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16841 before you restore the data.
16842
16843 @node Web Searches
16844 @subsection Web Searches
16845 @cindex nnweb
16846 @cindex Google
16847 @cindex dejanews
16848 @cindex gmane
16849 @cindex Usenet searches
16850 @cindex searching the Usenet
16851
16852 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16853 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16854 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16855 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16856 searches without having to use a browser.
16857
16858 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16859 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16860 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16861 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16862 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16863
16864 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16865 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16866 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16867 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16868 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16869 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16870 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16871 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16872 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16873 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16874 group as read.
16875
16876 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16877 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16878 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16879 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16880 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16881 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16882
16883 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16884 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16885 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16886
16887 Virtual server variables:
16888
16889 @table @code
16890 @item nnweb-type
16891 @vindex nnweb-type
16892 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16893 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16894 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16895
16896 @item nnweb-search
16897 @vindex nnweb-search
16898 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16899
16900 @item nnweb-max-hits
16901 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16902 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16903 999.
16904
16905 @item nnweb-type-definition
16906 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16907 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16908 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16909 present:
16910
16911 @table @code
16912 @item article
16913 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16914 understands.
16915
16916 @item map
16917 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16918
16919 @item search
16920 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16921
16922 @item address
16923 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16924 to.
16925
16926 @item id
16927 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16928 @end table
16929
16930 @end table
16931
16932
16933 @node RSS
16934 @subsection RSS
16935 @cindex nnrss
16936 @cindex RSS
16937
16938 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16939 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16940 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16941 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16942 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16943
16944 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16945 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16946
16947 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16948 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16949 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16950 group names.
16951
16952 @kindex G R (Group)
16953 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16954 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16955 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16956 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16957
16958 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16959 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16960 subscribe to groups.
16961
16962 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16963 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16964 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16965 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16966 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
16967 information.
16968
16969 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16970 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16971 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16972
16973 @cindex OPML
16974 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16975 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16976 Markup Language).
16977
16978 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16979 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16980 file.
16981 @end defun
16982
16983 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16984 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16985 @acronym{OPML} format.
16986 @end defun
16987
16988 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16989
16990 @table @code
16991 @item nnrss-directory
16992 @vindex nnrss-directory
16993 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16994 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16995
16996 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16997 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16998 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16999 data files. The default is the value of
17000 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17001 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17002
17003 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17004 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17005 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17006 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17007 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17008 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17009 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17010 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17011
17012 @item nnrss-use-local
17013 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17014 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17015 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17016 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17017 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17018 download script using @command{wget}.
17019 @end table
17020
17021 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17022 the summary buffer.
17023
17024 @lisp
17025 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17026 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17027
17028 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17029 (let ((descr
17030 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17031 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17032 @end lisp
17033
17034 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17035 summary buffer.
17036
17037 @lisp
17038 (require 'browse-url)
17039
17040 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17041 (interactive "p")
17042 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17043 (mail-header-extra
17044 (gnus-data-header
17045 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17046 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17047 (if url
17048 (progn
17049 (browse-url (cdr url))
17050 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17051 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17052
17053 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17054 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17055 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17056 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17057 @end lisp
17058
17059 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17060 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17061 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17062 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17063 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17064 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17065 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17066 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17067 @code{nnrss} groups:
17068
17069 @lisp
17070 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17071 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17072 '(add-to-list
17073 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17074 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17075 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17076
17077 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17078 (add-to-list
17079 'gnus-parameters
17080 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17081 @end lisp
17082
17083
17084 @node Customizing W3
17085 @subsection Customizing W3
17086 @cindex W3
17087 @cindex html
17088 @cindex url
17089 @cindex Netscape
17090
17091 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17092 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17093 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17094 users.
17095
17096 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17097 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17098 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17099
17100 @lisp
17101 (eval-after-load "w3"
17102 '(progn
17103 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17104 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17105 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17106 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17107 (browse-url url)
17108 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17109 @end lisp
17110
17111 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17112 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17113 follow the link.
17114
17115
17116 @node Other Sources
17117 @section Other Sources
17118
17119 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17120 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17121 newsgroups.
17122
17123 @menu
17124 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17125 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17126 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17127 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17128 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17129 @end menu
17130
17131
17132 @node Directory Groups
17133 @subsection Directory Groups
17134 @cindex nndir
17135 @cindex directory groups
17136
17137 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17138 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17139 names, of course.
17140
17141 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17142 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17143 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17144 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17145
17146 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17147 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17148 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17149 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17150 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17151
17152 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17153
17154 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17155 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17156 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17157 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17158
17159
17160 @node Anything Groups
17161 @subsection Anything Groups
17162 @cindex nneething
17163
17164 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17165 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17166 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17167 true.
17168
17169 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17170 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17171 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17172 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17173 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17174 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17175 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17176 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17177 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17178 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17179 elements.
17180
17181 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17182 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17183 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17184 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17185
17186 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17187 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17188 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17189 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17190
17191 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17192 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17193 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17194 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17195 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17196 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17197 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17198 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17199
17200 Some variables:
17201
17202 @table @code
17203 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17204 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17205 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17206 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17207
17208 @item nneething-exclude-files
17209 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17210 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17211 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17212
17213 @item nneething-include-files
17214 @vindex nneething-include-files
17215 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17216 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17217
17218 @item nneething-map-file
17219 @vindex nneething-map-file
17220 Name of the map files.
17221 @end table
17222
17223
17224 @node Document Groups
17225 @subsection Document Groups
17226 @cindex nndoc
17227 @cindex documentation group
17228 @cindex help group
17229
17230 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17231 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17232
17233 @table @code
17234 @cindex Babyl
17235 @item babyl
17236 The Babyl format.
17237
17238 @cindex mbox
17239 @cindex Unix mbox
17240 @item mbox
17241 The standard Unix mbox file.
17242
17243 @cindex MMDF mail box
17244 @item mmdf
17245 The MMDF mail box format.
17246
17247 @item news
17248 Several news articles appended into a file.
17249
17250 @cindex rnews batch files
17251 @item rnews
17252 The rnews batch transport format.
17253
17254 @item nsmail
17255 Netscape mail boxes.
17256
17257 @item mime-parts
17258 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17259
17260 @item standard-digest
17261 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17262
17263 @item mime-digest
17264 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17265
17266 @item lanl-gov-announce
17267 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17268
17269 @cindex git commit messages
17270 @item git
17271 @code{git} commit messages.
17272
17273 @cindex forwarded messages
17274 @item rfc822-forward
17275 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17276
17277 @item outlook
17278 The Outlook mail box.
17279
17280 @item oe-dbx
17281 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17282
17283 @item exim-bounce
17284 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17285
17286 @item forward
17287 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17288
17289 @item rfc934
17290 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17291
17292 @item mailman
17293 A mailman digest.
17294
17295 @item clari-briefs
17296 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17297
17298 @item slack-digest
17299 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17300
17301 @item mail-in-mail
17302 The last resort.
17303 @end table
17304
17305 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17306 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17307 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17308 file is.
17309
17310 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17311 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17312 group. And that's it.
17313
17314 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17315 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17316 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17317 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17318 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17319 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17320 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17321 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17322 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17323 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17324
17325 Virtual server variables:
17326
17327 @table @code
17328 @item nndoc-article-type
17329 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17330 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17331 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17332 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17333 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17334 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17335
17336 @item nndoc-post-type
17337 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17338 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17339 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17340 and @code{news}.
17341 @end table
17342
17343 @menu
17344 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17345 @end menu
17346
17347
17348 @node Document Server Internals
17349 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17350
17351 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17352 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17353 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17354 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17355
17356 First, here's an example document type definition:
17357
17358 @example
17359 (mmdf
17360 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17361 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17362 @end example
17363
17364 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17365 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17366 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17367 types can be defined with very few settings:
17368
17369 @table @code
17370 @item first-article
17371 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17372 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17373 totally ignored.
17374
17375 @item article-begin
17376 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17377 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17378 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17379 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17380
17381 @item article-begin-function
17382 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17383 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17384
17385 @item head-begin
17386 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17387 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17388 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17389
17390 @item head-begin-function
17391 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17392 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17393
17394 @item head-end
17395 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17396 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17397
17398 @item body-begin
17399 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17400 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17401 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17402
17403 @item body-begin-function
17404 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17405 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17406
17407 @item body-end
17408 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17409 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17410 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17411
17412 @item body-end-function
17413 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17414 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17415
17416 @item file-begin
17417 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17418 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17419
17420 @item file-end
17421 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17422 regexp will be totally ignored.
17423
17424 @end table
17425
17426 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17427 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17428 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17429 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17430 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17431
17432 @table @code
17433 @item prepare-body-function
17434 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17435 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17436 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17437
17438 @item article-transform-function
17439 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17440 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17441 body of the article.
17442
17443 @item generate-head-function
17444 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17445 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17446 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17447 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17448
17449 @item generate-article-function
17450 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17451 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17452 parameter when requesting all articles.
17453
17454 @item dissection-function
17455 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17456 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17457 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17458 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17459 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17460 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17461
17462 @end table
17463
17464 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17465 digests:
17466
17467 @example
17468 (standard-digest
17469 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17470 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17471 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17472 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17473 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17474 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17475 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17476 (subtype digest guess))
17477 @end example
17478
17479 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17480 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17481 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17482 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17483 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17484
17485 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17486 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17487 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17488 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17489 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17490 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17491 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17492 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17493 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17494 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17495 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17496 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17497
17498
17499 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17500 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17501 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17502 @cindex gateways
17503
17504 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17505 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17506 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17507
17508 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17509 used to post with.
17510
17511 Server variables:
17512
17513 @table @code
17514 @item nngateway-address
17515 @vindex nngateway-address
17516 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17517
17518 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17519 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17520 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17521 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17522 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17523 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17524 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17525 gateway address.
17526
17527 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17528 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17529 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17530
17531 @example
17532 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17533 @end example
17534
17535 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17536
17537 @example
17538 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17539 @end example
17540
17541 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17542
17543 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17544 @table @code
17545
17546 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17547 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17548 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17549
17550 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17551
17552 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17553 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17554 @code{nngateway-address}.
17555 @end table
17556
17557 @end table
17558
17559 Here's an example:
17560
17561 @lisp
17562 (setq gnus-post-method
17563 '(nngateway
17564 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17565 (nngateway-header-transformation
17566 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17567 @end lisp
17568
17569 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17570
17571 @lisp
17572 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17573 @end lisp
17574
17575
17576 @node The Empty Backend
17577 @subsection The Empty Backend
17578 @cindex nnnil
17579
17580 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17581 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17582 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17583 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17584
17585 @lisp
17586 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17587 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17588 '((nnimap "foo")
17589 (nnml "")))
17590 @end lisp
17591
17592
17593 @node Combined Groups
17594 @section Combined Groups
17595
17596 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17597 groups.
17598
17599 @menu
17600 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17601 @end menu
17602
17603
17604 @node Virtual Groups
17605 @subsection Virtual Groups
17606 @cindex nnvirtual
17607 @cindex virtual groups
17608 @cindex merging groups
17609
17610 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17611 other groups.
17612
17613 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17614 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17615 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17616
17617 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17618 regexp to match component groups.
17619
17620 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17621 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17622 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17623 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17624 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17625 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17626 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17627 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17628
17629 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17630 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17631
17632 @lisp
17633 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17634 @end lisp
17635
17636 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17637 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17638
17639 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17640 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17641 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17642 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17643
17644 @example
17645 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17646 @end example
17647
17648 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17649 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17650 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17651
17652 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17653 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17654 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17655 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17656 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17657
17658 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17659 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17660 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17661
17662 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17663 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17664 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17665 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17666 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17667 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17668 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17669 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17670 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17671 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17672 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17673
17674 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17675 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17676 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17677 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17678 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17679 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17680 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17681
17682 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17683 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17684
17685 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17686 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17687 inherited.
17688
17689
17690 @node Email Based Diary
17691 @section Email Based Diary
17692 @cindex diary
17693 @cindex email based diary
17694 @cindex calendar
17695
17696 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17697 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17698 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17699 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17700 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17701 namely, as event reminders.
17702
17703 Here is a typical scenario:
17704
17705 @itemize @bullet
17706 @item
17707 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17708 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17709 @item
17710 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17711 @item
17712 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17713 @item
17714 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17715 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17716 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17717 @item
17718 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17719 of the night you're gonna have.
17720 @item
17721 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17722 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17723 @end itemize
17724
17725 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17726 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17727 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17728 explained in the sections below.
17729
17730 @menu
17731 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17732 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17733 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17734 @end menu
17735
17736
17737 @node The NNDiary Back End
17738 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17739 @cindex nndiary
17740 @cindex the nndiary back end
17741
17742 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17743 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17744 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17745 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17746 directory per group.
17747
17748 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17749 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17750 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17751 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17752
17753 @menu
17754 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17755 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17756 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17757 @end menu
17758
17759 @node Diary Messages
17760 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17761 @cindex nndiary messages
17762 @cindex nndiary mails
17763
17764 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17765 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17766 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17767 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17768 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17769 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17770 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17771
17772 @itemize @bullet
17773 @item
17774 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17775 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17776 (separated by a comma).
17777 @item
17778 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17779 @item
17780 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17781 @item
17782 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17783 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17784 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17785 @item
17786 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17787 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17788 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17789 @item
17790 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17791 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17792 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17793 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17794 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17795 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17796 @end itemize
17797
17798 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17799 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17800 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17801 what to do then):
17802
17803 @example
17804 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17805 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17806 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17807 X-Diary-Month: *
17808 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17809 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17810 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17811 @end example
17812
17813 @node Running NNDiary
17814 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17815 @cindex running nndiary
17816 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17817
17818 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17819 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17820 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17821 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17822 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17823 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17824
17825 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17826 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17827 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17828 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17829 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17830 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17831 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17832 mode.
17833
17834 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17835 things to do:
17836
17837 @itemize @bullet
17838 @item
17839 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17840 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17841
17842 @lisp
17843 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17844 @end lisp
17845 @item
17846 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17847 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17848 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17849 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17850 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17851
17852 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17853 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17854
17855 @example
17856 :0 HD :
17857 * ^X-Diary
17858 .nndiary
17859 @end example
17860 @end itemize
17861
17862 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17863 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17864
17865 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17866 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17867 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17868 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17869 @end defvar
17870
17871 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17872 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17873 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17874 @end defvar
17875
17876 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17877 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17878 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17879
17880 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17881 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17882 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17883 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17884 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17885
17886 @node Customizing NNDiary
17887 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17888 @cindex customizing nndiary
17889 @cindex nndiary customization
17890
17891 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17892 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17893 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17894 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17895
17896 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17897 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17898 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17899 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17900 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17901 mail.
17902 @end defvar
17903
17904 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17905 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17906 default).
17907 @end defvar
17908
17909
17910 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17911 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17912 @cindex gnus-diary
17913 @cindex the gnus diary library
17914
17915 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17916 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17917 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17918 useful things for you.
17919
17920 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17921
17922 @lisp
17923 (require 'gnus-diary)
17924 @end lisp
17925
17926 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17927 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17928 (sorry if you used them before).
17929
17930
17931 @menu
17932 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17933 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17934 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17935 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17936 @end menu
17937
17938 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17939 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17940 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17941 @cindex diary summary line format
17942
17943 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17944 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17945 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17946 see the event's date.
17947
17948 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17949 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17950 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17951 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17952 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17953
17954 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17955 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17956 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17957
17958 @example
17959 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17960 @end example
17961
17962 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
17963 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
17964
17965 @lisp
17966 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
17967 @end lisp
17968
17969 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
17970 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
17971 with the following user options:
17972
17973 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
17974 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
17975 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
17976 diary groups'parameters.
17977 @end defvar
17978
17979 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
17980 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
17981 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
17982 @end defvar
17983
17984 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
17985 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
17986 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
17987 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
17988 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
17989 @end defvar
17990
17991 @node Diary Articles Sorting
17992 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
17993 @cindex diary articles sorting
17994 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
17995 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
17996 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
17997 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
17998
17999 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18000 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18001 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18002 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18003 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18004
18005 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18006 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18007 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18008 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18009 Parameters}).
18010
18011 @node Diary Headers Generation
18012 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18013 @cindex diary headers generation
18014 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18015
18016 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18017 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18018 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18019 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18020 needed.
18021
18022 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18023 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18024 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18025 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18026 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18027
18028 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18029 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18030 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18031 instance.
18032
18033 @node Diary Group Parameters
18034 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18035 @cindex diary group parameters
18036
18037 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18038 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18039 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18040 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18041 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18042 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18043 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18044 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18045
18046 @node Sending or Not Sending
18047 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18048
18049 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18050 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18051
18052 @itemize @bullet
18053 @item
18054 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18055 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18056 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18057 sending the diary message to them as well.
18058 @item
18059 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18060 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18061 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18062 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18063 @end itemize
18064
18065 @node Gnus Unplugged
18066 @section Gnus Unplugged
18067 @cindex offline
18068 @cindex unplugged
18069 @cindex agent
18070 @cindex Gnus agent
18071 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18072
18073 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18074 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18075 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18076 read news. Believe it or not.
18077
18078 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18079 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18080 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18081 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18082 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18083
18084 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18085 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18086 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18087 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18088 reading news on a machine.
18089
18090 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18091 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18092 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18093
18094 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18095
18096 @menu
18097 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18098 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18099 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18100 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18101 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18102 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18103 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18104 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18105 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18106 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18107 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18108 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18109 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18110 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18111 @end menu
18112
18113
18114 @node Agent Basics
18115 @subsection Agent Basics
18116
18117 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18118
18119 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18120 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18121 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18122 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18123
18124 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18125 connected to the net continuously.
18126
18127 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18128 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18129
18130 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18131 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18132 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18133 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18134 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18135
18136 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18137 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18138 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18139 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18140 they're kinda like plugged always).
18141
18142 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18143 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18144 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18145 the culprit.
18146
18147 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18148 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18149 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18150 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18151 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18152
18153 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18154
18155 @itemize @bullet
18156
18157 @item
18158 @findex gnus-unplugged
18159 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18160 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18161 already fetched while in this mode.
18162
18163 @item
18164 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18165 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18166 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18167 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18168 Source Specifiers}).
18169
18170 @item
18171 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18172 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18173 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18174 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18175 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18176
18177 @item
18178 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18179 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18180 then you read the news offline.
18181
18182 @item
18183 And then you go to step 2.
18184 @end itemize
18185
18186 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18187 the Agent.
18188
18189 @itemize @bullet
18190
18191 @item
18192 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18193 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18194 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18195 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18196 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18197 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18198 no servers are agentized.
18199
18200 @item
18201 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18202 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18203 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18204 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18205
18206 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18207 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18208 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18209 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18210 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18211 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18212 configure them.
18213
18214 @item
18215 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18216 @end itemize
18217
18218
18219 @node Agent Categories
18220 @subsection Agent Categories
18221
18222 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18223 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18224 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18225 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18226 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18227 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18228 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18229
18230 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18231 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18232 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18233 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18234 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18235
18236 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18237 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18238 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18239 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18240 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18241 sink.
18242
18243 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18244 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18245 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18246 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18247 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18248 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18249 your settings.
18250
18251 @menu
18252 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18253 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18254 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18255 @end menu
18256
18257
18258 @node Category Syntax
18259 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18260
18261 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18262 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18263 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18264 listed below.
18265
18266 @cindex Agent Parameters
18267 @table @code
18268 @item agent-groups
18269 The list of groups that are in this category.
18270
18271 @item agent-predicate
18272 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18273 are eligible for downloading; and
18274
18275 @item agent-score
18276 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18277 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18278 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18279
18280 @item agent-enable-expiration
18281 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18282 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18283 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18284 only groups that should not be expired.
18285
18286 @item agent-days-until-old
18287 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18288 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18289
18290 @item agent-low-score
18291 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18292
18293 @item agent-high-score
18294 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18295
18296 @item agent-short-article
18297 an integer that overrides the value of
18298 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18299
18300 @item agent-long-article
18301 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18302
18303 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18304 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18305 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18306 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18307 undownloaded faces.
18308 @end table
18309
18310 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18311 created.
18312
18313 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18314 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18315 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18316 category.
18317
18318 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18319 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18320 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18321 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18322
18323 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18324 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18325 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18326
18327 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18328 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18329 operators sprinkled in between.
18330
18331 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18332
18333 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18334 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18335
18336 @lisp
18337 short
18338 @end lisp
18339
18340 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18341 short (for some value of ``short'').
18342
18343 Here's a more complex predicate:
18344
18345 @lisp
18346 (or high
18347 (and
18348 (not low)
18349 (not long)))
18350 @end lisp
18351
18352 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18353 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18354 drift.
18355
18356 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18357 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18358 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18359
18360 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18361 you want to do, you can write your own.
18362
18363 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18364 bound to the value determined by calling
18365 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18366 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18367 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18368 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18369 predicate to individual groups.
18370
18371 @table @code
18372 @item short
18373 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18374 lines; default 100.
18375
18376 @item long
18377 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18378 lines; default 200.
18379
18380 @item low
18381 True if the article has a download score less than
18382 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18383
18384 @item high
18385 True if the article has a download score greater than
18386 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18387
18388 @item spam
18389 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18390 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18391 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18392
18393 @item true
18394 Always true.
18395
18396 @item false
18397 Always false.
18398 @end table
18399
18400 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18401 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18402 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18403 useful values.
18404
18405 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18406 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18407 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18408 something along the lines of the following:
18409
18410 @lisp
18411 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18412 "Say whether an article is old."
18413 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18414 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18415 @end lisp
18416
18417 with the predicate then defined as:
18418
18419 @lisp
18420 (not my-article-old-p)
18421 @end lisp
18422
18423 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18424 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18425 wherever.
18426
18427 @lisp
18428 (require 'gnus-agent)
18429 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18430 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18431 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18432 @end lisp
18433
18434 and simply specify your predicate as:
18435
18436 @lisp
18437 (not old)
18438 @end lisp
18439
18440 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18441 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18442 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18443 just don't give a damn.
18444
18445 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18446 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18447 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18448 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18449 parameters like so:
18450
18451 @lisp
18452 (agent-predicate . short)
18453 @end lisp
18454
18455 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18456 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18457 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18458
18459 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18460
18461 @lisp
18462 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18463 @end lisp
18464
18465 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18466 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18467 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18468
18469
18470 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18471 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18472 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18473 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18474 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18475 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18476
18477 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18478 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18479 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18480 if it's to be specific to that group.
18481
18482 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18483 three forms:
18484
18485 @enumerate
18486 @item
18487 Score rule
18488
18489 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18490 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18491
18492 example:
18493
18494 @itemize @bullet
18495 @item
18496 Category specification
18497
18498 @lisp
18499 (("from"
18500 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18501 ("lines"
18502 (500 -100 nil <)))
18503 @end lisp
18504
18505 @item
18506 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18507
18508 @lisp
18509 (agent-score ("from"
18510 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18511 ("lines"
18512 (500 -100 nil <)))
18513 @end lisp
18514
18515 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18516 @end itemize
18517
18518 @item
18519 Agent score file
18520
18521 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18522 keywords stated above.
18523
18524 example:
18525
18526 @itemize @bullet
18527 @item
18528 Category specification
18529
18530 @lisp
18531 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18532 @end lisp
18533
18534 or perhaps
18535
18536 @lisp
18537 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18538 @end lisp
18539
18540 @item
18541 Group Parameter specification
18542
18543 @lisp
18544 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18545 @end lisp
18546
18547 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18548 about parenthesis?
18549 @end itemize
18550
18551 @item
18552 Use @code{normal} score files
18553
18554 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18555 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18556 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18557 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18558
18559 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18560 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18561 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18562 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18563
18564 @itemize @bullet
18565 @item
18566 Category Specification
18567
18568 @lisp
18569 file
18570 @end lisp
18571
18572 @item
18573 Group Parameter specification
18574
18575 @lisp
18576 (agent-score . file)
18577 @end lisp
18578 @end itemize
18579 @end enumerate
18580
18581 @node Category Buffer
18582 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18583
18584 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18585 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18586 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18587
18588 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18589
18590 @table @kbd
18591 @item q
18592 @kindex q (Category)
18593 @findex gnus-category-exit
18594 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18595
18596 @item e
18597 @kindex e (Category)
18598 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18599 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18600 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18601
18602 @item k
18603 @kindex k (Category)
18604 @findex gnus-category-kill
18605 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18606
18607 @item c
18608 @kindex c (Category)
18609 @findex gnus-category-copy
18610 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18611
18612 @item a
18613 @kindex a (Category)
18614 @findex gnus-category-add
18615 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18616
18617 @item p
18618 @kindex p (Category)
18619 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18620 Edit the predicate of the current category
18621 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18622
18623 @item g
18624 @kindex g (Category)
18625 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18626 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18627 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18628
18629 @item s
18630 @kindex s (Category)
18631 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18632 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18633 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18634
18635 @item l
18636 @kindex l (Category)
18637 @findex gnus-category-list
18638 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18639 @end table
18640
18641
18642 @node Category Variables
18643 @subsubsection Category Variables
18644
18645 @table @code
18646 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18647 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18648 Hook run in category buffers.
18649
18650 @item gnus-category-line-format
18651 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18652 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18653 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18654
18655 @table @samp
18656 @item c
18657 The name of the category.
18658
18659 @item g
18660 The number of groups in the category.
18661 @end table
18662
18663 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18664 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18665 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18666
18667 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18668 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18669 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18670
18671 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18672 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18673 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18674
18675 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18676 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18677 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18678 0.
18679
18680 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18681 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18682 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18683 0.
18684
18685 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18686 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18687 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18688 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18689 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18690 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18691 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18692 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18693 read.
18694 Default 7.
18695
18696 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18697 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18698 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18699 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18700 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18701 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18702 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18703
18704 @end table
18705
18706
18707 @node Agent Commands
18708 @subsection Agent Commands
18709 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18710 @kindex J j (Agent)
18711
18712 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18713 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18714 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18715
18716
18717 @menu
18718 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18719 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18720 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18721 @end menu
18722
18723
18724
18725
18726 @node Group Agent Commands
18727 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18728
18729 @table @kbd
18730 @item J u
18731 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18732 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18733 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18734 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18735
18736 @item J c
18737 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18738 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18739 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18740
18741 @item J s
18742 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18743 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18744 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18745 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18746
18747 @item J S
18748 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18749 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18750 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18751 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18752
18753 @item J a
18754 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18755 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18756 Add the current group to an Agent category
18757 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18758 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18759
18760 @item J r
18761 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18762 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18763 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18764 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18765 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18766
18767 @item J Y
18768 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18769 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18770 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18771
18772
18773 @end table
18774
18775
18776 @node Summary Agent Commands
18777 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18778
18779 @table @kbd
18780 @item J #
18781 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18782 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18783 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18784
18785 @item J M-#
18786 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18787 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18788 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18789 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18790
18791 @cindex %
18792 @item @@
18793 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18794 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18795 Toggle whether to download the article
18796 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18797 default.
18798
18799 @item J c
18800 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18801 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18802 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18803
18804 @item J S
18805 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18806 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18807 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18808 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18809
18810 @item J s
18811 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18812 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18813 Download all processable articles in this group.
18814 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18815
18816 @item J u
18817 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18818 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18819 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18820 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18821
18822 @end table
18823
18824
18825 @node Server Agent Commands
18826 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18827
18828 @table @kbd
18829 @item J a
18830 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18831 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18832 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18833 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18834
18835 @item J r
18836 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18837 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18838 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18839 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18840
18841 @end table
18842
18843
18844 @node Agent Visuals
18845 @subsection Agent Visuals
18846
18847 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18848 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18849 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18850 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18851 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18852 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18853 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18854 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18855 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18856 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18857
18858 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18859 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18860 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18861 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18862 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18863 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18864 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18865 articles will be available when unplugged.
18866
18867 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18868 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18869 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18870 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18871 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18872 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18873 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18874 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18875
18876 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18877 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18878 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18879 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18880 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18881 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18882 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18883 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18884 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18885
18886 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18887 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18888 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18889 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18890 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18891 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18892 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18893 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18894 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18895 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18896
18897 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18898 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18899 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18900 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18901 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18902 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18903
18904 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18905 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18906 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18907 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18908 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18909 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18910 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18911 expiring'' articles.
18912
18913 @node Agent as Cache
18914 @subsection Agent as Cache
18915
18916 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18917 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18918 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18919 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18920 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18921 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18922 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18923 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18924 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18925
18926 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18927 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18928 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18929 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18930 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18931
18932 @node Agent Expiry
18933 @subsection Agent Expiry
18934
18935 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18936 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18937 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18938 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18939 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18940 @cindex agent expiry
18941 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18942 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18943
18944 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18945 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18946 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18947 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18948 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18949 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18950 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18951 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18952
18953 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18954 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18955
18956 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18957 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18958
18959 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18960 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18961 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18962 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18963 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18964 be kept indefinitely.
18965
18966 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18967 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18968 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18969 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18970
18971 @node Agent Regeneration
18972 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18973
18974 @cindex agent regeneration
18975 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18976 @cindex regeneration
18977
18978 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18979 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18980 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18981 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18982 internal inconsistencies.
18983
18984 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18985 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18986 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18987 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18988 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18989 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18990
18991 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18992 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18993 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18994 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18995 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18996 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18997
18998 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18999 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19000 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19001 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19002 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19003 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19004 agent as unread.
19005
19006 @node Agent and flags
19007 @subsection Agent and flags
19008
19009 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19010 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
19011 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19012 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19013 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19014 to the flags in its own files.
19015
19016 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19017 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19018 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19019
19020 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19021 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19022 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19023 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19024 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19025 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19026
19027 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19028 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19029 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19030 in the group buffer.
19031
19032 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19033 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19034 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19035 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19036 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19037 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19038 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19039 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19040
19041 @node Agent and IMAP
19042 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19043
19044 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19045 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19046 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19047 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19048
19049 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19050 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19051
19052 @itemize @bullet
19053
19054 @item
19055 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19056
19057 @item
19058 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19059
19060 @end itemize
19061
19062 @node Outgoing Messages
19063 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19064
19065 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19066 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19067 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19068
19069 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19070 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19071 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19072
19073 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19074 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19075 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19076 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19077 mail at any time.
19078
19079 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19080 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19081 ask you to confirm your action (see
19082 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19083
19084 @node Agent Variables
19085 @subsection Agent Variables
19086
19087 @table @code
19088 @item gnus-agent
19089 @vindex gnus-agent
19090 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19091 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19092 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19093 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19094
19095 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19096 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19097
19098
19099 @item gnus-agent-directory
19100 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19101 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19102 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19103
19104 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19105 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19106 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19107 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19108 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19109 by default.
19110
19111 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19112 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19113 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19114
19115 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19116 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19117 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19118
19119 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19120 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19121 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19122
19123 @item gnus-agent-cache
19124 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19125 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19126 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19127 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19128
19129 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19130 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19131 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19132 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19133 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19134 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19135 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19136 online status.
19137
19138 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19139 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19140 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19141 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19142 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19143 read. The default is @code{t}.
19144
19145 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19146 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19147 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19148 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19149 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19150 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19151 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19152
19153 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19154 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19155 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19156 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19157 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19158 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19159 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19160 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19161 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19162 over and over again.
19163
19164 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19165 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19166 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19167 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19168 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19169 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19170 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19171 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19172 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19173 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19174 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19175 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19176 see any cycling.
19177
19178 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19179 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19180 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19181 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19182 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19183 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19184 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19185 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19186 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19187
19188 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19189 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19190 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19191 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19192 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19193 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19194
19195 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19196 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19197 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19198 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19199 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19200
19201 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19202 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19203 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19204 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19205 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19206 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19207
19208 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19209 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19210 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19211 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19212 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19213
19214 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19215 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19216 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19217 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19218 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19219 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19220 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19221 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19222 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19223 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19224 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19225
19226 @end table
19227
19228
19229 @node Example Setup
19230 @subsection Example Setup
19231
19232 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19233 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19234 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19235
19236 @lisp
19237 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19238 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19239 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19240
19241 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19242 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19243 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19244
19245 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19246 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19247
19248 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19249 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19250 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19251 @end lisp
19252
19253 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19254 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19255 gnus}.
19256
19257 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19258 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19259 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19260 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19261 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19262 once.
19263
19264 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19265 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19266 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19267 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19268 back all the killed groups.)
19269
19270 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19271 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19272 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19273
19274
19275 @node Batching Agents
19276 @subsection Batching Agents
19277 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19278
19279 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19280 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19281 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19282
19283 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19284 following incantation:
19285
19286 @example
19287 #!/bin/sh
19288 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19289 @end example
19290
19291
19292 @node Agent Caveats
19293 @subsection Agent Caveats
19294
19295 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19296 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19297 may ask:
19298
19299 @table @dfn
19300 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19301
19302 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19303 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19304 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19305
19306 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19307 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19308
19309 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19310
19311 @end table
19312
19313 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19314 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19315 locally stored articles.
19316
19317
19318 @node Scoring
19319 @chapter Scoring
19320 @cindex scoring
19321
19322 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19323 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19324 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19325 attention!
19326
19327 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19328 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19329 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19330 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19331 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19332
19333 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19334 before generating the summary buffer.
19335
19336 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19337 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19338 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19339
19340 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19341 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19342 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19343 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19344
19345 @menu
19346 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19347 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19348 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19349 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19350 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19351 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19352 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19353 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19354 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19355 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19356 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19357 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19358 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19359 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19360 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19361 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19362 @end menu
19363
19364
19365 @node Summary Score Commands
19366 @section Summary Score Commands
19367 @cindex score commands
19368
19369 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19370 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19371 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19372 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19373 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19374
19375 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19376 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19377 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19378 score file the current one.
19379
19380 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19381
19382 @table @kbd
19383
19384 @item V s
19385 @kindex V s (Summary)
19386 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19387 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19388
19389 @item V S
19390 @kindex V S (Summary)
19391 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19392 Display the score of the current article
19393 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19394
19395 @item V t
19396 @kindex V t (Summary)
19397 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19398 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19399 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19400 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19401 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19402 score file and edit it.
19403
19404 @item V w
19405 @kindex V w (Summary)
19406 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19407 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19408
19409 @item V R
19410 @kindex V R (Summary)
19411 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19412 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19413 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19414 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19415 effect you're having.
19416
19417 @item V c
19418 @kindex V c (Summary)
19419 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19420 Make a different score file the current
19421 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19422
19423 @item V e
19424 @kindex V e (Summary)
19425 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19426 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19427 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19428 File Editing}).
19429
19430 @item V f
19431 @kindex V f (Summary)
19432 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19433 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19434 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19435
19436 @item V F
19437 @kindex V F (Summary)
19438 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19439 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19440 after editing score files.
19441
19442 @item V C
19443 @kindex V C (Summary)
19444 @findex gnus-score-customize
19445 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19446 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19447
19448 @end table
19449
19450 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19451
19452 @table @kbd
19453
19454 @item V m
19455 @kindex V m (Summary)
19456 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19457 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19458 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19459
19460 @item V x
19461 @kindex V x (Summary)
19462 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19463 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19464 expunge all articles below this score
19465 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19466 @end table
19467
19468 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19469 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19470 them.)
19471
19472 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19473 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19474
19475 @enumerate
19476 @item
19477 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19478 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19479 @item
19480 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19481 keys are available:
19482 @table @kbd
19483
19484 @item a
19485 Score on the author name.
19486
19487 @item s
19488 Score on the subject line.
19489
19490 @item x
19491 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19492
19493 @item r
19494 Score on the @code{References} line.
19495
19496 @item d
19497 Score on the date.
19498
19499 @item l
19500 Score on the number of lines.
19501
19502 @item i
19503 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19504
19505 @item e
19506 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19507 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19508
19509 @item f
19510 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19511 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19512 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19513
19514 @item b
19515 Score on the body.
19516
19517 @item h
19518 Score on the head.
19519
19520 @item t
19521 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19522 files.)
19523
19524 @end table
19525
19526 @item
19527 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19528 what headers you are scoring on.
19529
19530 @table @code
19531
19532 @item strings
19533
19534 @table @kbd
19535
19536 @item e
19537 Exact matching.
19538
19539 @item s
19540 Substring matching.
19541
19542 @item f
19543 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19544
19545 @item r
19546 Regexp matching
19547 @end table
19548
19549 @item date
19550 @table @kbd
19551
19552 @item b
19553 Before date.
19554
19555 @item a
19556 After date.
19557
19558 @item n
19559 This date.
19560 @end table
19561
19562 @item number
19563 @table @kbd
19564
19565 @item <
19566 Less than number.
19567
19568 @item =
19569 Equal to number.
19570
19571 @item >
19572 Greater than number.
19573 @end table
19574 @end table
19575
19576 @item
19577 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19578 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19579 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19580 file.
19581 @table @kbd
19582
19583 @item t
19584 Temporary score entry.
19585
19586 @item p
19587 Permanent score entry.
19588
19589 @item i
19590 Immediately scoring.
19591 @end table
19592
19593 @item
19594 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19595 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19596 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19597
19598 @end enumerate
19599
19600 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19601 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19602 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19603 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19604
19605 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19606 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19607 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19608 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19609 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19610
19611 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19612 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19613 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19614 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19615 current score file.
19616
19617 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19618 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19619 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19620
19621
19622 @node Group Score Commands
19623 @section Group Score Commands
19624 @cindex group score commands
19625
19626 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19627
19628 @table @kbd
19629
19630 @item W e
19631 @kindex W e (Group)
19632 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19633 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19634 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19635
19636 @item W f
19637 @kindex W f (Group)
19638 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19639 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19640 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19641 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19642
19643 @end table
19644
19645 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19646
19647 @findex gnus-batch-score
19648 @cindex batch scoring
19649 @example
19650 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19651 @end example
19652
19653
19654 @node Score Variables
19655 @section Score Variables
19656 @cindex score variables
19657
19658 @table @code
19659
19660 @item gnus-use-scoring
19661 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19662 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19663 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19664
19665 @item gnus-kill-killed
19666 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19667 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19668 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19669 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19670 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19671 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19672 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19673
19674 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19675 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19676 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19677 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19678 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19679
19680 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19681 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19682 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19683 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19684
19685 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19686 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19687 @cindex score cache
19688 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19689 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19690 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19691 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19692 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19693 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19694 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19695 be cached.
19696
19697 @item gnus-save-score
19698 @vindex gnus-save-score
19699 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19700 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19701 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19702
19703 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19704 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19705 across group visits.
19706
19707 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19708 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19709 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19710 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19711 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19712 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19713 manually entered data.
19714
19715 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19716 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19717 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19718
19719 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19720 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19721 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19722 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19723 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19724 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19725
19726 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19727 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19728 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19729 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19730
19731 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19732 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19733 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19734 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19735
19736 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19737 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19738 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19739 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19740
19741 Predefined functions available are:
19742 @table @code
19743
19744 @item gnus-score-find-single
19745 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19746 Only apply the group's own score file.
19747
19748 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19749 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19750 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19751 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19752 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19753 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19754 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19755 then a regexp match is done.
19756
19757 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19758 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19759
19760 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19761 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19762 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19763 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19764
19765 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19766 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19767 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19768 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19769 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19770 server.
19771
19772 @end table
19773 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19774 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19775 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19776 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19777 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19778 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19779 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19780 Phu.
19781
19782 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19783 overall score file, you could use the value
19784 @example
19785 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19786 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19787 @end example
19788
19789 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19790 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19791 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19792 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19793 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19794
19795 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19796 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19797 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19798 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19799 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19800 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19801 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19802 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19803
19804 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19805 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19806 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19807
19808 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19809 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19810 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19811 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19812 threading---according to the current value of
19813 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19814 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19815 simplified in this manner.
19816
19817 @end table
19818
19819
19820 @node Score File Format
19821 @section Score File Format
19822 @cindex score file format
19823
19824 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19825 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19826 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19827
19828 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19829
19830 @lisp
19831 (("from"
19832 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19833 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19834 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19835 ("subject"
19836 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19837 ("xref"
19838 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19839 ("lines"
19840 (2 -100 nil <))
19841 (mark 0)
19842 (expunge -1000)
19843 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19844 (read-only nil)
19845 (orphan -10)
19846 (adapt t)
19847 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19848 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19849 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19850 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19851 (eval (ding)))
19852 @end lisp
19853
19854 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19855 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19856
19857 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19858 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19859 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19860
19861 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19862
19863 @table @code
19864
19865 @item STRING
19866 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19867 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19868 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19869 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19870 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19871 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19872 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19873 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19874 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19875 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19876 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19877 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19878 to articles that matches these score entries.
19879
19880 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19881 score entry has one to four elements.
19882 @enumerate
19883
19884 @item
19885 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19886 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19887 integer.
19888
19889 @item
19890 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19891 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19892 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19893 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19894 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19895 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19896
19897 @item
19898 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19899 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19900 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19901 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19902 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19903
19904 @item
19905 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19906 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19907 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19908 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19909 @table @dfn
19910
19911 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19912 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19913 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19914 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19915 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19916 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19917 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19918 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19919 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19920 instead, if you feel like.
19921
19922 @item Extra
19923 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19924 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19925 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19926 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19927 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19928 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19929 overviews:
19930
19931 @lisp
19932 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19933 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19934 @end lisp
19935
19936 @item Lines, Chars
19937 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19938 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19939
19940 These predicates are true if
19941
19942 @example
19943 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19944 @end example
19945
19946 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19947 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19948 following form:
19949
19950 @lisp
19951 (< header-value 4)
19952 @end lisp
19953
19954 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19955 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19956 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19957 it's not. I think.)
19958
19959 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19960 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19961 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19962 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19963
19964 @item Date
19965 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19966 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19967 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19968 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19969 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19970 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19971 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19972
19973 @cindex ISO8601
19974 @cindex date
19975 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19976 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19977 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19978 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19979 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19980 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19981 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19982 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19983 whole family, eh?)
19984
19985 @item Head, Body, All
19986 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19987 header uses.
19988
19989 @item Followup
19990 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19991 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19992 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19993 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19994 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19995 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19996 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19997 files.)
19998
19999 @item Thread
20000 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20001 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20002 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20003 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20004 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20005 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20006 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20007 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20008 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20009 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20010 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20011 @end table
20012 @end enumerate
20013
20014 @cindex score file atoms
20015 @item mark
20016 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20017 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20018
20019 @item expunge
20020 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20021 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20022
20023 @item mark-and-expunge
20024 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20025 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20026 summary buffer.
20027
20028 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20029 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20030 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20031 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20032 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20033
20034 @item files
20035 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20036 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20037 this one was.
20038
20039 @item exclude-files
20040 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20041 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20042 other.
20043
20044 @item eval
20045 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20046 ignored when handling global score files.
20047
20048 @item read-only
20049 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20050 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20051 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20052 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20053
20054 @item orphan
20055 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20056 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20057 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20058 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20059
20060 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20061
20062 @example
20063 (orphan -500)
20064 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20065 @end example
20066
20067 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20068 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20069 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20070 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20071 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20072
20073 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20074 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20075 scoring rules exist.
20076
20077 @item adapt
20078 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20079 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20080 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20081 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20082 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20083 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20084 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20085 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20086 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20087 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20088 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20089 it.
20090
20091 @item adapt-file
20092 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20093 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20094 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20095 file for a number of groups.
20096
20097 @item local
20098 @cindex local variables
20099 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20100 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20101 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20102 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20103 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20104 be evaluated.
20105 @end table
20106
20107
20108 @node Score File Editing
20109 @section Score File Editing
20110
20111 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20112 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20113 with a mode for that.
20114
20115 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20116 additional commands:
20117
20118 @table @kbd
20119
20120 @item C-c C-c
20121 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20122 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20123 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20124 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20125
20126 @item C-c C-d
20127 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20128 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20129 Insert the current date in numerical format
20130 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20131 you were wondering.
20132
20133 @item C-c C-p
20134 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20135 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20136 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20137 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20138 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20139 you.
20140
20141 @end table
20142
20143 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20144
20145 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20146 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20147
20148 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20149 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20150
20151
20152 @node Adaptive Scoring
20153 @section Adaptive Scoring
20154 @cindex adaptive scoring
20155
20156 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20157 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20158 stupidity, to be precise.
20159
20160 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20161 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20162 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20163 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20164 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20165 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20166 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20167 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20168 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20169
20170 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20171 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20172 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20173 might look something like this:
20174
20175 @lisp
20176 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20177 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20178 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20179 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20180 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20181 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20182 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20183 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20184 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20185 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20186 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20187 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20188 @end lisp
20189
20190 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20191 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20192 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20193 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20194 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20195 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20196 entries.
20197
20198 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20199 will be applied to each article.
20200
20201 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20202 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20203 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20204 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20205
20206 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20207 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20208 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20209 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20210
20211 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20212 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20213 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20214 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20215
20216 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20217 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20218 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20219 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20220 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20221 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20222
20223 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20224 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20225 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20226
20227 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20228 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20229 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20230
20231 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20232 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20233 let you use different rules in different groups.
20234
20235 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20236 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20237 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20238 is @file{ADAPT}.
20239
20240 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20241 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20242 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20243 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20244
20245 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20246 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20247 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20248 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20249 the length of the match is less than
20250 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20251 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20252 this problem.
20253
20254 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20255 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20256 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20257 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20258 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20259
20260 @lisp
20261 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20262 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20263 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20264 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20265 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20266 @end lisp
20267
20268 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20269 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20270 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20271 score with 30 points.
20272
20273 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20274 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20275 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20276 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20277 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20278
20279 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20280 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20281 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20282 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20283 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20284
20285 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20286 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20287 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20288 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20289
20290 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20291 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20292 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20293 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20294
20295 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20296 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20297 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20298 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20299 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20300
20301 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20302 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20303 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20304
20305 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20306 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20307 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20308 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20309
20310
20311 @node Home Score File
20312 @section Home Score File
20313
20314 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20315 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20316 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20317 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20318
20319 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20320 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20321 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20322
20323 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20324 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20325 be:
20326
20327 @enumerate
20328 @item
20329 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20330 groups.
20331
20332 @item
20333 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20334 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20335 parameter.
20336
20337 @item
20338 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20339
20340 @enumerate
20341 @item
20342 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20343 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20344
20345 @item
20346 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20347 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20348 name of the group as the parameter.
20349
20350 @item
20351 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20352 @end enumerate
20353
20354 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20355 for matches.
20356
20357 @end enumerate
20358
20359 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20360
20361 @lisp
20362 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20363 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20364 @end lisp
20365
20366 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20367 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20368
20369 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20370 @lisp
20371 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20372 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20373 @end lisp
20374
20375 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20376 Other functions include
20377
20378 @table @code
20379 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20380 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20381 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20382 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20383
20384 @end table
20385
20386 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20387 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20388 their own home score files:
20389
20390 @lisp
20391 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20392 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20393 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20394 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20395 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20396 @end lisp
20397
20398 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20399 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20400 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20401 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20402 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20403
20404 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20405 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20406 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20407 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20408 precedence over this variable.
20409
20410
20411 @node Followups To Yourself
20412 @section Followups To Yourself
20413
20414 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20415 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20416 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20417 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20418 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20419 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20420
20421 @table @code
20422
20423 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20424 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20425 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20426 article.
20427
20428 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20429 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20430 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20431 your own article.
20432 @end table
20433
20434 @vindex message-sent-hook
20435 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20436 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20437 @lisp
20438 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20439 @end lisp
20440
20441
20442 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20443 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20444 mine:
20445
20446 @example
20447 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20448 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20449 @end example
20450
20451 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20452 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20453 myself:
20454
20455 @lisp
20456 ("references"
20457 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20458 1000 nil r))
20459 @end lisp
20460
20461 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20462 is system-dependent.
20463
20464
20465 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20466 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20467 @cindex scoring on other headers
20468
20469 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20470 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20471 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20472 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20473 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20474
20475 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20476 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20477 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20478 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20479 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20480 inhibited for all groups.
20481
20482 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20483 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20484 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20485 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20486 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20487
20488 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20489
20490 @lisp
20491 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20492 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20493 @end lisp
20494
20495 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20496 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20497 time if you have much mail.
20498
20499 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20500 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20501
20502 See? Simple.
20503
20504
20505 @node Scoring Tips
20506 @section Scoring Tips
20507 @cindex scoring tips
20508
20509 @table @dfn
20510
20511 @item Crossposts
20512 @cindex crossposts
20513 @cindex scoring crossposts
20514 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20515 the @code{Xref} header.
20516 @lisp
20517 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20518 @end lisp
20519
20520 @item Multiple crossposts
20521 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20522 more than, say, 3 groups:
20523 @lisp
20524 ("xref"
20525 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20526 -1000 nil r))
20527 @end lisp
20528
20529 @item Matching on the body
20530 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20531 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20532 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20533 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20534 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20535 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20536 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20537 the matches.
20538
20539 @item Marking as read
20540 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20541 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20542 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20543 @lisp
20544 ((mark -100))
20545 @end lisp
20546 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20547
20548 @item Negated character classes
20549 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20550 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20551 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20552 @end table
20553
20554
20555 @node Reverse Scoring
20556 @section Reverse Scoring
20557 @cindex reverse scoring
20558
20559 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20560 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20561 like this in your score file:
20562
20563 @lisp
20564 (("subject"
20565 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20566 (mark 1)
20567 (expunge 1))
20568 @end lisp
20569
20570 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20571 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20572
20573
20574 @node Global Score Files
20575 @section Global Score Files
20576 @cindex global score files
20577
20578 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20579 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20580 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20581
20582 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20583 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20584 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20585
20586 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20587 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20588 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20589 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20590 files are applicable to which group.
20591
20592 To use the score file
20593 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20594 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20595 say this:
20596
20597 @lisp
20598 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20599 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20600 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20601 @end lisp
20602
20603 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20604 @noindent
20605 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20606 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20607 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20608 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20609
20610 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20611 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20612
20613 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20614 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20615 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20616 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20617 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20618 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20619
20620 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20621 head:
20622
20623 @itemize @bullet
20624
20625 @item
20626 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20627 @item
20628 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20629 @item
20630 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20631 @item
20632 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20633 lowered out of existence.
20634 @item
20635 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20636 articles completely.
20637
20638 @item
20639 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20640 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20641 old articles for a long time.
20642 @end itemize
20643
20644 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20645 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20646 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20647 holding our breath yet?
20648
20649
20650 @node Kill Files
20651 @section Kill Files
20652 @cindex kill files
20653
20654 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20655 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20656 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20657
20658 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20659 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20660 files into score files.
20661
20662 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20663 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20664 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20665 that isn't a very good idea.
20666
20667 Normal kill files look like this:
20668
20669 @lisp
20670 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20671 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20672 (gnus-expunge "X")
20673 @end lisp
20674
20675 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20676 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20677
20678 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20679 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20680 interpreting it.
20681
20682 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20683
20684 @table @kbd
20685
20686 @item M-k
20687 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20688 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20689 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20690
20691 @item M-K
20692 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20693 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20694 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20695 @end table
20696
20697 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20698
20699 @table @kbd
20700
20701 @item M-k
20702 @kindex M-k (Group)
20703 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20704 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20705
20706 @item M-K
20707 @kindex M-K (Group)
20708 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20709 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20710 @end table
20711
20712 Kill file variables:
20713
20714 @table @code
20715 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20716 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20717 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20718 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20719 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20720 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20721 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20722
20723 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20724 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20725 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20726 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20727 kills.
20728
20729 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20730 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20731 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20732 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20733 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20734 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20735 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20736 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20737 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20738
20739 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20740 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20741 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20742
20743 @end table
20744
20745
20746 @node Converting Kill Files
20747 @section Converting Kill Files
20748 @cindex kill files
20749 @cindex converting kill files
20750
20751 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20752 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20753 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20754 by hand.
20755
20756 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20757 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20758 from
20759 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20760
20761 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20762 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20763 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20764 before.
20765
20766
20767 @node Advanced Scoring
20768 @section Advanced Scoring
20769
20770 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20771 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20772 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20773 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20774 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20775
20776 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20777 scoring patterns.
20778
20779 @menu
20780 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20781 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20782 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20783 @end menu
20784
20785
20786 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20787 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20788
20789 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20790 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20791 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20792 non-@code{nil} value.
20793
20794 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20795 operator, and various match operators.
20796
20797 Logical operators:
20798
20799 @table @code
20800 @item &
20801 @itemx and
20802 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20803 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20804 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20805 @code{true}.
20806
20807 @item |
20808 @itemx or
20809 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20810 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20811 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20812
20813 @item !
20814 @itemx not
20815 @itemx ¬
20816 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20817 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20818
20819 @end table
20820
20821 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20822 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20823 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20824 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20825 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20826 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20827 the ancestry you want to go.
20828
20829 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20830 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20831 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20832 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20833 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20834
20835
20836 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20837 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20838
20839 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20840 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20841 of parentheses.
20842
20843 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20844 when he's talking about Gnus:
20845
20846 @example
20847 @group
20848 ((&
20849 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20850 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20851 1000)
20852 @end group
20853 @end example
20854
20855 Quite simple, huh?
20856
20857 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20858
20859 @example
20860 ((&
20861 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20862 (|
20863 ("subject" "Gnus")
20864 ("lines" 100 >)))
20865 1000)
20866 @end example
20867
20868 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20869 really don't want to read what he's written:
20870
20871 @example
20872 ((&
20873 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20874 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20875 -100000)
20876 @end example
20877
20878 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20879 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20880 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20881 very interesting:
20882
20883 @example
20884 ((&
20885 (1-
20886 (&
20887 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20888 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20889 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20890 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20891 1000)
20892 @end example
20893
20894 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20895 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20896 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20897 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20898
20899 @example
20900 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20901 -200)
20902 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20903 200)
20904 @end example
20905
20906 The possibilities are endless.
20907
20908 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20909 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20910
20911 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20912 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20913 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20914 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20915 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20916 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20917 @samp{subject}) first.
20918
20919 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20920 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20921 something like:
20922
20923 @example
20924 ...
20925 (1-
20926 (1-
20927 ("from" "lars")))
20928 ...
20929 @end example
20930
20931 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20932 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20933
20934 @example
20935 (1-
20936 (&
20937 ("from" "Lars")
20938 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20939 @end example
20940
20941 than it is to say:
20942
20943 @example
20944 (&
20945 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20946 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20947 @end example
20948
20949
20950 @node Score Decays
20951 @section Score Decays
20952 @cindex score decays
20953 @cindex decays
20954
20955 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20956 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20957 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20958 use them in any sensible way.
20959
20960 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20961 @findex gnus-decay-score
20962 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20963 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20964 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20965 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20966 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20967 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
20968 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
20969 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
20970 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
20971 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
20972 function:
20973
20974 @lisp
20975 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20976 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20977 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20978 (let ((n (- score
20979 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20980 (min (abs score)
20981 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20982 (* (abs score)
20983 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20984 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20985 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
20986 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20987 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20988 (string-to-number
20989 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20990 (floor n))))
20991 @end lisp
20992
20993 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20994 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20995 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20996 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20997
20998 @enumerate
20999 @item
21000 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21001
21002 @item
21003 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21004
21005 @item
21006 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21007 score.
21008 @end enumerate
21009
21010 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21011 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21012 the new score, which should be an integer.
21013
21014 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21015 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21016
21017 @node Searching
21018 @chapter Searching
21019 @cindex searching
21020
21021 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21022 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21023 as well.
21024
21025 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21026 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21027 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21028 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21029
21030 @menu
21031 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21032 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21033 @end menu
21034
21035 @node nnir
21036 @section nnir
21037 @cindex nnir
21038
21039 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21040 within gnus.
21041
21042 @menu
21043 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21044 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21045 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21046 @end menu
21047
21048 @node What is nnir?
21049 @subsection What is nnir?
21050
21051 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21052 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21053 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21054 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21055 interface.
21056
21057 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21058 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21059 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21060
21061
21062 @node Basic Usage
21063 @subsection Basic Usage
21064
21065 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21066 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21067 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21068 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21069 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21070 using the usual commands.
21071
21072 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21073 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21074 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21075 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21076 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21077 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21078 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21079 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21080 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21081 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21082 whatever. Go nuts.
21083
21084 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21085 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21086 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21087 will search all the groups under that heading.
21088
21089 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21090 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21091 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21092 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21093 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21094
21095 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21096 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21097 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21098 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21099 special search features for each engine separately.
21100
21101
21102 @node Setting up nnir
21103 @subsection Setting up nnir
21104
21105 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21106 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21107 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21108 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21109 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21110 a backend.
21111
21112 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21113 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21114 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21115 query language anyway.
21116
21117 @menu
21118 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21119 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21120 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21121 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21122 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21123 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21124 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21125 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21126 @end menu
21127
21128 @node Associating Engines
21129 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21130
21131
21132 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21133 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21134 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21135 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21136 named @code{home} you can use
21137
21138 @lisp
21139 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21140 '((nnml "home"
21141 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21142 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21143 @end lisp
21144
21145 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21146 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21147 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21148 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21149 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21150 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21151 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21152 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21153 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21154 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21155 could change this to
21156
21157 @lisp
21158 '((nnimap . namazu)
21159 (nntp . gmane))
21160 @end lisp
21161
21162 @node The imap Engine
21163 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21164
21165 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21166
21167 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21168 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21169 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21170
21171 @table @samp
21172
21173 @item Boolean query operators
21174 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21175 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21176 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21177 recognized. Also preceding a term with a - sign is equivalent to NOT
21178 term.
21179
21180 @item Automatic AND queries
21181 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21182 expression intended to match all components.
21183
21184 @item Phrase searches
21185 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21186 literal string.
21187
21188 @end table
21189
21190 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21191 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21192 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21193 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21194 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21195 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21196 the query to the Message-ID header.
21197
21198 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21199 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21200 RFC3501.
21201
21202 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21203 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21204 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21205
21206 @lisp
21207 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21208 @end lisp
21209
21210 @node The gmane Engine
21211 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21212
21213 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21214
21215 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21216
21217 @table @samp
21218 @item Boolean query operators
21219 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21220 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21221 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21222 recognized.
21223
21224 @item Required and excluded terms
21225 + and - can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football -american
21226
21227 @item Unicode handling
21228 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21229 in any language.
21230
21231 @item Stopwords
21232 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21233 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21234 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21235
21236 @end table
21237
21238 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21239 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21240 name (or part of a name) to match.
21241
21242 @node The swish++ Engine
21243 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21244
21245 FIXME: Say something more here.
21246
21247 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21248 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21249
21250 @table @code
21251
21252 @item nnir-swish++-program
21253 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21254
21255 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21256 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21257 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21258
21259 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21260 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21261 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21262
21263 @end table
21264
21265 @node The swish-e Engine
21266 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21267
21268 FIXME: Say something more here.
21269
21270 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21271 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21272
21273 @table @code
21274
21275 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21276 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21277
21278 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21279 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21280 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21281
21282 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21283 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21284 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21285
21286 @end table
21287
21288 @node The namazu Engine
21289 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21290
21291 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21292 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21293 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21294 variable.
21295
21296 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21297 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21298 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21299 instead of `.').
21300
21301 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21302 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21303 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21304 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21305 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21306 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21307 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21308
21309 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21310 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21311 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21312 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21313 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21314 information on valid switches.
21315
21316 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21317 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21318
21319 @cartouche
21320 @example
21321 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21322
21323 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21324 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21325
21326 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21327 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21328
21329 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21330 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21331
21332 # The max length of a word.
21333 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21334
21335 # The max length of a field.
21336 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21337 @end example
21338 @end cartouche
21339
21340 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21341 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21342 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21343 the following command:
21344
21345 @example
21346 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21347 @end example
21348
21349 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21350 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21351
21352 @node The hyrex Engine
21353 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21354 This engine is obsolete.
21355
21356 @node Customizations
21357 @subsubsection Customizations
21358
21359 @table @code
21360
21361 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21362 Alist of server backend - search engine pairs. The default associations
21363 are
21364 @example
21365 (nnimap . imap)
21366 (nntp . gmane)
21367 @end example
21368
21369 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21370 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21371 when searching all groups on a server.
21372
21373 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21374 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21375 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21376 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21377
21378 @example
21379 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21380 %G Article original full group name (string)
21381 %g Article original short group name (string)
21382 @end example
21383
21384 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21385
21386 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21387 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21388 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21389 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21390 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21391 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21392 should return @code{nil}
21393
21394 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21395 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21396
21397
21398 @end table
21399
21400
21401 @node nnmairix
21402 @section nnmairix
21403
21404 @cindex mairix
21405 @cindex nnmairix
21406 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21407 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21408 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21409 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21410
21411 @menu
21412 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21413 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21414 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21415 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21416 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21417 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21418 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21419 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21420 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21421 @end menu
21422
21423 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21424 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21425 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21426
21427 @node About mairix
21428 @subsection About mairix
21429
21430 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21431 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21432 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21433 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21434 be found at
21435 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21436
21437 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21438 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21439 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21440 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21441 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21442 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21443 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21444 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21445 up.
21446
21447 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21448 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21449 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21450 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21451 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21452 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21453 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21454 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21455 searches.
21456
21457 @node nnmairix requirements
21458 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21459
21460 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21461 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21462 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21463 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21464
21465 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21466 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21467 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21468 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21469
21470 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21471 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21472 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21473 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21474 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21475 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21476
21477 @node What nnmairix does
21478 @subsection What nnmairix does
21479
21480 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21481 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21482 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21483 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21484 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21485 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21486 mails are in different folders.
21487
21488 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21489 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21490 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21491 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21492 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21493 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21494
21495 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21496 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21497 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21498 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21499 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21500 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21501 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21502 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21503 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21504 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21505 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21506
21507 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21508 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21509 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21510 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21511 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21512 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21513 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21514 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21515 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21516 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21517 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21518 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21519 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21520 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21521 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21522 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21523
21524 @node Setting up mairix
21525 @subsection Setting up mairix
21526
21527 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21528
21529 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21530 (at least) the following entries:
21531
21532 @example
21533 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21534 base=~/Maildir
21535 @end example
21536
21537 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21538 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21539 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21540 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21541
21542 @example
21543 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21544 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21545 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21546 @end example
21547
21548 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21549 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21550 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21551 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21552 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21553
21554 @example
21555 omit=zz_mairix-*
21556 @end example
21557
21558 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21559 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21560 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21561 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21562
21563 @example
21564 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21565 database= ... location of database file ...
21566 @end example
21567
21568 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21569 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21570 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21571
21572 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21573
21574 @example
21575 base=~/Maildir
21576 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21577 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21578 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21579 mformat=maildir
21580 omit=zz_mairix-*
21581 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21582 @end example
21583
21584 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21585 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21586 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21587 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21588 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21589 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21590 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21591 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21592 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21593 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21594 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21595 The other lines should be obvious.
21596
21597 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21598 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21599 than you are used to.
21600
21601 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21602 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21603 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21604
21605 @node Configuring nnmairix
21606 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21607
21608 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21609 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21610 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21611 server. You will have to specify the following:
21612
21613 @itemize @bullet
21614
21615 @item
21616 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21617 want.
21618
21619 @item
21620 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21621 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21622 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21623 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21624 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21625 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21626 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21627 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21628 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21629 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21630 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21631 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21632 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21633 @code{nnimap} server here.
21634
21635 @item
21636 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21637 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21638 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21639 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21640 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21641 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21642 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21643
21644 @item
21645 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21646 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21647 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21648 like.
21649
21650 @item
21651 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21652 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21653 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21654 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21655 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21656
21657 @end itemize
21658
21659 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21660 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21661
21662 In group mode:
21663
21664 @table @kbd
21665
21666 @item G b c
21667 @kindex G b c (Group)
21668 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21669 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21670 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21671 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21672
21673 @item G b s
21674 @kindex G b s (Group)
21675 @findex nnmairix-search
21676 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21677 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21678 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21679
21680 @item G b m
21681 @kindex G b m (Group)
21682 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21683 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21684 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21685 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21686
21687 @item G b i
21688 @kindex G b i (Group)
21689 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21690 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21691 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21692
21693 @item G b g
21694 @kindex G b g (Group)
21695 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21696 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21697 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21698 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21699 @kbd{M-g}.
21700
21701 @item G b q
21702 @kindex G b q (Group)
21703 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21704 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21705 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21706
21707 @item G b t
21708 @kindex G b t (Group)
21709 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21710 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21711 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21712 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21713
21714 @item G b u
21715 @kindex G b u (Group)
21716 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21717 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21718 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21719 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21720 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21721 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21722 options).
21723
21724 @item G b r
21725 @kindex G b r (Group)
21726 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21727 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21728 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21729
21730 @item G b d
21731 @kindex G b d (Group)
21732 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21733 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21734 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21735 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21736
21737 @item G b a
21738 @kindex G b a (Group)
21739 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21740 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21741 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21742 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21743 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21744 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21745 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21746 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21747 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21748
21749 @item G b p
21750 @kindex G b p (Group)
21751 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21752 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21753 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21754 marks}).
21755
21756 @item G b o
21757 @kindex G b o (Group)
21758 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21759 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21760 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21761
21762 @end table
21763
21764 In summary mode:
21765
21766 @table @kbd
21767
21768 @item $ m
21769 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21770 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21771 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21772 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21773 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21774
21775 @item $ g
21776 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21777 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21778 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21779 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21780 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21781
21782 @item $ t
21783 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21784 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21785 Searches thread for the current article
21786 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21787 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21788 current article and enabled threads.
21789
21790 @item $ f
21791 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21792 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21793 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21794 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21795 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21796
21797 @item $ o
21798 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21799 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21800 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21801 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21802 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21803 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21804 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21805 article file name as a fallback method.
21806
21807 @item $ u
21808 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21809 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21810 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21811 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21812 tips and tricks}).
21813
21814 @end table
21815
21816 @node Propagating marks
21817 @subsection Propagating marks
21818
21819 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21820 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21821 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21822
21823 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21824
21825 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21826 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21827 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21828 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21829 be useful to you.
21830
21831 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21832 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21833 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21834 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21835 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21836 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21837 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21838 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21839 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21840 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21841
21842 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21843 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21844 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21845 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21846 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21847 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21848 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21849
21850 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21851 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21852 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21853 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21854 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21855 even more cumbersome.
21856
21857 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21858 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21859 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21860
21861 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21862 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21863 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21864 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21865 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21866 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21867 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21868
21869 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21870 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21871 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21872 magically be set for the original article, too.
21873
21874 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21875
21876 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21877 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21878 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21879 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21880 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21881 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21882 details).
21883
21884 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21885 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21886 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21887 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21888 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21889 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21890 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21891
21892 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21893 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21894 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21895 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21896 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21897 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21898 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21899
21900 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21901 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21902 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21903 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21904 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21905 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21906 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21907 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21908 maildir as its file format.
21909
21910 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21911 If you work with this setup, just set
21912 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21913 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21914 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21915 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21916 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21917 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21918
21919 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21920 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21921
21922 @itemize
21923 @item
21924 Checking Mail
21925
21926 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21927 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21928 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21929 Levels}).
21930
21931 I use the following to check for mails:
21932
21933 @lisp
21934 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21935 (interactive "P")
21936 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21937 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21938 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21939 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21940
21941 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21942 @end lisp
21943
21944 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21945 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21946 details.
21947
21948 @item
21949 Example: search group for ticked articles
21950
21951 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21952 articles always stay unread:
21953
21954 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
21955 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21956
21957 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21958 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21959
21960 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21961 group? There are two options: You may simply use
21962 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
21963 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
21964 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
21965 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
21966 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
21967 e.g., by marking an article as read.
21968
21969 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
21970 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
21971 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
21972 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
21973 snippet and the doc string for details.
21974
21975 @item
21976 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
21977
21978 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
21979 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
21980 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
21981 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
21982 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
21983 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
21984 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
21985 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
21986 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
21987 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
21988 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
21989 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
21990
21991 @lisp
21992 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
21993 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
21994 @end lisp
21995
21996 @end itemize
21997
21998 @node nnmairix caveats
21999 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22000
22001 @itemize
22002 @item
22003 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22004 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22005 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22006 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22007 an example server definition:
22008
22009 @lisp
22010 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22011 @end lisp
22012
22013 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22014 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22015 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22016 mairix.)
22017
22018 @item
22019 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22020 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22021 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22022 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22023 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22024 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22025 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22026
22027 @item
22028 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22029 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22030
22031 @item
22032 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22033 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22034
22035 @item
22036 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22037
22038 @item
22039 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22040 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22041 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22042 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22043 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22044 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22045 folders.
22046
22047 @item
22048 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22049 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22050 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22051 it is gone for good.
22052
22053 @item
22054 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22055 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22056 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22057 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22058 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22059 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22060 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22061 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22062 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22063
22064 @item
22065 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22066 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22067
22068 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22069 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22070 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22071 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22072 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22073 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22074 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22075 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22076 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22077 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22078 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22079 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22080
22081 @end itemize
22082
22083 @iftex
22084 @iflatex
22085 @chapter Message
22086 @include message.texi
22087 @chapter Emacs MIME
22088 @include emacs-mime.texi
22089 @chapter Sieve
22090 @include sieve.texi
22091 @chapter EasyPG
22092 @include epa.texi
22093 @chapter SASL
22094 @include sasl.texi
22095 @end iflatex
22096 @end iftex
22097
22098 @node Various
22099 @chapter Various
22100
22101 @menu
22102 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22103 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22104 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22105 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22106 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22107 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22108 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22109 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22110 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22111 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22112 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22113 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22114 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22115 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22116 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22117 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22118 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22119 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22120 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22121 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22122 @end menu
22123
22124
22125 @node Process/Prefix
22126 @section Process/Prefix
22127 @cindex process/prefix convention
22128
22129 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22130 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22131
22132 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22133 command to be performed on.
22134
22135 It goes like this:
22136
22137 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22138 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22139 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22140 with the current one.
22141
22142 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22143 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22144 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22145
22146 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22147 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22148 the process mark.
22149
22150 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22151 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22152
22153 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22154 are avoided.
22155
22156 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22157 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22158 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22159 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22160
22161 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22162 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22163 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22164 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22165 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22166 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22167 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22168 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22169
22170 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22171 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22172 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22173 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22174 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22175
22176
22177 @node Interactive
22178 @section Interactive
22179 @cindex interaction
22180
22181 @table @code
22182
22183 @item gnus-novice-user
22184 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22185 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22186 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22187 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22188 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22189 default.
22190
22191 @item gnus-expert-user
22192 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22193 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22194 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22195 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22196 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22197 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22198 confirmation.
22199
22200 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22201 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22202 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22203 is @code{t} by default.
22204
22205 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22206 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22207 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22208 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22209 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22210 @end table
22211
22212
22213 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22214 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22215 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22216
22217 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22218 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22219 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22220 rule of 900 to the current article.
22221
22222 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22223 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22224 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22225 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22226 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22227 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22228 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22229
22230 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22231 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22232 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22233 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22234 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22235 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22236 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22237 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22238 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22239
22240 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22241 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22242 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22243
22244 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22245 Interactive}.
22246
22247
22248 @node Formatting Variables
22249 @section Formatting Variables
22250 @cindex formatting variables
22251
22252 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22253 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22254 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22255 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22256 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22257 be annoyed by.
22258
22259 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22260 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22261 lots of percentages everywhere.
22262
22263 @menu
22264 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22265 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22266 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22267 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22268 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22269 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22270 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22271 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22272 @end menu
22273
22274 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22275 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22276 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22277 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22278 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22279 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22280 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22281 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22282
22283 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22284 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22285
22286 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22287 @findex gnus-update-format
22288 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22289 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22290 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22291 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22292
22293
22294
22295 @node Formatting Basics
22296 @subsection Formatting Basics
22297
22298 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22299 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22300 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22301
22302 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22303 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22304 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22305 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22306 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22307 the right instead.
22308
22309 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22310 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22311 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22312 less than 4 characters wide.
22313
22314 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22315 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22316
22317
22318 @node Mode Line Formatting
22319 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22320
22321 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22322 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22323 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22324 with the following two differences:
22325
22326 @enumerate
22327
22328 @item
22329 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22330
22331 @item
22332 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22333 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22334 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22335 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22336 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22337 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22338 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22339
22340 @end enumerate
22341
22342
22343 @node Advanced Formatting
22344 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22345
22346 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22347 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22348 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22349 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22350
22351 These are the valid modifiers:
22352
22353 @table @code
22354 @item pad
22355 @itemx pad-left
22356 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22357 length.
22358
22359 @item pad-right
22360 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22361 length.
22362
22363 @item max
22364 @itemx max-left
22365 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22366
22367 @item max-right
22368 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22369 length.
22370
22371 @item cut
22372 @itemx cut-left
22373 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22374
22375 @item cut-right
22376 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22377
22378 @item ignore
22379 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22380
22381 @item form
22382 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22383 used.
22384
22385 Here's an example:
22386
22387 @lisp
22388 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22389 @end lisp
22390
22391 @end table
22392
22393 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22394 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22395 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22396 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22397 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22398 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22399 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22400
22401 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22402 last operation, padding.
22403
22404
22405 @node User-Defined Specs
22406 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22407
22408 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22409 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22410 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22411 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22412 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22413 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22414 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22415 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22416 should protect against that.
22417
22418 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22419 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22420
22421 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22422 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22423 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22424 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22425 inserted.
22426
22427
22428 @node Formatting Fonts
22429 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22430
22431 @cindex %(, %)
22432 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22433 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22434 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22435 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22436 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22437 over it.
22438
22439 @cindex %@{, %@}
22440 @vindex gnus-face-0
22441 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22442 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22443 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22444 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22445 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22446 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22447
22448 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22449 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22450 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22451 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22452 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22453 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22454 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22455 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22456 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22457 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22458 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22459 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22460 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22461 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22462 paragraph.)
22463
22464 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22465
22466 @lisp
22467 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22468 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22469 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22470
22471 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22472 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22473 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22474 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22475 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22476 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22477 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22478
22479 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22480 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22481 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22482 @end lisp
22483
22484 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22485 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22486
22487 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22488 mode-line variables.
22489
22490 @node Positioning Point
22491 @subsection Positioning Point
22492
22493 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22494 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22495 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22496
22497 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22498
22499 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22500 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22501 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22502
22503 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22504 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22505 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22506 place point there.
22507
22508
22509 @node Tabulation
22510 @subsection Tabulation
22511
22512 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22513 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22514 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22515 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22516
22517 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22518 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22519
22520 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22521 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22522 This is the soft tabulator.
22523
22524 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22525 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22526 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22527
22528
22529 @node Wide Characters
22530 @subsection Wide Characters
22531
22532 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22533 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22534 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22535
22536 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22537 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22538 these countries, that's not true.
22539
22540 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22541 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22542 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22543 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22544 for Emacs.
22545
22546
22547 @node Window Layout
22548 @section Window Layout
22549 @cindex window layout
22550
22551 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22552
22553 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22554 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22555 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22556 @code{t} by default.
22557
22558 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22559 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22560
22561 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22562 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22563 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22564
22565 @lisp
22566 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22567 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22568 (article 1.0))))
22569 @end lisp
22570
22571 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22572 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22573 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22574 possible names is listed below.
22575
22576 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22577 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
22578
22579 @lisp
22580 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22581 (article 1.0)))
22582 @end lisp
22583
22584 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22585 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22586 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22587 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22588 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22589 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22590 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22591 size spec per split.
22592
22593 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22594 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22595 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22596 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22597 present) gets focus.
22598
22599 Here's a more complicated example:
22600
22601 @lisp
22602 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22603 (summary 0.25 point)
22604 (article 1.0)))
22605 @end lisp
22606
22607 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22608 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22609 occupy, not a percentage.
22610
22611 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22612 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22613 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22614 be used as a split.
22615
22616 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22617
22618 @lisp
22619 (article (horizontal 1.0
22620 (vertical 0.5
22621 (group 1.0))
22622 (vertical 1.0
22623 (summary 0.25 point)
22624 (article 1.0))))
22625 @end lisp
22626
22627 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22628 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22629
22630 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22631 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22632 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22633 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22634 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22635
22636 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22637 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22638 lines from the splits.
22639
22640 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22641 may look like:
22642
22643 @example
22644 @group
22645 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22646 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22647 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22648 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22649 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22650 size = number | frame-params
22651 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22652 @end group
22653 @end example
22654
22655 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22656 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22657 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22658 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22659
22660 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22661 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22662 @cindex window height
22663 @cindex window width
22664 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22665 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22666 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22667 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22668 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22669 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22670
22671 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22672 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22673 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22674 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22675
22676 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22677 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22678 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22679 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22680 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22681 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22682 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22683 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22684 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22685 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22686 configuration list.
22687
22688 @lisp
22689 (gnus-configure-frame
22690 '(horizontal 1.0
22691 (vertical 10
22692 (group 1.0)
22693 (article 0.3 point))
22694 (vertical 1.0
22695 (article 1.0)
22696 (horizontal 4
22697 (group 1.0)
22698 (article 10)))))
22699 @end lisp
22700
22701 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22702 @code{frame} split:
22703
22704 @lisp
22705 (gnus-configure-frame
22706 '(frame 1.0
22707 (vertical 1.0
22708 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22709 (article 1.0))
22710 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22711 (user-position . t)
22712 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22713 (picon 1.0))))
22714
22715 @end lisp
22716
22717 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22718 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22719 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22720 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22721 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22722 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22723 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22724 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22725 is such a plist.
22726 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22727 be found in its default value.
22728
22729 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22730 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22731 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22732 might be used:
22733
22734 @lisp
22735 (message (horizontal 1.0
22736 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22737 (vertical 0.24
22738 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22739 '(summary 0.5))
22740 (group 1.0))))
22741 @end lisp
22742
22743 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22744 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22745 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22746
22747 @lisp
22748 (message
22749 (frame 1.0
22750 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22751 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22752 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22753 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22754 (name . "Message"))
22755 (message 1.0 point))))
22756 @end lisp
22757
22758 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22759 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22760 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22761 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22762 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22763
22764 @lisp
22765 (gnus-add-configuration
22766 '(article (vertical 1.0
22767 (group 4)
22768 (summary .25 point)
22769 (article 1.0))))
22770 @end lisp
22771
22772 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22773 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22774 Gnus has been loaded.
22775
22776 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22777 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22778 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22779 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22780 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22781
22782 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22783 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22784 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22785 windows resized.
22786
22787 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22788
22789 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22790 and when they're used:
22791
22792 @table @code
22793 @item group
22794 The group buffer.
22795
22796 @item summary
22797 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22798
22799 @item article
22800 Selecting an article.
22801
22802 @item server
22803 The server buffer.
22804
22805 @item browse
22806 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22807
22808 @item message
22809 Composing a (new) message.
22810
22811 @item only-article
22812 Showing only the article buffer.
22813
22814 @item edit-article
22815 Editing an article.
22816
22817 @item edit-form
22818 Editing group parameters and the like.
22819
22820 @item edit-score
22821 Editing a server definition.
22822
22823 @item post
22824 Composing a news message.
22825
22826 @item reply
22827 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22828
22829 @item forward
22830 Forwarding a message.
22831
22832 @item reply-yank
22833 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22834
22835 @item mail-bound
22836 Bouncing a message.
22837
22838 @item pipe
22839 Sending an article to an external process.
22840
22841 @item bug
22842 Sending a bug report.
22843
22844 @item score-trace
22845 Displaying the score trace.
22846
22847 @item score-words
22848 Displaying the score words.
22849
22850 @item split-trace
22851 Displaying the split trace.
22852
22853 @item compose-bounce
22854 Composing a bounce message.
22855
22856 @item mml-preview
22857 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22858
22859 @end table
22860
22861
22862 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22863
22864 @itemize @bullet
22865 @item
22866 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22867 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22868
22869 @ifinfo
22870 @example
22871 +---+---------+
22872 | G | Summary |
22873 | r +---------+
22874 | o | |
22875 | u | Article |
22876 | p | |
22877 +---+---------+
22878 @end example
22879 @end ifinfo
22880
22881 @lisp
22882 (gnus-add-configuration
22883 '(article
22884 (horizontal 1.0
22885 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22886 (vertical 1.0
22887 (summary 0.16 point)
22888 (article 1.0)))))
22889
22890 (gnus-add-configuration
22891 '(summary
22892 (horizontal 1.0
22893 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22894 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22895 @end lisp
22896
22897 @end itemize
22898
22899
22900 @node Faces and Fonts
22901 @section Faces and Fonts
22902 @cindex faces
22903 @cindex fonts
22904 @cindex colors
22905
22906 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22907 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22908 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22909 interface.
22910
22911
22912 @node Mode Lines
22913 @section Mode Lines
22914 @cindex mode lines
22915
22916 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22917 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22918 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22919 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22920 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22921 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22922 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22923 quicker.
22924
22925 @cindex display-time
22926
22927 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22928 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22929 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22930 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22931 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22932 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22933 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22934 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
22935 this variable:
22936
22937 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22938 @lisp
22939 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22940 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22941 (+ 21
22942 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22943 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22944 (length display-time-string)))))
22945 @end lisp
22946
22947 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22948 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22949 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22950 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22951 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22952
22953
22954 @node Highlighting and Menus
22955 @section Highlighting and Menus
22956 @cindex visual
22957 @cindex highlighting
22958 @cindex menus
22959
22960 @vindex gnus-visual
22961 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22962 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22963 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22964 file.
22965
22966 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22967 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22968
22969 @table @code
22970 @item group-highlight
22971 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22972 @item summary-highlight
22973 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22974 @item article-highlight
22975 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22976 @item highlight
22977 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22978 @item group-menu
22979 Create menus in the group buffer.
22980 @item summary-menu
22981 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22982 @item article-menu
22983 Create menus in the article buffer.
22984 @item browse-menu
22985 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22986 @item server-menu
22987 Create menus in the server buffer.
22988 @item score-menu
22989 Create menus in the score buffers.
22990 @item menu
22991 Create menus in all buffers.
22992 @end table
22993
22994 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22995 buffers, you could say something like:
22996
22997 @lisp
22998 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22999 @end lisp
23000
23001 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23002
23003 @lisp
23004 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23005 @end lisp
23006
23007 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23008 in all Gnus buffers.
23009
23010 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23011
23012 @table @code
23013 @item gnus-mouse-face
23014 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23015 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23016 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23017
23018 @end table
23019
23020 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23021
23022 @table @code
23023
23024 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23025 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23026 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23027
23028 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23029 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23030 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23031
23032 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23033 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23034 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23035
23036 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23037 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23038 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23039
23040 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23041 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23042 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23043
23044 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23045 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23046 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23047
23048 @end table
23049
23050
23051 @node Daemons
23052 @section Daemons
23053 @cindex demons
23054 @cindex daemons
23055
23056 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23057 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23058 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23059 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23060 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23061
23062 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23063 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23064 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23065
23066 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23067 been idle for thirty minutes:
23068
23069 @lisp
23070 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23071 @end lisp
23072
23073 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23074 Emacs is idle:
23075
23076 @lisp
23077 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23078 @end lisp
23079
23080 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23081 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23082 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23083
23084 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23085 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23086 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23087 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23088
23089 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23090 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23091 @var{idle} minutes.
23092
23093 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23094 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23095 minutes.
23096
23097 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23098 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23099 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23100
23101 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23102 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23103 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23104 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23105
23106 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23107 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23108
23109 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23110 @lisp
23111 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23112 @end lisp
23113
23114 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23115 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23116 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23117 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23118 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23119 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23120 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23121 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23122 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23123 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23124
23125 @findex gnus-demon-init
23126 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23127 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23128 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23129 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23130 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23131
23132 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23133 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23134 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23135 behave.
23136
23137
23138 @node Undo
23139 @section Undo
23140 @cindex undo
23141
23142 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23143 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23144 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23145
23146 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23147 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23148 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23149 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23150 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23151 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23152 @code{undo} function.
23153
23154 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23155 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23156 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23157 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23158 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23159 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23160 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23161 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23162 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23163 never be totally undoable.
23164
23165 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23166 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23167 @findex gnus-undo
23168 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23169 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23170 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23171 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23172 command.
23173
23174
23175 @node Predicate Specifiers
23176 @section Predicate Specifiers
23177 @cindex predicate specifiers
23178
23179 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23180 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23181 to type all that much.
23182
23183 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23184
23185 Here's an example:
23186
23187 @lisp
23188 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23189 gnus-article-unread-p)
23190 @end lisp
23191
23192 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23193 functions all take one parameter.
23194
23195 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23196 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23197 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23198 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23199 specifier.
23200
23201
23202 @node Moderation
23203 @section Moderation
23204 @cindex moderation
23205
23206 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23207 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23208 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23209 get a copy.
23210
23211 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23212 buffers. Put
23213
23214 @lisp
23215 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23216 @end lisp
23217
23218 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23219
23220 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23221 supposed to work:
23222
23223 @enumerate
23224 @item
23225 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23226 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23227 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23228
23229 @item
23230 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23231 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23232
23233 @item
23234 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23235 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23236 @kbd{c} command.
23237 @end enumerate
23238
23239 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23240
23241 @lisp
23242 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23243 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23244 @end lisp
23245
23246
23247 @node Fetching a Group
23248 @section Fetching a Group
23249 @cindex fetching a group
23250
23251 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23252 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23253 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23254 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23255 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23256 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23257
23258
23259 @node Image Enhancements
23260 @section Image Enhancements
23261
23262 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23263 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23264 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23265
23266 @menu
23267 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23268 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23269 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23270 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23271 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23272 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23273 @end menu
23274
23275
23276 @node X-Face
23277 @subsection X-Face
23278 @cindex x-face
23279
23280 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23281 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23282 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23283 readers.
23284
23285 @cindex x-face
23286 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23287 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23288 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23289 @iftex
23290 @iflatex
23291 \include{xface}
23292 @end iflatex
23293 @end iftex
23294 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23295
23296 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23297 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23298 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23299 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23300 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23301 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23302 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23303 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23304 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23305 @code{display} program.
23306
23307 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23308 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23309 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23310 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23311 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23312 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23313 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23314 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23315
23316 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23317 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23318 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23319 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23320 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23321 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23322
23323 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23324 @code{xface}).
23325
23326 @noindent
23327 Face and variable:
23328
23329 @table @code
23330 @item gnus-x-face
23331 @vindex gnus-x-face
23332 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23333 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23334 default colors are black and white.
23335
23336 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23337 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23338 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23339 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23340 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23341 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23342
23343 @lisp
23344 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23345 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23346 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23347 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23348
23349 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23350 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23351 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23352 (png . (:relief -2))))
23353 @end lisp
23354
23355 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23356 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23357 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23358 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23359 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23360 @samp{libcompface} library.
23361 @end table
23362
23363 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23364 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23365 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23366 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23367 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23368 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23369
23370 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23371 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23372 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23373 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23374 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23375 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23376 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23377 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23378 header data as a string.
23379
23380 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23381 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23382 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23383 randomly generated data.
23384
23385 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23386 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23387 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23388 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23389 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23390
23391 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23392 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23393
23394 @lisp
23395 (setq message-required-news-headers
23396 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23397 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23398 @end lisp
23399
23400 Using the last function would be something like this:
23401
23402 @lisp
23403 (setq message-required-news-headers
23404 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23405 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23406 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23407 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23408 @end lisp
23409
23410
23411 @node Face
23412 @subsection Face
23413 @cindex face
23414
23415 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23416
23417 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23418 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23419 represent the author of the message.
23420
23421 @cindex face
23422 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23423 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23424 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23425 specifications.
23426
23427 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23428 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23429
23430 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23431 PNG images.
23432 @c Maybe add this:
23433 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23434 @c (featurep 'png)
23435 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23436
23437 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23438 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23439
23440 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23441 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23442 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23443
23444 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23445 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23446 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23447 converts the file to Face format by using the
23448 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23449
23450 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23451 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23452
23453 @lisp
23454 (setq message-required-news-headers
23455 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23456 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23457 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23458 @end lisp
23459
23460
23461 @node Smileys
23462 @subsection Smileys
23463 @cindex smileys
23464
23465 @iftex
23466 @iflatex
23467 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23468 \input{smiley}
23469 @end iflatex
23470 @end iftex
23471
23472 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23473 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23474
23475 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23476 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23477
23478 @lisp
23479 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23480 @end lisp
23481
23482 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23483 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23484 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23485 text and maps that to file names.
23486
23487 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23488 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23489 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23490 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23491 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23492 displayed.
23493
23494 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23495
23496 @table @code
23497
23498 @item smiley-style
23499 @vindex smiley-style
23500 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23501 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23502 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23503 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23504 face.
23505
23506 @item smiley-data-directory
23507 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23508 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23509 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23510
23511 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23512 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23513 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23514
23515 @end table
23516
23517
23518 @node Picons
23519 @subsection Picons
23520
23521 @iftex
23522 @iflatex
23523 \include{picons}
23524 @end iflatex
23525 @end iftex
23526
23527 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23528 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23529 over your shoulder as you read news.
23530
23531 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23532
23533 @iftex
23534 @iflatex
23535 \margindex{}
23536 @end iflatex
23537 @end iftex
23538
23539 @quotation
23540 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23541 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23542 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23543 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23544 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23545 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23546 @code{GIF} formats.
23547 @end quotation
23548
23549 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23550 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23551 point your Web browser at
23552 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23553
23554 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23555 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23556
23557 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23558 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23559 Picons databases.
23560
23561 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23562 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23563 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23564 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23565
23566 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23567 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23568 properties applied to picons.
23569
23570 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23571
23572 @table @code
23573
23574 @item gnus-picon-databases
23575 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23576 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23577 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23578 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23579 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23580
23581 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23582 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23583 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23584 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23585
23586 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23587 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23588 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23589 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23590
23591 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23592 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23593 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23594 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23595 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23596
23597 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23598 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23599 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23600 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23601
23602 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23603 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23604 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23605 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23606 interesting.
23607
23608 @end table
23609
23610 @node Gravatars
23611 @subsection Gravatars
23612
23613 @iftex
23614 @iflatex
23615 \include{gravatars}
23616 @end iflatex
23617 @end iftex
23618
23619 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23620
23621 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23622
23623 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23624
23625 @table @code
23626
23627 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23628 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23629 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23630 number for the size is enough.
23631
23632 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23633 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23634 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23635
23636 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23637 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23638 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23639 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23640 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23641
23642 @end table
23643
23644 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23645 @lisp
23646 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23647 @end lisp
23648
23649 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23650
23651 @lisp
23652 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23653 @end lisp
23654
23655
23656 @node XVarious
23657 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23658
23659 @table @code
23660 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23661 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23662 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23663 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23664 unusual directory structure.
23665
23666 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23667 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23668 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23669 default.
23670
23671 @end table
23672
23673 @subsubsection Toolbar
23674
23675 @table @code
23676
23677 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23678 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23679 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23680 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23681 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23682 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23683 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23684 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23685
23686 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23687 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23688 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23689 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23690 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23691 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23692
23693 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23694 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23695 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23696
23697 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23698 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23699 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23700
23701 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23702 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23703 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23704
23705 @end table
23706
23707 @iftex
23708 @iflatex
23709 \margindex{}
23710 @end iflatex
23711 @end iftex
23712
23713
23714 @node Fuzzy Matching
23715 @section Fuzzy Matching
23716 @cindex fuzzy matching
23717
23718 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23719 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23720
23721 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23722 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23723 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23724
23725 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23726 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23727 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23728 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23729 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23730
23731
23732 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23733 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23734 @cindex email spam
23735 @cindex spam
23736 @cindex UCE
23737 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23738
23739 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23740 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23741 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23742 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23743 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23744 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23745 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23746 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23747 in the end.
23748
23749 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23750 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23751 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23752 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23753 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23754 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23755
23756 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23757
23758 @menu
23759 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23760 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23761 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23762 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23763 @end menu
23764
23765 @node The problem of spam
23766 @subsection The problem of spam
23767 @cindex email spam
23768 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23769 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23770 @cindex UCE
23771 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23772
23773 First, some background on spam.
23774
23775 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23776 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23777 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23778 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23779 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23780 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23781 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23782 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23783 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23784
23785 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23786 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23787 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23788 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23789 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23790 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23791 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23792 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23793 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23794 and processing.
23795
23796 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23797 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23798 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23799 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23800 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23801 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23802 from Bulgarian IPs.
23803
23804 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23805 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23806 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23807 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23808
23809 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23810 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23811 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23812 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23813
23814 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23815 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23816 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23817 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23818 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23819 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23820 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23821 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23822 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23823
23824 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23825 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23826 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23827 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23828 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23829 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23830 down for some time because of the incident.
23831
23832 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23833 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23834 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23835 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23836 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23837 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23838 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23839 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23840 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23841 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23842 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23843
23844 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23845 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23846 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23847 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23848 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23849 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23850 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23851 spam plague.
23852
23853 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23854 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23855 @cindex email spam
23856 @cindex spam
23857 @cindex UCE
23858 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23859
23860 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23861 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23862
23863 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23864 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23865 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23866 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23867 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23868 part of the mail address.)
23869
23870 @lisp
23871 (setq message-default-news-headers
23872 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23873 @end lisp
23874
23875 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23876 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23877
23878 @lisp
23879 (...
23880 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23881 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23882 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23883 "spam"))
23884 ...)
23885 @end lisp
23886
23887 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23888 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23889 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23890 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23891
23892 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23893 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23894 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23895 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23896 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23897 your fancy split rule in this way:
23898
23899 @lisp
23900 (
23901 ...
23902 (to "larsi" "misc")
23903 "spam")
23904 @end lisp
23905
23906 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23907 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23908 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23909 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23910 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23911
23912 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23913 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23914 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23915 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23916
23917 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23918
23919
23920 @node SpamAssassin
23921 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23922 @cindex SpamAssassin
23923 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23924 @cindex DCC
23925
23926 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23927 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23928 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23929 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23930 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23931 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23932 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23933
23934 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23935 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23936 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23937 recipes.
23938
23939 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23940 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23941 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23942 Specifiers}) follow.
23943
23944 @lisp
23945 (setq mail-sources
23946 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23947 (pop :user "jrl"
23948 :server "pophost"
23949 :postscript
23950 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23951 @end lisp
23952
23953 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23954 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23955 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23956
23957 @lisp
23958 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23959 ...))
23960 @end lisp
23961
23962 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23963
23964 @lisp
23965 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23966 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23967 ...))
23968 @end lisp
23969
23970 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23971 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23972 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23973 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23974
23975 @lisp
23976 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23977 ...))
23978 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23979 (save-excursion
23980 (save-restriction
23981 (widen)
23982 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23983 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23984 "spam"))))
23985 @end lisp
23986
23987 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
23988 downloaded by default. You need to set
23989 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23990 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
23991
23992 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23993 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23994 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23995
23996 @lisp
23997 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23998 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23999 (interactive)
24000 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24001 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24002 @end lisp
24003
24004 @node Hashcash
24005 @subsection Hashcash
24006 @cindex hashcash
24007
24008 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24009 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24010 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24011 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24012 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24013
24014 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24015 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24016 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24017 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24018 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24019 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24020 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24021 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24022 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24023 one of them separately.
24024
24025 @cindex X-Hashcash
24026 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24027 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24028 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24029 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24030 need to install to use this feature, see
24031 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24032 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24033
24034 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24035 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24036 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24037
24038 @lisp
24039 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24040 @end lisp
24041
24042 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24043
24044 @table @code
24045
24046 @item hashcash-default-payment
24047 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24048 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24049 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24050 include 17 to 29.
24051
24052 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24053 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24054 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24055 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24056 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24057 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24058 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24059 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24060 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24061
24062 @item hashcash-path
24063 @vindex hashcash-path
24064 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24065 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24066 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24067 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24068 when you generate hashcash payments.
24069
24070 @end table
24071
24072 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24073 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24074 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24075 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24076 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24077 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24078 Hashcash Payments}).
24079
24080 @node Spam Package
24081 @section Spam Package
24082 @cindex spam filtering
24083 @cindex spam
24084
24085 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24086 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24087 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24088 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24089
24090 @menu
24091 * Spam Package Introduction::
24092 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24093 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24094 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24095 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24096 * Spam Back Ends::
24097 * Extending the Spam package::
24098 * Spam Statistics Package::
24099 @end menu
24100
24101 @node Spam Package Introduction
24102 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24103 @cindex spam filtering
24104 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24105 @cindex spam
24106
24107 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24108 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24109
24110 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24111 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24112
24113 @cindex spam-initialize
24114 @vindex spam-use-stat
24115 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24116 @code{spam-initialize}:
24117
24118 @example
24119 (spam-initialize)
24120 @end example
24121
24122 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24123 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24124 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24125 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24126 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24127
24128 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24129 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24130
24131 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24132 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24133
24134 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24135 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24136 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24137 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24138 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24139
24140 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24141 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24142 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24143 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24144 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24145 Groups}.
24146
24147 @cindex spam back ends
24148 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24149 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24150 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24151 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24152 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24153
24154 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24155 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24156
24157 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24158 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24159 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24160 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24161 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24162 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24163 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24164
24165 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24166 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24167 point, the Spam package does several things:
24168
24169 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24170 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24171 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24172 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24173 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24174 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24175 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24176 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24177 Ham Processors}.
24178
24179 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24180 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24181 group:
24182
24183 @table @kbd
24184 @item $
24185 @itemx M-d
24186 @itemx M s x
24187 @itemx S x
24188 @kindex $ (Summary)
24189 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24190 @kindex S x (Summary)
24191 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24192 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24193 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24194 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24195 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24196 @end table
24197
24198 @noindent
24199 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24200 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24201
24202 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24203 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24204 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24205 to be processed as ham by setting
24206 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24207 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24208
24209 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24210 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24211 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24212 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24213 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24214 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24215 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24216 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24217 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24218 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24219 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24220 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24221
24222 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24223 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24224 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24225 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24226 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24227 Configuration Examples}.
24228
24229 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24230 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24231 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24232 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24233
24234 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24235 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24236
24237 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24238 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24239 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24240
24241 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24242 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24243 @cindex spam filtering
24244 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24245 @cindex spam
24246
24247 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24248 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24249 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24250 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24251 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24252
24253 @example
24254 (: spam-split)
24255 @end example
24256
24257 @vindex spam-split-group
24258 @noindent
24259 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24260 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24261 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24262 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24263 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24264 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24265 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24266 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24267 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24268
24269 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24270
24271 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24272 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24273 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24274 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24275 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24276 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24277 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24278 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24279 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24280 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24281 IMAP Splitting}.
24282
24283 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24284 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24285 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24286 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24287 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24288 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24289 ends, and the following split rule:
24290
24291 @example
24292 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24293 (any "ding" "ding")
24294 (: spam-split)
24295 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24296 "mail")
24297 @end example
24298
24299 @noindent
24300 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24301 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24302 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24303 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24304 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24305 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24306
24307 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24308 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24309 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24310 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24311
24312 @example
24313 nnimap-split-fancy
24314 '(|
24315 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24316 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24317 (any "ding" "ding")
24318 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24319 (: spam-split)
24320 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24321 "mail")
24322 @end example
24323
24324 @noindent
24325 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24326 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24327 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24328 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24329 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24330 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24331 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24332
24333 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24334 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24335 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24336 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24337
24338 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24339 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24340 @c don't.}
24341
24342 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24343 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24344
24345 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24346 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24347 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24348 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24349
24350 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24351 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24352 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24353 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24354
24355 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24356 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24357 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24358
24359 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24360 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24361 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24362 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24363 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24364 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24365 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24366
24367 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24368 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24369 @cindex spam filtering
24370 @cindex spam filtering variables
24371 @cindex spam variables
24372 @cindex spam
24373
24374 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24375 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24376 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24377 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24378 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24379 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24380 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24381
24382 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24383 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24384 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24385 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24386
24387 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24388 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24389 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24390 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24391 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24392 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24393 by customizing the corresponding variable
24394 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24395 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24396 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24397 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24398 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24399 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24400 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24401 default.
24402
24403 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24404 @cindex $
24405 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24406 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24407 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24408 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24409 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24410 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24411 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24412 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24413 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24414 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24415 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24416 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24417 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24418
24419 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24420 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24421 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24422 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24423 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24424 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24425 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24426 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24427
24428 @defvar ham-marks
24429 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24430 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24431 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24432 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24433 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24434 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24435 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24436 happy for you.
24437 @end defvar
24438
24439 @defvar spam-marks
24440 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24441 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24442 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24443 you really want to.
24444 @end defvar
24445
24446 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24447 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24448 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24449 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24450 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24451 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24452 and nothing else.
24453
24454 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24455 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24456 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24457 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24458 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24459 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24460 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24461 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24462 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24463 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24464 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24465 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24466 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24467 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24468 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24469
24470 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24471 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24472
24473 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24474 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24475 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24476
24477 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24478 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24479
24480 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24481 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24482 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24483 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24484 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24485
24486 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24487 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24488 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24489 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24490 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24491 it there.
24492
24493 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24494 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24495 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24496 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24497 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24498 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24499 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24500 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24501 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24502 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24503 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24504 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24505 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24506
24507 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24508 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24509
24510 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24511 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24512 training} groups.
24513
24514 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24515 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24516 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24517 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24518 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24519 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24520 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24521
24522 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24523 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24524 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24525 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24526
24527 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24528 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24529 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24530 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24531 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24532 from the mail server.
24533
24534 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24535 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24536 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24537 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24538
24539 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24540 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24541 @cindex spam filtering
24542 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24543 @cindex spam configuration examples
24544 @cindex spam
24545
24546 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24547
24548 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24549 @example
24550 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24551 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24552 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24553 (spam-initialize)
24554
24555 (setq
24556 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24557 spam-use-BBDB t
24558 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24559 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24560 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24561 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24562 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24563 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24564 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24565 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24566 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24567 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24568 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24569 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24570 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24571 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24572 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24573 (any "ding" "ding")
24574 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24575 (: spam-split)
24576 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24577 "mail"))
24578
24579 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24580
24581 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24582 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24583 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24584 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24585
24586 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24587
24588 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24589 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24590 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24591 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24592 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24593
24594 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24595 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24596
24597 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24598
24599 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24600 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24601
24602 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24603 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24604 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24605
24606 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24607
24608 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24609 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24610
24611 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24612 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24613 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24614 (ham-marks
24615 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24616 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24617 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24618 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24619
24620 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24621 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24622 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24623
24624 @end example
24625
24626 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24627 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24628
24629 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24630 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24631 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24632 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24633 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24634 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24635 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24636 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24637 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24638
24639 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24640 does most of the job for me:
24641
24642 @lisp
24643 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24644 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24645 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24646 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24647 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24648 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24649 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24650 @end lisp
24651
24652 @itemize
24653
24654 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24655
24656 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24657 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24658 bogofilter or DCC).
24659
24660 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24661 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24662 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24663 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24664 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24665 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24666 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24667
24668 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24669 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24670 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24671 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24672 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24673 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24674
24675 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24676
24677 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24678 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24679 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24680 @samp{training.spam}.
24681 @end itemize
24682
24683 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24684
24685 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24686
24687 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24688 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24689 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24690
24691 @lisp
24692 ("^gmane\\."
24693 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24694 @end lisp
24695
24696 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24697 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24698 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24699 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24700 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24701
24702 @node Spam Back Ends
24703 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24704 @cindex spam back ends
24705
24706 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24707 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24708 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24709 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24710 Processors}).
24711
24712 @menu
24713 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24714 * BBDB Whitelists::
24715 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24716 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24717 * Blackholes::
24718 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24719 * Bogofilter::
24720 * SpamAssassin back end::
24721 * ifile spam filtering::
24722 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24723 * SpamOracle::
24724 @end menu
24725
24726 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24727 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24728 @cindex spam filtering
24729 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24730 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24731 @cindex spam
24732
24733 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24734
24735 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24736 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24737 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24738 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24739 be spammers.
24740
24741 @end defvar
24742
24743 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24744
24745 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24746 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24747 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24748 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24749 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24750
24751 @end defvar
24752
24753 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24754
24755 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24756 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24757 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24758
24759 @end defvar
24760
24761 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24762
24763 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24764 customizing the group parameters or the
24765 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24766 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24767 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24768
24769 @emph{WARNING}
24770
24771 Instead of the obsolete
24772 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24773 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24774 the same way, we promise.
24775
24776 @end defvar
24777
24778 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24779
24780 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24781 customizing the group parameters or the
24782 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24783 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24784 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24785 whitelist.
24786
24787 @emph{WARNING}
24788
24789 Instead of the obsolete
24790 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24791 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24792 the same way, we promise.
24793
24794 @end defvar
24795
24796 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24797 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24798 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24799 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24800 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24801
24802 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24803 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24804 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24805 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24806
24807 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24808 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24809 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24810 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24811 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24812 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24813
24814 @node BBDB Whitelists
24815 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24816 @cindex spam filtering
24817 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24818 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24819 @cindex spam
24820
24821 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24822
24823 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24824 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24825 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24826 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24827 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24828 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24829 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24830
24831 @end defvar
24832
24833 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24834
24835 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24836 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24837 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24838 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24839 classified as spammers.
24840
24841 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24842 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24843 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24844 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24845 will be exclusive.
24846
24847 @end defvar
24848
24849 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24850
24851 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24852 customizing the group parameters or the
24853 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24854 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24855 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24856 BBDB.
24857
24858 @emph{WARNING}
24859
24860 Instead of the obsolete
24861 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24862 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24863 the same way, we promise.
24864
24865 @end defvar
24866
24867 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24868 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24869 @cindex spam reporting
24870 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24871 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24872 @cindex spam
24873
24874 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24875
24876 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24877 customizing the group parameters or the
24878 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24879 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24880 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24881 HTTP request.
24882
24883 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24884
24885 @emph{WARNING}
24886
24887 Instead of the obsolete
24888 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24889 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24890 same way, we promise.
24891
24892 @end defvar
24893
24894 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24895
24896 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24897 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24898 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24899 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24900 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24901
24902 @end defvar
24903
24904 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24905
24906 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24907 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24908 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24909
24910 @end defvar
24911
24912 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24913 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24914 @cindex spam filtering
24915 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24916 @cindex spam
24917
24918 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24919
24920 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24921 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24922 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24923 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24924 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24925 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24926
24927 @end defvar
24928
24929 @node Blackholes
24930 @subsubsection Blackholes
24931 @cindex spam filtering
24932 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24933 @cindex spam
24934
24935 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24936
24937 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24938 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24939 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24940 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24941 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24942 contains outdated servers.
24943
24944 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24945 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24946 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24947 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24948 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24949 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24950
24951 @end defvar
24952
24953 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24954
24955 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24956
24957 @end defvar
24958
24959 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24960
24961 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24962 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24963
24964 @end defvar
24965
24966 @defvar spam-use-dig
24967
24968 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24969 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24970
24971 @end defvar
24972
24973 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24974 ham processor for blackholes.
24975
24976 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24977 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24978 @cindex spam filtering
24979 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24980 @cindex spam
24981
24982 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24983
24984 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24985 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24986 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24987 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24988 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24989 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24990
24991 @end defvar
24992
24993 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24994
24995 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24996 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24997
24998 @end defvar
24999
25000 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25001
25002 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25003 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25004
25005 @end defvar
25006
25007 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25008 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25009
25010 @node Bogofilter
25011 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25012 @cindex spam filtering
25013 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25014 @cindex spam
25015
25016 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25017
25018 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25019 speedy Bogofilter.
25020
25021 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25022 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25023 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25024 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25025 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25026 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25027
25028 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25029 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25030 documentation.
25031
25032 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25033 processing will be turned off.
25034
25035 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25036
25037 @end defvar
25038
25039 @table @kbd
25040 @item M s t
25041 @itemx S t
25042 @kindex M s t
25043 @kindex S t
25044 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25045 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25046 @end table
25047
25048 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25049
25050 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25051 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25052 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25053 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25054 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25055 installation documents for details.
25056
25057 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25058
25059 @end defvar
25060
25061 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25062 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25063 customizing the group parameters or the
25064 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25065 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25066 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25067
25068 @emph{WARNING}
25069
25070 Instead of the obsolete
25071 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25072 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25073 the same way, we promise.
25074 @end defvar
25075
25076 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25077 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25078 customizing the group parameters or the
25079 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25080 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25081 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25082 of non-spam messages.
25083
25084 @emph{WARNING}
25085
25086 Instead of the obsolete
25087 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25088 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25089 the same way, we promise.
25090 @end defvar
25091
25092 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25093
25094 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25095 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25096 database directory.
25097
25098 @end defvar
25099
25100 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25101 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25102 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25103 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25104 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25105 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25106
25107 @node SpamAssassin back end
25108 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25109 @cindex spam filtering
25110 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25111 @cindex spam
25112
25113 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25114
25115 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25116
25117 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25118 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25119 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25120 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25121 mode.
25122
25123 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25124 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25125 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25126 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25127 instead.
25128
25129 You should not enable this if you use
25130 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25131
25132 @end defvar
25133
25134 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25135
25136 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25137 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25138
25139 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25140
25141 @end defvar
25142
25143 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25144
25145 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25146 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25147 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25148 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25149
25150 @end defvar
25151
25152 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25153 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25154 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25155 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25156 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25157 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25158 to test this functionality.
25159
25160 @node ifile spam filtering
25161 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25162 @cindex spam filtering
25163 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25164 @cindex spam
25165
25166 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25167
25168 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25169 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25170
25171 @end defvar
25172
25173 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25174
25175 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25176 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25177 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25178
25179 @end defvar
25180
25181 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25182
25183 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25184 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25185 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25186 @end defvar
25187
25188 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25189
25190 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25191 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25192
25193 @end defvar
25194
25195 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25196 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25197 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25198 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25199 functionality.
25200
25201 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25202 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25203 @cindex spam filtering
25204 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25205 @cindex spam-stat
25206 @cindex spam
25207
25208 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25209 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25210 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25211 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25212 spam-stat dictionary}.
25213
25214 @defvar spam-use-stat
25215
25216 @end defvar
25217
25218 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25219 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25220 customizing the group parameters or the
25221 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25222 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25223 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25224
25225 @emph{WARNING}
25226
25227 Instead of the obsolete
25228 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25229 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25230 the same way, we promise.
25231 @end defvar
25232
25233 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25234 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25235 customizing the group parameters or the
25236 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25237 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25238 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25239 of non-spam messages.
25240
25241 @emph{WARNING}
25242
25243 Instead of the obsolete
25244 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25245 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25246 the same way, we promise.
25247 @end defvar
25248
25249 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25250 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25251 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25252 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25253 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25254
25255 @node SpamOracle
25256 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25257 @cindex spam filtering
25258 @cindex SpamOracle
25259 @cindex spam
25260
25261 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25262 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25263 installed separately.
25264
25265 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25266 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25267 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25268 mail as a spam mail or not.
25269
25270 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25271 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25272 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25273
25274 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25275 call SpamOracle.
25276
25277 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25278 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25279 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25280 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25281 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25282 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25283 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25284 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25285
25286 @example
25287 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25288 spam-split-group "Junk"
25289 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25290 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25291 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25292 @end example
25293
25294 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25295 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25296 SpamOracle.
25297 @end defvar
25298
25299 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25300 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25301 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25302 can be customized.
25303 @end defvar
25304
25305 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25306 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25307 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25308 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25309 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25310 database to live somewhere special, set
25311 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25312 @end defvar
25313
25314 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25315 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25316 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25317 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25318 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25319 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25320 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25321 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25322 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25323 @xref{Spam Package}.
25324
25325 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25326 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25327 customizing the group parameter or the
25328 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25329 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25330 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25331
25332 @emph{WARNING}
25333
25334 Instead of the obsolete
25335 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25336 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25337 the same way, we promise.
25338 @end defvar
25339
25340 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25341 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25342 customizing the group parameter or the
25343 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25344 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25345 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25346 messages.
25347
25348 @emph{WARNING}
25349
25350 Instead of the obsolete
25351 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25352 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25353 the same way, we promise.
25354 @end defvar
25355
25356 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25357 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25358 messages.
25359 @example
25360 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25361 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25362 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25363 @end example
25364 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25365 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25366 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25367 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25368 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25369 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25370
25371 @node Extending the Spam package
25372 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25373 @cindex spam filtering
25374 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25375 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25376
25377 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25378 incoming mail, provide the following:
25379
25380 @enumerate
25381
25382 @item
25383 Code
25384
25385 @lisp
25386 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25387 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25388 @end lisp
25389
25390 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25391
25392 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25393 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25394 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25395 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25396 register/unregister spam and ham.
25397
25398 @item
25399 Functionality
25400
25401 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25402 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25403 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25404 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25405 why you aren't.
25406
25407 @end enumerate
25408
25409 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25410
25411 @enumerate
25412
25413 @item
25414 Code
25415
25416 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25417 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25418
25419 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25420 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25421 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25422 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25423
25424 @lisp
25425 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25426 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25427 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25428
25429 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25430 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25431 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25432
25433 @end lisp
25434
25435 @item
25436 Gnus parameters
25437
25438 Add
25439 @lisp
25440 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25441 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25442 @end lisp
25443 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25444 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25445 variable customization.
25446
25447 Add
25448 @lisp
25449 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25450 @end lisp
25451 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25452 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25453
25454 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25455 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25456
25457
25458 @enumerate
25459
25460 @item
25461 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25462
25463 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25464 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25465 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25466
25467 @item
25468 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25469
25470 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25471 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25472 such a back end.
25473
25474 @item
25475 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25476
25477 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25478 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25479 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25480 back ends.
25481
25482 @item
25483 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25484
25485 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25486 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25487 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25488
25489 @item
25490 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25491
25492 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25493 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25494 set up this way.
25495
25496 @item
25497 @code{spam-install-backend}
25498
25499 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25500 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25501 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25502
25503 @item
25504 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25505
25506 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25507 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25508 never install such a back end.
25509 @end enumerate
25510
25511 @end enumerate
25512
25513 @node Spam Statistics Package
25514 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25515 @cindex Paul Graham
25516 @cindex Graham, Paul
25517 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25518 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25519 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25520
25521 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25522 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25523 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25524 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25525 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25526 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25527 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25528 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25529 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25530 or not.
25531
25532 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25533 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25534 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25535 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25536 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25537 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25538 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25539 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25540
25541 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25542 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25543 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25544
25545 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25546 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25547 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25548 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25549 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25550
25551 @menu
25552 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25553 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25554 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25555 @end menu
25556
25557 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25558 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25559
25560 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25561 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25562 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25563 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25564 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25565
25566 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25567 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25568 per mail. Use the following:
25569
25570 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25571 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25572 is treated as one spam mail.
25573 @end defun
25574
25575 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25576 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25577 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25578 @end defun
25579
25580 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25581 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25582 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25583 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25584 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25585 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25586
25587 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25588 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25589 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25590 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25591 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25592
25593 @defvar spam-stat
25594 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25595 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25596 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25597 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25598 @end defvar
25599
25600 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25601 reset the dictionary.
25602
25603 @defun spam-stat-reset
25604 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25605 @end defun
25606
25607 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25608 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25609 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25610 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25611 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25612 only non-spam mails.
25613
25614 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25615 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25616 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25617 @end defun
25618
25619 @defun spam-stat-save
25620 Save the dictionary.
25621 @end defun
25622
25623 @defvar spam-stat-file
25624 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25625 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25626 @end defvar
25627
25628 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25629 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25630
25631 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25632 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25633
25634 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25635
25636 @lisp
25637 (require 'spam-stat)
25638 (spam-stat-load)
25639 @end lisp
25640
25641 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25642 created.
25643
25644 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25645 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25646 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25647 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25648
25649 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25650 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25651 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25652 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25653
25654 @lisp
25655 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25656 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25657 "mail.misc"))
25658 @end lisp
25659
25660 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25661 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25662 @end defvar
25663
25664 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25665 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25666 expression are considered potential spam.
25667
25668 @lisp
25669 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25670 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25671 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25672 "mail.misc"))
25673 @end lisp
25674
25675 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25676 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25677 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25678 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25679 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25680
25681 @lisp
25682 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25683 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25684 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25685 "mail.misc"))
25686 @end lisp
25687
25688 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25689 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25690 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25691 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25692 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25693 dictionary!
25694
25695 @lisp
25696 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25697 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25698 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25699 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25700 "mail.misc"))
25701 @end lisp
25702
25703
25704 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25705 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25706
25707 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25708
25709 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25710 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25711 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25712 @end defun
25713
25714 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25715 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25716 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25717 @end defun
25718
25719 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25720 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25721 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25722 already been processed as non-spam.
25723 @end defun
25724
25725 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25726 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25727 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25728 been processed as spam.
25729 @end defun
25730
25731 @defun spam-stat-save
25732 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25733 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25734 @end defun
25735
25736 @defun spam-stat-load
25737 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25738 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25739 @end defun
25740
25741 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25742 Return the spam score for a word.
25743 @end defun
25744
25745 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25746 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25747 @end defun
25748
25749 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25750 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25751 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25752 @end defun
25753
25754 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25755 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25756
25757 @lisp
25758 (require 'spam-stat)
25759 (spam-stat-load)
25760 @end lisp
25761
25762 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25763
25764 @smallexample
25765 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25766 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25767 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25768 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25769 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25770 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25771 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25772 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25773 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25774 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25775 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25776 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25777 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25778 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25779 @end smallexample
25780
25781 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25782
25783 @smallexample
25784 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25785 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25786 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25787 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25788 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25789 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25790 @end smallexample
25791
25792 @node The Gnus Registry
25793 @section The Gnus Registry
25794 @cindex registry
25795 @cindex split
25796 @cindex track
25797
25798 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25799 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25800 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25801 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25802 features are pretty cool.
25803
25804 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25805 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25806
25807 @enumerate
25808 @item
25809 Split messages to their parent
25810
25811 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25812 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25813 available.
25814
25815 @item
25816 Refer to messages by ID
25817
25818 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25819 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25820 of the group the message is in.
25821
25822 @item
25823 Store custom flags and keywords
25824
25825 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25826 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25827 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25828 etc. backends.
25829
25830 @item
25831 Store arbitrary data
25832
25833 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25834 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25835 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25836 @end enumerate
25837
25838 @menu
25839 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25840 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25841 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25842 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25843 * Store arbitrary data::
25844 @end menu
25845
25846 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25847 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25848
25849 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25850
25851 @lisp
25852 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25853
25854 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25855 @end lisp
25856
25857 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25858 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25859 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.) so
25860 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25861 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25862
25863 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25864 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25865
25866 @lisp
25867 (setq
25868 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25869 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25870 ("nnrss" t)
25871 ("spam" t)
25872 ("train" t))
25873 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25874 ;; this is the default
25875 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25876 @end lisp
25877
25878 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25879 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25880 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25881 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25882 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25883 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25884
25885 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25886 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25887 the general settings.
25888
25889 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25890 The groups that will not be followed by
25891 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25892 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25893 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25894 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25895 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25896 @end defvar
25897
25898 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25899 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25900 registry will keep.
25901 @end defvar
25902
25903 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25904 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25905 the registry will keep after pruning.
25906 @end defvar
25907
25908 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25909 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25910 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25911 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25912 @end defvar
25913
25914 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25915 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25916
25917 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25918 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25919 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25920 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25921
25922 @vindex nnregistry
25923 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25924
25925 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25926 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25927 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25928 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25929 lines:
25930
25931 @example
25932 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25933 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25934 ;; knows where the article is.
25935 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25936
25937 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25938
25939 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
25940 '(current
25941 (nnregistry)
25942 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
25943 @end example
25944
25945 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25946 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25947 all else fails, using Gmane.
25948
25949 @node Fancy splitting to parent
25950 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25951
25952 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25953
25954 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25955 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25956 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25957 strategy.
25958
25959 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25960 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25961 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
25962 have to put a rule like this:
25963
25964 @lisp
25965 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
25966
25967 ;; split to parent: you need this
25968 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25969
25970 ;; other rules, as an example
25971 (: spam-split)
25972 ;; default mailbox
25973 "mail")
25974 @end lisp
25975
25976 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
25977 following variables.
25978
25979 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
25980 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
25981 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
25982 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
25983 people don't stick to the same groups.
25984 @end defvar
25985
25986 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
25987 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
25988 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
25989 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
25990 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
25991 works best.
25992 @end defvar
25993
25994 @node Store custom flags and keywords
25995 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
25996
25997 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
25998 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
25999 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26000
26001 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26002 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26003 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26004 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26005 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26006 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26007
26008 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26009 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26010 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26011 letter.
26012 @end defvar
26013
26014 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26015 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26016 will offer the available marks for completion.
26017 @end defun
26018
26019 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26020 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26021 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26022 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26023
26024 @lisp
26025 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26026 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
26027 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26028
26029 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26030 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26031 @end lisp
26032
26033
26034 @node Store arbitrary data
26035 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26036
26037 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26038 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26039 storage).
26040
26041 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26042 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26043 @end defun
26044
26045 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26046 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26047 @end defun
26048
26049 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26050 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26051 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26052 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26053 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26054 precious.
26055 @end defvar
26056
26057 @node Other modes
26058 @section Interaction with other modes
26059
26060 @subsection Dired
26061 @cindex dired
26062
26063 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26064 buffers. It is enabled with
26065 @lisp
26066 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26067 @end lisp
26068
26069 @table @kbd
26070 @item C-c C-m C-a
26071 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26072 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26073 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26074 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26075
26076 @item C-c C-m C-l
26077 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26078 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26079 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26080 buffer.
26081
26082 @item C-c C-m C-p
26083 @findex gnus-dired-print
26084 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26085 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26086 @end table
26087
26088 @node Various Various
26089 @section Various Various
26090 @cindex mode lines
26091 @cindex highlights
26092
26093 @table @code
26094
26095 @item gnus-home-directory
26096 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26097 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26098 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26099
26100 @item gnus-directory
26101 @vindex gnus-directory
26102 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26103 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26104 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26105
26106 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26107 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26108 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26109 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26110
26111 @item gnus-default-directory
26112 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26113 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26114 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26115 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26116 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26117 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26118 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26119
26120 @item gnus-verbose
26121 @vindex gnus-verbose
26122 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26123 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26124 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26125 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26126 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26127
26128 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26129 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26130 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26131 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26132
26133 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26134 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26135 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26136 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26137 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26138 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26139 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26140 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26141 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26142 displayed in the echo area.
26143
26144 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26145 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26146 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26147 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26148 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26149 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26150 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26151 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26152 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26153 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26154
26155 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26156 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26157 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26158 read when doing the operation described above.
26159
26160 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26161 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26162 @cindex file names
26163 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26164 @cindex characters in file names
26165 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26166 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26167 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26168
26169 @lisp
26170 @group
26171 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26172 '((?: . ?_)))
26173 @end group
26174 @end lisp
26175
26176 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26177 Windows (phooey) systems.
26178
26179 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26180 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26181 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26182 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26183 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26184
26185 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26186 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26187 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26188 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26189 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26190
26191 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26192 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26193 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26194
26195 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26196 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26197
26198 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26199 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26200 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26201 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26202 group).
26203
26204 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26205
26206 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26207 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26208 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26209 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26210 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26211 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26212 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26213 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26214 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26215
26216 @end table
26217
26218 @node The End
26219 @chapter The End
26220
26221 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26222 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26223
26224 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26225
26226 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26227
26228 @quotation
26229 @strong{Te Deum}
26230
26231 @sp 1
26232 Not because of victories @*
26233 I sing,@*
26234 having none,@*
26235 but for the common sunshine,@*
26236 the breeze,@*
26237 the largess of the spring.
26238
26239 @sp 1
26240 Not for victory@*
26241 but for the day's work done@*
26242 as well as I was able;@*
26243 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26244 but at the common table.@*
26245 @end quotation
26246
26247
26248 @node Appendices
26249 @chapter Appendices
26250
26251 @menu
26252 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26253 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26254 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26255 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26256 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26257 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26258 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26259 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26260 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26261 @end menu
26262
26263
26264 @node XEmacs
26265 @section XEmacs
26266 @cindex XEmacs
26267 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26268
26269 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26270 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26271 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26272 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26273 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26274 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26275
26276
26277 @node History
26278 @section History
26279
26280 @cindex history
26281 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26282 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26283
26284 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26285 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26286 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26287 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26288 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26289
26290 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26291 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26292 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26293 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26294 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26295 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26296
26297 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26298 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26299 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26300 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26301
26302 @menu
26303 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26304 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26305 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26306 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26307 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26308 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26309 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26310 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26311 @end menu
26312
26313
26314 @node Gnus Versions
26315 @subsection Gnus Versions
26316 @cindex ding Gnus
26317 @cindex September Gnus
26318 @cindex Red Gnus
26319 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26320 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26321 @cindex Oort Gnus
26322 @cindex No Gnus
26323 @cindex Ma Gnus
26324 @cindex Gnus versions
26325
26326 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26327 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26328 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26329
26330 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26331 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26332
26333 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26334 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26335
26336 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26337 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26338
26339 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26340 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26341 1999.
26342
26343 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26344 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26345
26346 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26347
26348 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26349 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26350 with the information when possible).
26351
26352 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26353
26354 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
26355 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26356 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus'' -- don't
26357 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26358 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26359 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26360 that instead.
26361
26362
26363 @node Why?
26364 @subsection Why?
26365
26366 What's the point of Gnus?
26367
26368 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26369 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26370 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26371 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26372 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26373 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26374 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26375 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26376 keep track of millions of people who post?
26377
26378 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26379 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26380 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26381 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26382 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26383 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26384 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26385 every one of you to explore and invent.
26386
26387 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26388 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26389
26390
26391 @node Compatibility
26392 @subsection Compatibility
26393
26394 @cindex compatibility
26395 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26396 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26397 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26398
26399 Our motto is:
26400 @quotation
26401 @cartouche
26402 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26403 @end cartouche
26404 @end quotation
26405
26406 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26407 their names.
26408
26409 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26410 Articles}.
26411
26412 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26413 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26414 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26415 important variables have their values copied into their global
26416 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26417 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26418
26419 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26420 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26421 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26422 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26423 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26424 peculiar results.
26425
26426 @cindex hilit19
26427 @cindex highlighting
26428 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26429 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26430 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26431 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26432 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26433 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26434 Away!
26435
26436 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26437 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26438 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26439 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26440
26441 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26442 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26443 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26444 to stop doing it the old way.
26445
26446 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26447
26448 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26449 @findex gnus-bug
26450 @cindex reporting bugs
26451 @cindex bugs
26452 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26453 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26454 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26455
26456 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26457 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26458 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26459 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26460 up at you.
26461
26462
26463 @node Conformity
26464 @subsection Conformity
26465
26466 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26467 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26468 with, of course.
26469
26470 @table @strong
26471
26472 @item RFC (2)822
26473 @cindex RFC 822
26474 @cindex RFC 2822
26475 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26476
26477 @item RFC 1036
26478 @cindex RFC 1036
26479 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26480
26481 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26482 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26483 We do have some breaches to this one.
26484
26485 @table @emph
26486
26487 @item X-Newsreader
26488 @itemx User-Agent
26489 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26490 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26491 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26492 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26493 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26494 @end table
26495
26496 @item USEFOR
26497 @cindex USEFOR
26498 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26499 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26500 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26501 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26502
26503 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
26504 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26505 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26506
26507 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
26508 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26509
26510 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26511 @cindex RFC 1991
26512 @cindex RFC 2440
26513 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26514 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26515 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26516 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26517 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26518 decryption).
26519
26520 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
26521 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26522 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26523 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26524
26525 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
26526 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26527
26528 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26529 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26530 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26531 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26532 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26533 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26534 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26535 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26536
26537 @end table
26538
26539 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26540 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26541 know.
26542
26543
26544 @node Emacsen
26545 @subsection Emacsen
26546 @cindex Emacsen
26547 @cindex XEmacs
26548 @cindex Mule
26549 @cindex Emacs
26550
26551 This version of Gnus should work on:
26552
26553 @itemize @bullet
26554
26555 @item
26556 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26557
26558 @item
26559 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26560
26561 @end itemize
26562
26563 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26564 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26565 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26566 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26567
26568 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26569 @c synced here!
26570
26571 @node Gnus Development
26572 @subsection Gnus Development
26573
26574 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26575 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26576 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26577 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26578 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26579 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26580 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26581 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26582
26583 After futzing around for 10-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26584 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26585 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26586 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26587 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26588 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26589 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26590 in Emacs.
26591
26592 @cindex Incoming*
26593 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26594 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26595 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26596 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26597 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26598
26599 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26600 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26601 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26602 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26603 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26604 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26605 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26606 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26607 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26608 can't be assumed to do so.
26609
26610 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26611 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26612 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26613
26614 @cindex Incoming*
26615 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26616 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26617 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26618 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26619 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26620
26621 @node Contributors
26622 @subsection Contributors
26623 @cindex contributors
26624
26625 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26626 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26627 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26628 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26629 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26630 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26631 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26632 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26633 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26634 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26635
26636 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26637 wrong show.
26638
26639 @itemize @bullet
26640
26641 @item
26642 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26643
26644 @item
26645 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26646 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26647 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26648 functionality and stuff.
26649
26650 @item
26651 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26652 well as numerous other things).
26653
26654 @item
26655 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26656
26657 @item
26658 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26659
26660 @item
26661 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26662
26663 @item
26664 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26665
26666 @item
26667 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26668 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26669
26670 @item
26671 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26672
26673 @item
26674 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26675
26676 @item
26677 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26678
26679 @item
26680 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26681
26682 @item
26683 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26684
26685 @item
26686 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26687
26688 @item
26689 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26690 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26691
26692 @item
26693 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26694
26695 @item
26696 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26697
26698 @item
26699 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26700
26701 @item
26702 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26703 .newsrc files.
26704
26705 @item
26706 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26707
26708 @item
26709 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26710
26711 @item
26712 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26713
26714 @item
26715 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26716 well as autoconf support.
26717
26718 @end itemize
26719
26720 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26721 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26722
26723 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26724
26725 Christopher Davis,
26726 Andrew Eskilsson,
26727 Kai Grossjohann,
26728 Kevin Greiner,
26729 Jesper Harder,
26730 Paul Jarc,
26731 Simon Josefsson,
26732 David K@aa{}gedal,
26733 Richard Pieri,
26734 Fabrice Popineau,
26735 Daniel Quinlan,
26736 Michael Shields,
26737 Reiner Steib,
26738 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26739 Jack Vinson,
26740 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26741 and
26742 Teodor Zlatanov.
26743
26744 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26745
26746 Jari Aalto,
26747 Adrian Aichner,
26748 Vladimir Alexiev,
26749 Russ Allbery,
26750 Peter Arius,
26751 Matt Armstrong,
26752 Marc Auslander,
26753 Miles Bader,
26754 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26755 Frank Bennett,
26756 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26757 Chris Bone,
26758 Mark Borges,
26759 Mark Boyns,
26760 Lance A. Brown,
26761 Rob Browning,
26762 Kees de Bruin,
26763 Martin Buchholz,
26764 Joe Buehler,
26765 Kevin Buhr,
26766 Alastair Burt,
26767 Joao Cachopo,
26768 Zlatko Calusic,
26769 Massimo Campostrini,
26770 Castor,
26771 David Charlap,
26772 Dan Christensen,
26773 Kevin Christian,
26774 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26775 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26776 Laura Conrad,
26777 Michael R. Cook,
26778 Glenn Coombs,
26779 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26780 Neil Crellin,
26781 Frank D. Cringle,
26782 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26783 Andre Deparade,
26784 Ulrik Dickow,
26785 Dave Disser,
26786 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26787 Joev Dubach,
26788 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26789 Dave Edmondson,
26790 Paul Eggert,
26791 Mark W. Eichin,
26792 Karl Eichwalder,
26793 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26794 Michael Ernst,
26795 Luc Van Eycken,
26796 Sam Falkner,
26797 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26798 Sigbjorn Finne,
26799 Sven Fischer,
26800 Paul Fisher,
26801 Decklin Foster,
26802 Gary D. Foster,
26803 Paul Franklin,
26804 Guy Geens,
26805 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26806 David S. Goldberg,
26807 Michelangelo Grigni,
26808 Dale Hagglund,
26809 D. Hall,
26810 Magnus Hammerin,
26811 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26812 Raja R. Harinath,
26813 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26814 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26815 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26816 Scott Hofmann,
26817 Tassilo Horn,
26818 Marc Horowitz,
26819 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26820 Richard Hoskins,
26821 Brad Howes,
26822 Miguel de Icaza,
26823 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26824 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26825 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26826 Lee Iverson,
26827 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26828 Rajappa Iyer,
26829 Andreas Jaeger,
26830 Adam P. Jenkins,
26831 Randell Jesup,
26832 Fred Johansen,
26833 Gareth Jones,
26834 Greg Klanderman,
26835 Karl Kleinpaste,
26836 Michael Klingbeil,
26837 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26838 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26839 Petr Konecny,
26840 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26841 Thor Kristoffersen,
26842 Jens Lautenbacher,
26843 Martin Larose,
26844 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26845 Joerg Lenneis,
26846 Carsten Leonhardt,
26847 James LewisMoss,
26848 Christian Limpach,
26849 Markus Linnala,
26850 Dave Love,
26851 Mike McEwan,
26852 Tonny Madsen,
26853 Shlomo Mahlab,
26854 Nat Makarevitch,
26855 Istvan Marko,
26856 David Martin,
26857 Jason R. Mastaler,
26858 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26859 Timo Metzemakers,
26860 Richard Mlynarik,
26861 Lantz Moore,
26862 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26863 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26864 Hrvoje Niksic,
26865 Andy Norman,
26866 Fred Oberhauser,
26867 C. R. Oldham,
26868 Alexandre Oliva,
26869 Ken Olstad,
26870 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26871 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26872 Ettore Perazzoli,
26873 William Perry,
26874 Stephen Peters,
26875 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26876 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26877 Matt Pharr,
26878 Andy Piper,
26879 John McClary Prevost,
26880 Bill Pringlemeir,
26881 Mike Pullen,
26882 Jim Radford,
26883 Colin Rafferty,
26884 Lasse Rasinen,
26885 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26886 Joe Reiss,
26887 Renaud Rioboo,
26888 Roland B. Roberts,
26889 Bart Robinson,
26890 Christian von Roques,
26891 Markus Rost,
26892 Jason Rumney,
26893 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26894 Jay Sachs,
26895 Dewey M. Sasser,
26896 Conrad Sauerwald,
26897 Loren Schall,
26898 Dan Schmidt,
26899 Ralph Schleicher,
26900 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26901 Andreas Schwab,
26902 Randal L. Schwartz,
26903 Danny Siu,
26904 Matt Simmons,
26905 Paul D. Smith,
26906 Jeff Sparkes,
26907 Toby Speight,
26908 Michael Sperber,
26909 Darren Stalder,
26910 Richard Stallman,
26911 Greg Stark,
26912 Sam Steingold,
26913 Paul Stevenson,
26914 Jonas Steverud,
26915 Paul Stodghill,
26916 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26917 Kurt Swanson,
26918 Samuel Tardieu,
26919 Teddy,
26920 Chuck Thompson,
26921 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26922 Philippe Troin,
26923 James Troup,
26924 Trung Tran-Duc,
26925 Jack Twilley,
26926 Aaron M. Ucko,
26927 Aki Vehtari,
26928 Didier Verna,
26929 Vladimir Volovich,
26930 Jan Vroonhof,
26931 Stefan Waldherr,
26932 Pete Ware,
26933 Barry A. Warsaw,
26934 Christoph Wedler,
26935 Joe Wells,
26936 Lee Willis,
26937 and
26938 Lloyd Zusman.
26939
26940
26941 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26942 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26943 (550kB and counting).
26944
26945 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26946 sure.
26947
26948 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26949 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26950
26951
26952 @node New Features
26953 @subsection New Features
26954 @cindex new features
26955
26956 @menu
26957 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
26958 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
26959 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
26960 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
26961 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
26962 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
26963 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
26964 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
26965 @end menu
26966
26967 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
26968 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
26969 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
26970
26971 @node ding Gnus
26972 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
26973
26974 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
26975
26976 @itemize @bullet
26977
26978 @item
26979 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
26980 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
26981
26982 @item
26983 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
26984 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
26985
26986 @item
26987 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
26988
26989 @item
26990 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
26991 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
26992 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
26993
26994 @item
26995 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
26996 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
26997 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
26998 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26999
27000 @item
27001 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27002 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27003
27004 @item
27005 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27006 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27007 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27008
27009 @item
27010 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27011 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27012
27013 @item
27014 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27015 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27016 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27017
27018 @item
27019 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27020 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27021 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27022
27023 @item
27024 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27025 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27026
27027 @item
27028 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27029 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27030
27031 @item
27032 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27033 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27034
27035 @item
27036 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27037 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27038
27039 @item
27040 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27041 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27042
27043 @item
27044 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27045
27046 @item
27047 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27048 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27049
27050 @item
27051 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27052 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27053
27054 @item
27055 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27056 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27057
27058 @item
27059 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27060
27061 @item
27062 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27063 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27064
27065 @item
27066 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27067 Articles}).
27068
27069 @item
27070 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27071 Buttons}).
27072
27073 @item
27074 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27075 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27076
27077 @end itemize
27078
27079
27080 @node September Gnus
27081 @subsubsection September Gnus
27082
27083 @iftex
27084 @iflatex
27085 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27086 @end iflatex
27087 @end iftex
27088
27089 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27090
27091 @itemize @bullet
27092
27093 @item
27094 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27095 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27096 now obsolete.
27097
27098 @item
27099 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27100 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27101 Threading}).
27102
27103 @lisp
27104 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27105 @end lisp
27106
27107 @item
27108 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27109 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27110
27111 @item
27112 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27113 referred.
27114
27115 @item
27116 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27117
27118 @item
27119 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27120
27121 @item
27122 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27123
27124 @lisp
27125 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27126 @end lisp
27127
27128 @item
27129 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27130 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27131
27132 @lisp
27133 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27134 @end lisp
27135
27136 @item
27137 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27138 Groups}).
27139
27140 @item
27141 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27142 Topics}).
27143
27144 @lisp
27145 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27146 @end lisp
27147
27148 @item
27149 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27150
27151 @item
27152 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27153 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27154
27155 @lisp
27156 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27157 @end lisp
27158
27159 @item
27160 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27161 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27162
27163 @item
27164 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27165
27166 @item
27167 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27168 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27169 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27170
27171 @item
27172 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27173
27174 @item
27175 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27176
27177 @item
27178 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27179 Groups}).
27180
27181 @item
27182 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27183 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27184
27185 @item
27186 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27187 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27188
27189 @item
27190 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27191 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27192
27193 @item
27194 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27195 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27196 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27197
27198 @item
27199 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27200 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27201
27202 @item
27203 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27204
27205 @item
27206 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27207
27208 @item
27209 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27210
27211 @item
27212 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27213
27214 @item
27215 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27216 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27217
27218 @item
27219 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27220 Layout}).
27221
27222 @item
27223 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27224 @iftex
27225 @iflatex
27226 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27227 @end iflatex
27228 @end iftex
27229
27230 @item
27231 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27232
27233 @lisp
27234 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27235 @end lisp
27236
27237 @item
27238 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27239
27240 @item
27241 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27242
27243 @item
27244 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27245 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27246
27247 @lisp
27248 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27249 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27250 @end lisp
27251
27252 @item
27253 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27254 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27255
27256 @lisp
27257 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27258 @end lisp
27259
27260 @item
27261 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27262 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27263
27264 @item
27265 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27266
27267 @item
27268 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27269 Articles}).
27270
27271 @lisp
27272 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27273 @end lisp
27274
27275 @item
27276 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27277 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27278
27279 @lisp
27280 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27281 @end lisp
27282
27283 @item
27284 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27285 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27286
27287 @item
27288 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27289 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27290
27291 @lisp
27292 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27293 @end lisp
27294
27295 @item
27296 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27297
27298 @item
27299 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27300
27301 @item
27302 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27303
27304 @end itemize
27305
27306
27307 @node Red Gnus
27308 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27309
27310 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27311
27312 @iftex
27313 @iflatex
27314 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27315 @end iflatex
27316 @end iftex
27317
27318 @itemize @bullet
27319
27320 @item
27321 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27322
27323 @item
27324 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27325 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27326
27327 @item
27328 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27329 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27330 Scoring}).
27331
27332 @item
27333 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27334 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27335
27336 @item
27337 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27338
27339 @item
27340 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27341 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27342
27343 @lisp
27344 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27345 @end lisp
27346
27347 @item
27348 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27349 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27350 been added.
27351
27352 @item
27353 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27354 Server Internals}).
27355
27356 @item
27357 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27358 Parameters}).
27359
27360 @item
27361 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27362
27363 @item
27364 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27365 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27366
27367 @item
27368 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27369 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27370 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27371
27372 @item
27373 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27374 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27375
27376 @item
27377 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27378 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27379
27380 @item
27381 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27382 (@pxref{Undo}).
27383
27384 @item
27385 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27386 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27387
27388 @item
27389 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27390 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27391
27392 @lisp
27393 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27394 @end lisp
27395
27396 @item
27397 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27398
27399 @lisp
27400 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27401 @end lisp
27402
27403 @item
27404 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27405 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27406
27407 @item
27408 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27409 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27410
27411 @item
27412 A new command for reading collections of documents
27413 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27414 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27415
27416 @item
27417 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27418 Marks}).
27419
27420 @item
27421 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27422 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27423
27424 @item
27425 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27426 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27427 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27428
27429 @item
27430 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27431 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27432 Sorting}).
27433
27434 @item
27435 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27436 Groups}).
27437
27438 @item
27439 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27440 Commands}).
27441 @iftex
27442 @iflatex
27443 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27444 @end iflatex
27445 @end iftex
27446
27447 @item
27448 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27449 Variables}).
27450
27451 @item
27452 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27453 Mail}).
27454
27455 @item
27456 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27457 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27458
27459 @item
27460 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27461
27462 @end itemize
27463
27464
27465 @node Quassia Gnus
27466 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27467
27468 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27469
27470 @itemize @bullet
27471
27472 @item
27473 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27474 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27475 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27476
27477 @item
27478 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27479 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27480 group, which is created automatically.
27481
27482 @item
27483 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27484 values.
27485
27486 @item
27487 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27488
27489 @item
27490 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27491 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27492
27493 @item
27494 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27495 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27496
27497 @item
27498 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27499
27500 @item
27501 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27502 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27503
27504 @item
27505 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27506
27507 @item
27508 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27509 details.
27510
27511 @item
27512 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27513 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27514
27515 @item
27516 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27517 control over simplification.
27518
27519 @item
27520 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27521
27522 @item
27523 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27524 limit.
27525
27526 @item
27527 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27528
27529 @item
27530 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27531
27532 @item
27533 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27534 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27535 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27536
27537 @item
27538 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27539 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27540
27541 @item
27542 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27543 text---@kbd{W d}.
27544
27545 @item
27546 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27547 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27548
27549 @item
27550 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27551 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27552
27553 @item
27554 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27555 has been added.
27556
27557 @item
27558 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27559
27560 @item
27561 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27562
27563 @item
27564 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27565 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27566
27567 @item
27568 A new function for citing in Message has been
27569 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27570
27571 @item
27572 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27573
27574 @item
27575 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27576 been added.
27577
27578 @item
27579 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27580 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27581
27582 @item
27583 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27584 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27585
27586 @item
27587 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27588
27589 @item
27590 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27591
27592 @end itemize
27593
27594 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27595 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27596
27597 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27598
27599 @itemize @bullet
27600
27601 @item
27602 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27603 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27604
27605 If you used procmail like in
27606
27607 @lisp
27608 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27609 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27610 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27611 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27612 @end lisp
27613
27614 this now has changed to
27615
27616 @lisp
27617 (setq mail-sources
27618 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27619 :suffix ".in")))
27620 @end lisp
27621
27622 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27623
27624 @item
27625 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27626 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27627
27628 @item
27629 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27630 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27631
27632 @item
27633 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27634 called to position point.
27635
27636 @item
27637 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27638 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27639
27640 @item
27641 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27642 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27643
27644 @item
27645 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27646 subtly different manner.
27647
27648 @item
27649 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27650 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27651 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27652
27653 @item
27654 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27655
27656 @end itemize
27657
27658 @node Oort Gnus
27659 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27660 @cindex Oort Gnus
27661
27662 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27663
27664 @itemize @bullet
27665
27666 @item Installation changes
27667 @c ***********************
27668
27669 @itemize @bullet
27670 @item
27671 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27672
27673 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27674 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27675 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27676 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27677 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27678 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27679 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27680 isn't save in general.
27681
27682 @item
27683 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27684 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27685 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27686 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27687 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27688 remove-installed-shadows}.
27689
27690 @item
27691 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27692
27693 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27694 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27695 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27696 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27697 the second parameter.
27698
27699 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27700 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27701 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27702 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27703 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27704 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27705 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27706 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27707 cycle used under Unix systems.
27708
27709 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27710 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27711
27712 @item
27713 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27714
27715 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27716 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27717 hierarchy.
27718
27719 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27720 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27721 @item
27722 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27723
27724 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27725 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27726 lisp directory into load-path.
27727
27728 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27729 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27730
27731 @end itemize
27732
27733 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27734 @c *****************************************
27735
27736 @itemize @bullet
27737
27738 @item
27739 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27740 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27741
27742 @item
27743 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27744
27745 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27746 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27747
27748 @item
27749 Improved anti-spam features.
27750
27751 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27752 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27753 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27754 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27755 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27756 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27757
27758 @item
27759 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27760
27761 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27762 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27763 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27764 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27765 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27766
27767 @end itemize
27768
27769 @item Changes in group mode
27770 @c ************************
27771
27772 @itemize @bullet
27773
27774 @item
27775 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27776 using @kbd{G M}.
27777
27778 @item
27779 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27780
27781 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27782 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27783
27784 @item
27785 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27786
27787 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27788 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27789 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27790 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27791 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27792 parameters, a'la:
27793 @lisp
27794 (setq gnus-parameters
27795 '(("mail\\..*"
27796 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27797 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27798 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27799 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27800 @end lisp
27801
27802 @item
27803 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27804
27805 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27806 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27807 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27808 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27809 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27810 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27811 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27812 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27813 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27814
27815 @item
27816 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27817
27818 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27819 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27820 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27821
27822 @item
27823 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27824 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27825
27826 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27827 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27828 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27829 @lisp
27830 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27831 @end lisp
27832
27833 @item
27834 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27835 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27836 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27837
27838 @end itemize
27839
27840 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27841 @c **************************************
27842
27843 @itemize @bullet
27844
27845 @item
27846 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27847 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27848 region if the region is active.
27849
27850 @item
27851 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27852 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27853
27854 @item
27855 Article Buttons
27856
27857 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27858 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27859 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27860 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27861
27862 @item
27863 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27864
27865 @item
27866 Picons
27867
27868 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27869 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27870
27871 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27872 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27873 @xref{Picons}.
27874
27875 @item
27876 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27877 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27878
27879 @item
27880 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27881
27882 @item
27883 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27884 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27885
27886 @item
27887 Warn about email replies to news
27888
27889 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27890 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27891 you.
27892
27893 @item
27894 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27895 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27896 built.
27897
27898 @item
27899 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27900 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27901
27902 @item
27903 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27904 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27905
27906 @item
27907 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27908 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27909
27910 @item
27911 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27912
27913 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27914 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27915 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27916 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27917 citations.
27918
27919 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27920 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27921 Outlook (Express) articles.
27922
27923 @item
27924 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27925
27926 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27927 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27928 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27929 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27930
27931 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27932 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27933 message cited below.
27934
27935 @item
27936 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
27937 Emacs too.
27938
27939 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27940 disable it.
27941
27942 @item
27943 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27944
27945 @item
27946 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27947 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27948
27949 @item
27950 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27951
27952 @item
27953 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27954
27955 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27956 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27957 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
27958 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
27959 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
27960 groups.
27961
27962 @item
27963 Deleting of attachments.
27964
27965 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
27966 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27967 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27968 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27969 that support editing.
27970
27971 @item
27972 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27973
27974 The default value is determined from the
27975 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27976 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
27977 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
27978
27979 @item
27980 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
27981
27982 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
27983 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
27984 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
27985
27986 @item
27987 Extended format specs.
27988
27989 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
27990 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
27991 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
27992 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
27993 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
27994 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27995
27996 @item
27997 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27998 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27999
28000 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28001 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28002 out other articles.
28003
28004 @item
28005 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28006
28007 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28008 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28009 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28010 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28011
28012 @item
28013 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28014
28015 @end itemize
28016
28017 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28018 @c ****************************************************
28019
28020 @itemize @bullet
28021
28022 @item
28023 Delayed articles
28024
28025 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28026 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28027 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28028
28029 @item
28030 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28031 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28032
28033 @item
28034 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28035 Gcc articles as read.
28036
28037 @item
28038 Externalizing of attachments
28039
28040 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28041 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28042 local files as external parts.
28043
28044 @item
28045 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28046 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28047
28048 @item
28049 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28050
28051 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28052 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28053 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28054 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28055 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28056 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28057 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28058 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28059 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28060
28061 @item
28062 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28063
28064 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28065 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28066 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28067 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28068 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28069 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28070
28071 @item
28072 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28073 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28074 @code{nil}.
28075
28076 @item
28077 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28078
28079 @item
28080 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28081
28082 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28083 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28084 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28085 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28086 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28087 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28088 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28089 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28090 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28091 was inserted directly.
28092
28093 @item
28094 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28095
28096 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28097 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28098 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28099 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28100 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28101
28102 @item
28103 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28104
28105 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28106 @lisp
28107 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28108 'bbdb-complete-name)
28109 @end lisp
28110
28111 @item
28112 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28113
28114 Add a new format of match like
28115 @lisp
28116 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28117 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28118 @end lisp
28119 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28120 @lisp
28121 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28122 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28123 @end lisp
28124
28125 @item
28126 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28127
28128 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28129 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28130 need add those two headers too.
28131
28132 @item
28133 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28134 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28135 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28136 versions.
28137
28138 @item
28139 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28140 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28141 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28142 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28143 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28144
28145 @item
28146 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28147
28148 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28149
28150 @item
28151 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28152
28153 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28154 the valid values.
28155
28156 @item
28157 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28158
28159 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28160 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28161 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28162 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28163 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28164 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28165 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28166 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28167
28168 @item
28169 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28170 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
28171
28172 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28173 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28174 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28175 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28176
28177 @item
28178 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28179 C-m}.
28180
28181 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28182 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28183
28184 @item
28185 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28186 @code{best}.
28187
28188 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28189 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28190 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28191 invalidate the digital signature.
28192
28193 @item
28194 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28195 decompressed when activated.
28196 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28197
28198 @item
28199 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28200
28201 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28202 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28203 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28204 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28205 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28206 controls this.
28207
28208 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28209 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28210 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28211 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28212
28213 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28214 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28215 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28216 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28217
28218 @end itemize
28219
28220 @item Changes in back ends
28221 @c ***********************
28222
28223 @itemize @bullet
28224 @item
28225 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28226
28227 @item
28228 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28229
28230 @item
28231 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28232
28233 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28234
28235 @item
28236 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28237
28238 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28239 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28240 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28241 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28242 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28243 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28244 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28245 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28246 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28247 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28248 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28249
28250 @end itemize
28251
28252 @item Appearance
28253 @c *************
28254
28255 @itemize @bullet
28256
28257 @item
28258 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28259 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28260
28261 @item
28262 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28263 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28264 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28265 message, Message Manual}).
28266
28267 @item
28268 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28269 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28270 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28271 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28272
28273 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28274 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28275 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28276 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28277 @end itemize
28278
28279
28280 @item Miscellaneous changes
28281 @c ************************
28282
28283 @itemize @bullet
28284
28285 @item
28286 @code{gnus-agent}
28287
28288 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28289 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28290 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28291 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28292 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28293 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28294 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28295 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28296 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28297 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28298 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28299 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28300 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28301 is not needed any more.
28302
28303 @item
28304 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28305
28306 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28307 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28308 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28309
28310 @item
28311 Dired integration
28312
28313 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28314 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28315 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28316 entry.
28317
28318 @item
28319 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28320
28321 @item
28322 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28323
28324 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28325
28326 @end itemize
28327
28328 @end itemize
28329
28330 @node No Gnus
28331 @subsubsection No Gnus
28332 @cindex No Gnus
28333
28334 New features in No Gnus:
28335 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28336
28337 @include gnus-news.texi
28338
28339 @node Ma Gnus
28340 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28341 @cindex Ma Gnus
28342
28343 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28344 Gnus.
28345
28346 New features in Ma Gnus:
28347
28348 @itemize @bullet
28349
28350 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28351 @c ****************************************************
28352
28353 @itemize @bullet
28354
28355 @item
28356 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28357 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28358 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28359 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28360
28361 @end itemize
28362
28363 @end itemize
28364
28365 @iftex
28366
28367 @page
28368 @node The Manual
28369 @section The Manual
28370 @cindex colophon
28371 @cindex manual
28372
28373 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28374 either @code{texi2dvi}
28375 @iflatex
28376 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28377 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28378 @end iflatex
28379 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28380
28381 The following conventions have been used:
28382
28383 @enumerate
28384
28385 @item
28386 This is a @samp{string}
28387
28388 @item
28389 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28390
28391 @item
28392 This is a @file{file}
28393
28394 @item
28395 This is a @code{symbol}
28396
28397 @end enumerate
28398
28399 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28400 mean:
28401
28402 @lisp
28403 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28404 @end lisp
28405
28406 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28407
28408 @lisp
28409 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28410 @end lisp
28411
28412 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28413 ever get them confused.
28414
28415 @iflatex
28416 @c @head
28417 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28418 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28419 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28420 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28421 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28422 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28423 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28424 @end iflatex
28425
28426 @end iftex
28427
28428
28429 @node On Writing Manuals
28430 @section On Writing Manuals
28431
28432 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28433 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28434 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28435 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28436 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28437 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28438 in hand.
28439
28440 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28441 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28442 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28443 started with Gnus.
28444
28445 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28446 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28447
28448
28449 @page
28450 @node Terminology
28451 @section Terminology
28452
28453 @cindex terminology
28454 @table @dfn
28455
28456 @item news
28457 @cindex news
28458 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28459 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28460 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28461 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28462 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28463
28464 @item mail
28465 @cindex mail
28466 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28467 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28468 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28469 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28470
28471 @item reply
28472 @cindex reply
28473 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28474
28475 @item follow up
28476 @cindex follow up
28477 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28478 are reading.
28479
28480 @item back end
28481 @cindex back end
28482 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28483 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28484 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28485 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28486 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28487 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28488 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28489 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28490 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28491 number 4711''.
28492
28493 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28494 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28495 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28496 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28497 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28498 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28499
28500 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28501 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28502 access the articles.
28503
28504 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28505 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28506 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28507 confusing.
28508
28509 @item native
28510 @cindex native
28511 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28512 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28513 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28514
28515 @item foreign
28516 @cindex foreign
28517 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28518 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28519 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28520 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28521
28522 @item secondary
28523 @cindex secondary
28524 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28525 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28526 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28527
28528 @item article
28529 @cindex article
28530 A message that has been posted as news.
28531
28532 @item mail message
28533 @cindex mail message
28534 A message that has been mailed.
28535
28536 @item message
28537 @cindex message
28538 A mail message or news article
28539
28540 @item head
28541 @cindex head
28542 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
28543 put.
28544
28545 @item body
28546 @cindex body
28547 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28548 body.
28549
28550 @item header
28551 @cindex header
28552 A line from the head of an article.
28553
28554 @item headers
28555 @cindex headers
28556 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28557 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28558
28559 @item @acronym{NOV}
28560 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28561 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28562 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28563 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28564 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28565 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28566
28567 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28568 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28569 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28570 normal @sc{head} format.
28571
28572 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28573 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28574 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28575 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28576 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28577 references, etc.
28578
28579 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28580 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28581 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28582 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28583 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28584 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28585 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28586
28587 @item level
28588 @cindex levels
28589 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
28590 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28591 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
28592 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28593 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28594 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28595
28596 @item killed groups
28597 @cindex killed groups
28598 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28599 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28600
28601 @item zombie groups
28602 @cindex zombie groups
28603 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28604
28605 @item active file
28606 @cindex active file
28607 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28608 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28609 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28610
28611 @item bogus groups
28612 @cindex bogus groups
28613 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28614 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28615 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28616
28617 @item activating
28618 @cindex activating groups
28619 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28620 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28621 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28622
28623 @item spool
28624 @cindex spool
28625 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28626 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28627 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28628
28629 @item server
28630 @cindex server
28631 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28632
28633 @item select method
28634 @cindex select method
28635 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28636 server settings.
28637
28638 @item virtual server
28639 @cindex virtual server
28640 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28641 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28642 whole is a virtual server.
28643
28644 @item washing
28645 @cindex washing
28646 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28647 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28648 original.
28649
28650 @item ephemeral groups
28651 @cindex ephemeral groups
28652 @cindex temporary groups
28653 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28654 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28655 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28656
28657 @item solid groups
28658 @cindex solid groups
28659 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28660 group buffer are solid groups.
28661
28662 @item sparse articles
28663 @cindex sparse articles
28664 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28665 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28666
28667 @item threading
28668 @cindex threading
28669 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28670 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28671
28672 @item root
28673 @cindex root
28674 @cindex thread root
28675 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28676 articles in the thread.
28677
28678 @item parent
28679 @cindex parent
28680 An article that has responses.
28681
28682 @item child
28683 @cindex child
28684 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28685
28686 @item digest
28687 @cindex digest
28688 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28689 specified by RFC 1153.
28690
28691 @item splitting
28692 @cindex splitting, terminology
28693 @cindex mail sorting
28694 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28695 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28696 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28697
28698 @end table
28699
28700
28701 @page
28702 @node Customization
28703 @section Customization
28704 @cindex general customization
28705
28706 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28707 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28708 for some quite common situations.
28709
28710 @menu
28711 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28712 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28713 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28714 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28715 @end menu
28716
28717
28718 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28719 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28720
28721 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28722 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28723 Gnus has to get from the server.
28724
28725 @table @code
28726
28727 @item gnus-read-active-file
28728 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28729 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28730 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28731 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28732 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28733
28734 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28735 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28736 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28737 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28738 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28739 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28740 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28741 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28742 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28743 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28744 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28745
28746 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28747 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28748 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28749 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28750 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28751 variables.
28752 @end table
28753
28754
28755 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28756 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28757
28758 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28759 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28760 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28761
28762 @table @code
28763
28764 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28765 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28766 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28767 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28768 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28769
28770 @item gnus-visible-headers
28771 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28772 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28773 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28774 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28775
28776 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28777 @lisp
28778 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28779 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28780 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28781 @end lisp
28782
28783 @item gnus-use-full-window
28784 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28785 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28786 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28787 want to read them anyway.
28788
28789 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28790 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28791 hidden initially.
28792
28793
28794 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28795 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28796 lines, which might save some time.
28797 @end table
28798
28799
28800 @node Little Disk Space
28801 @subsection Little Disk Space
28802 @cindex disk space
28803
28804 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28805 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28806
28807 @table @code
28808
28809 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28810 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28811 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28812 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28813 default.
28814
28815 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28816 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28817 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28818 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28819 default.
28820
28821 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28822 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28823 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28824 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28825 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28826
28827 @end table
28828
28829
28830 @node Slow Machine
28831 @subsection Slow Machine
28832 @cindex slow machine
28833
28834 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28835 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28836
28837 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28838 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28839
28840 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28841 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28842 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28843
28844
28845 @page
28846 @node Troubleshooting
28847 @section Troubleshooting
28848 @cindex troubleshooting
28849
28850 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28851 problems, really.
28852
28853 Ahem.
28854
28855 @enumerate
28856
28857 @item
28858 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28859
28860 @item
28861 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28862 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28863 Gnus will work.
28864
28865 @item
28866 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28867 like @c
28868 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28869 @c
28870 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28871 files lying around. Delete these.
28872
28873 @item
28874 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28875 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28876
28877 @item
28878 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28879 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28880 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28881 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28882 something like that.
28883 @end enumerate
28884
28885 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28886
28887 @cindex bugs
28888 @cindex reporting bugs
28889
28890 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28891 @findex gnus-bug
28892 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28893 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28894 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28895 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28896
28897 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28898 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28899 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28900 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28901 time.
28902
28903 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28904 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28905 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28906 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28907 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28908 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28909
28910 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28911 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28912 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28913 the bug report.
28914
28915 @cindex patches
28916 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28917 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28918
28919 @cindex edebug
28920 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28921 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28922 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28923 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28924 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28925 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28926 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28927 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28928 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28929 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28930 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28931 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28932 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28933 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28934
28935 @cindex elp
28936 @cindex profile
28937 @cindex slow
28938 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28939 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28940 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28941 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28942 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28943
28944 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
28945 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28946 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28947 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
28948 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28949 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28950 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28951 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28952 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28953 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28954 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28955 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28956 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28957 work perfectly.
28958
28959 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28960 @cindex ding mailing list
28961 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28962 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28963 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28964 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28965
28966
28967 @page
28968 @node Gnus Reference Guide
28969 @section Gnus Reference Guide
28970
28971 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
28972 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
28973 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
28974 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
28975 it.
28976
28977 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
28978 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
28979 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
28980 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
28981 and general methods of operation.
28982
28983 @menu
28984 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
28985 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
28986 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
28987 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
28988 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
28989 * Group Info:: The group info format.
28990 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
28991 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
28992 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
28993 @end menu
28994
28995
28996 @node Gnus Utility Functions
28997 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
28998 @cindex Gnus utility functions
28999 @cindex utility functions
29000 @cindex functions
29001 @cindex internal variables
29002
29003 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29004 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29005 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29006
29007 @table @code
29008
29009 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29010 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29011 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29012
29013 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29014 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29015 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29016
29017 @item gnus-group-real-name
29018 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29019 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29020 name.
29021
29022 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29023 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29024 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29025 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29026
29027 @item gnus-get-info
29028 @findex gnus-get-info
29029 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29030
29031 @item gnus-group-unread
29032 @findex gnus-group-unread
29033 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29034 unknown.
29035
29036 @item gnus-active
29037 @findex gnus-active
29038 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29039 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29040
29041 @item gnus-set-active
29042 @findex gnus-set-active
29043 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29044
29045 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29046 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29047 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29048 exit.
29049
29050 @item gnus-continuum-version
29051 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29052 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29053 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29054 versions.
29055
29056 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29057 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29058 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29059
29060 @item gnus-news-group-p
29061 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29062 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29063
29064 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29065 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29066 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29067
29068 @item gnus-server-to-method
29069 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29070 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29071
29072 @item gnus-server-equal
29073 @findex gnus-server-equal
29074 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29075 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29076 this function will consider them equal.
29077
29078 @item gnus-group-native-p
29079 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29080 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29081
29082 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29083 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29084 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29085
29086 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29087 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29088 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29089
29090 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29091 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29092 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29093 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29094 @var{group}.
29095
29096 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29097 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29098 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29099
29100 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29101 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29102 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29103
29104 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29105 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29106 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29107 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29108
29109 @lisp
29110 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29111 @result{} t
29112 @end lisp
29113
29114 @item gnus-read-method
29115 @findex gnus-read-method
29116 Prompts the user for a select method.
29117
29118 @end table
29119
29120
29121 @node Back End Interface
29122 @subsection Back End Interface
29123
29124 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29125 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29126 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29127 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29128 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29129 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29130
29131 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29132 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29133 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29134 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29135 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29136 been opened, the function should fail.
29137
29138 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29139 name. Take this example:
29140
29141 @lisp
29142 (nntp "odd-one"
29143 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29144 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29145 @end lisp
29146
29147 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29148 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29149
29150 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29151 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29152 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29153
29154 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29155 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29156 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29157
29158 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29159 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29160 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29161 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29162 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29163 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29164 return value.
29165
29166 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29167 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29168 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
29169 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29170 more.
29171
29172 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29173 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29174 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29175 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29176 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29177 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29178 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29179 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29180 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29181 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29182
29183 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29184 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29185 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29186 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29187 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29188 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29189 of numbers as long as possible.
29190
29191 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29192 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29193 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29194
29195 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29196 @code{nnchoke}.
29197
29198 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29199
29200 @menu
29201 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29202 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29203 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29204 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29205 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29206 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29207 @end menu
29208
29209
29210 @node Required Back End Functions
29211 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29212
29213 @table @code
29214
29215 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29216
29217 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29218 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29219 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29220 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29221
29222 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29223 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29224 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29225 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29226
29227 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29228 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29229 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29230 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29231 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29232 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29233 number, do maximum fetches.
29234
29235 Here's an example HEAD:
29236
29237 @example
29238 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29239 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29240 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29241 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29242 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29243 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29244 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29245 Lines: 26
29246 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29247 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29248 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29249 .
29250 @end example
29251
29252 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29253 these in the data buffer.
29254
29255 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29256
29257 @example
29258 headers = *head
29259 head = error / valid-head
29260 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29261 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29262 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29263 header = <text> eol
29264 @end example
29265
29266 @cindex BNF
29267 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29268
29269 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29270 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29271 separated by tabs.
29272
29273 @example
29274 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29275 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29276 field = <text except TAB>
29277 @end example
29278
29279 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29280 @pxref{Headers}.
29281
29282
29283 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29284
29285 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29286 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29287
29288 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29289 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29290 server. In fact, it should do so.
29291
29292 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29293 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29294
29295
29296 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29297
29298 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29299 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29300 reason.
29301
29302 There should be no data returned.
29303
29304
29305 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29306
29307 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29308 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29309 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29310 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29311
29312 There should be no data returned.
29313
29314
29315 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29316
29317 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29318 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29319 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29320 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29321
29322 There should be no data returned.
29323
29324
29325 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29326
29327 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29328
29329 There should be no data returned.
29330
29331
29332 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29333
29334 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29335 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29336 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29337 it would be nice if that were possible.
29338
29339 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29340 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29341 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29342 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29343 into its article buffer.
29344
29345 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29346 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29347 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29348 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29349 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29350 on successful article retrieval.
29351
29352
29353 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29354
29355 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29356 making @var{group} the current group.
29357
29358 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29359 the current group.
29360
29361 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29362 structure.
29363
29364 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29365
29366 @example
29367 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29368 @end example
29369
29370 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29371 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29372 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29373 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29374 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29375 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29376 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29377 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29378 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29379 highest as 0.
29380
29381 @example
29382 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29383 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29384 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29385 @end example
29386
29387
29388 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29389
29390 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29391 a no-op on most back ends.
29392
29393 There should be no data returned.
29394
29395
29396 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29397
29398 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29399 @emph{all}.
29400
29401 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29402
29403 @example
29404 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29405 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29406 @end example
29407
29408 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29409 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29410 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29411 and the highest as 0.
29412
29413 @example
29414 active-file = *active-line
29415 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29416 name = <string>
29417 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29418 @end example
29419
29420 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29421 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29422 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29423
29424
29425 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29426
29427 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29428 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29429 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29430 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29431 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29432 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29433
29434 There should be no result data from this function.
29435
29436 @end table
29437
29438
29439 @node Optional Back End Functions
29440 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29441
29442 @table @code
29443
29444 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29445
29446 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29447 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29448 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29449
29450 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29451 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29452 former is in the same format as the data from
29453 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29454 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29455
29456 @example
29457 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29458 @end example
29459
29460
29461 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29462
29463 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29464 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29465 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29466 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29467 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29468 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29469 the network resources).
29470
29471 There should be no result data from this function.
29472
29473
29474 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29475
29476 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29477 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29478 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29479 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29480 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29481 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29482 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29483 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29484
29485 There should be no result data from this function.
29486
29487
29488 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29489
29490 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29491 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
29492 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29493 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29494 propagate the mark information to the server.
29495
29496 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29497
29498 @example
29499 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29500 @end example
29501
29502 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29503 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29504 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29505 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29506 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29507 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29508 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29509 itself to these.
29510
29511 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29512 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29513 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29514 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29515
29516 An example action list:
29517
29518 @example
29519 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29520 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29521 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29522 @end example
29523
29524 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29525 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29526
29527 There should be no result data from this function.
29528
29529 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29530
29531 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29532 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29533 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29534 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29535 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29536
29537 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29538 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29539 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29540 expirable.
29541
29542 There should be no result data from this function.
29543
29544
29545 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29546
29547 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29548 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29549 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29550 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29551 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29552 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29553 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29554 local if that's practical.
29555
29556 There should be no result data from this function.
29557
29558
29559 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29560
29561 The result data from this function should be a description of
29562 @var{group}.
29563
29564 @example
29565 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29566 name = <string>
29567 description = <text>
29568 @end example
29569
29570 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29571
29572 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29573 groups available on the server.
29574
29575 @example
29576 description-buffer = *description-line
29577 @end example
29578
29579
29580 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29581
29582 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29583 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29584 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29585 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29586 in the active buffer format.
29587
29588 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29589 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29590 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29591 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29592 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29593 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29594 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29595
29596
29597 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29598
29599 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29600
29601 There should be no return data.
29602
29603
29604 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29605
29606 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29607 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29608 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29609 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29610 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29611 they are.
29612
29613 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29614 able to delete.
29615
29616 There should be no result data returned.
29617
29618
29619 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29620
29621 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29622 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29623
29624 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29625 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29626 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29627 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29628 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29629 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29630
29631 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29632 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29633 optimizations.
29634
29635 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29636 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29637
29638 There should be no data returned.
29639
29640
29641 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29642
29643 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29644 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29645 this function in short order.
29646
29647 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29648 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29649
29650 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29651 article for that group.
29652
29653 There should be no data returned.
29654
29655
29656 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29657
29658 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29659 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29660
29661 There should be no data returned.
29662
29663
29664 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29665
29666 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29667 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29668 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29669
29670 There should be no data returned.
29671
29672
29673 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29674
29675 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29676 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29677
29678 There should be no data returned.
29679
29680 @end table
29681
29682
29683 @node Error Messaging
29684 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29685
29686 @findex nnheader-report
29687 @findex nnheader-get-report
29688 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29689 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29690 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29691 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29692 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29693 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29694
29695 @lisp
29696 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29697
29698 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29699 @end lisp
29700
29701 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29702 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29703 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29704 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29705
29706 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29707 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29708 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29709
29710
29711 @node Writing New Back Ends
29712 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29713
29714 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29715 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29716 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29717 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29718 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29719 editing articles.
29720
29721 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29722 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29723 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29724
29725 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29726 package called @code{nnoo}.
29727
29728 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29729 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29730 following macros:
29731
29732 @table @code
29733
29734 @item nnoo-declare
29735 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29736 parameters. For instance:
29737
29738 @lisp
29739 (nnoo-declare nndir
29740 nnml nnmh)
29741 @end lisp
29742
29743 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29744 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29745
29746 @item defvoo
29747 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29748 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29749 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29750
29751 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29752 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29753 a function in those back ends.
29754
29755 @lisp
29756 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29757 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29758 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29759 @end lisp
29760
29761 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29762 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29763 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29764
29765 @item nnoo-define-basics
29766 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29767 have.
29768
29769 @lisp
29770 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29771 @end lisp
29772
29773 @item deffoo
29774 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29775 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29776 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29777
29778 @item nnoo-map-functions
29779 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29780 functions from the parent back ends.
29781
29782 @lisp
29783 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29784 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29785 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29786 @end lisp
29787
29788 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29789 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29790 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29791 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29792
29793 @item nnoo-import
29794 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29795 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29796 haven't already been defined.
29797
29798 @lisp
29799 (nnoo-import nndir
29800 (nnmh
29801 nnmh-request-list
29802 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29803 (nnml))
29804 @end lisp
29805
29806 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29807 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29808 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29809 defined now.
29810
29811 @end table
29812
29813 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29814
29815 @lisp
29816 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29817 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29818
29819 ;;; @r{Code:}
29820
29821 (require 'nnheader)
29822 (require 'nnmh)
29823 (require 'nnml)
29824 (require 'nnoo)
29825 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29826
29827 (nnoo-declare nndir
29828 nnml nnmh)
29829
29830 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29831 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29832 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29833
29834 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29835 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29836 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29837
29838 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29839 nil
29840 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29841 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29842 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29843
29844 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29845 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29846
29847 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29848
29849 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29850
29851 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29852 (setq nndir-directory
29853 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29854 server))
29855 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29856 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29857 (push `(nndir-current-group
29858 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29859 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29860 defs)
29861 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29862 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29863 defs)
29864 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29865
29866 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29867 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29868 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29869 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29870 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29871
29872 (nnoo-import nndir
29873 (nnmh
29874 nnmh-status-message
29875 nnmh-request-list
29876 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29877
29878 (provide 'nndir)
29879 @end lisp
29880
29881
29882 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29883 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29884
29885 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29886 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29887 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29888 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29889 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29890
29891 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29892 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29893
29894 Here's an example:
29895
29896 @lisp
29897 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29898 @end lisp
29899
29900 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29901
29902 The abilities can be:
29903
29904 @table @code
29905 @item mail
29906 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29907 @item post
29908 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29909 @item post-mail
29910 This back end supports both mail and news.
29911 @item none
29912 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29913 different.
29914 @item respool
29915 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29916 articles and groups.
29917 @item address
29918 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29919 true for almost all back ends.
29920 @item prompt-address
29921 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29922 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29923 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29924 @end table
29925
29926
29927 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29928 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29929
29930 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29931 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29932 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29933 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29934
29935 @lisp
29936 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29937 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29938 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29939 @end lisp
29940
29941 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29942 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29943 mail.
29944
29945 This function takes four parameters.
29946
29947 @table @var
29948 @item method
29949 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29950 the call.
29951
29952 @item exit-function
29953 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29954
29955 @item temp-directory
29956 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29957
29958 @item group
29959 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29960 performed for one group only.
29961 @end table
29962
29963 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29964 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29965 find the article number assigned to this article.
29966
29967 The function also uses the following variables:
29968 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
29969 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
29970 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
29971 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
29972 this:
29973
29974 @example
29975 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
29976 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
29977 @end example
29978
29979
29980 @node Score File Syntax
29981 @subsection Score File Syntax
29982
29983 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
29984 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
29985 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
29986
29987 Here's a typical score file:
29988
29989 @lisp
29990 (("summary"
29991 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
29992 ("Gnus"))
29993 ("from"
29994 ("Lars" -1000))
29995 (mark -100))
29996 @end lisp
29997
29998 BNF definition of a score file:
29999
30000 @example
30001 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30002 element = rule / atom
30003 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30004 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30005 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30006 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30007 quote = <ascii 34>
30008 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30009 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30010 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30011 date-header = "date"
30012 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30013 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30014 score = "nil" / <integer>
30015 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30016 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30017 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30018 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30019 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30020 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30021 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30022 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30023 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30024 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30025 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30026 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30027 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30028 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30029 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30030 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30031 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30032 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30033 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30034 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30035 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30036 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30037 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30038 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30039 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30040 eval = "eval" space <form>
30041 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30042 @end example
30043
30044 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30045 discarded.
30046
30047 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30048 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30049 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30050 one looong line, then that's ok.
30051
30052 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30053 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30054
30055
30056 @node Headers
30057 @subsection Headers
30058
30059 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30060 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30061 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30062 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30063
30064 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30065 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30066 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30067 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30068 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30069 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30070 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30071
30072 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30073 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30074 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30075 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30076 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30077
30078 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30079 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30080
30081
30082 @node Ranges
30083 @subsection Ranges
30084
30085 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30086 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30087
30088 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30089 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30090 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30091 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30092
30093 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30094 sequence.
30095
30096 @example
30097 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30098 @end example
30099
30100 is transformed into
30101
30102 @example
30103 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30104 @end example
30105
30106 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30107 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30108
30109 @example
30110 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30111 @end example
30112
30113 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30114 is slightly tricky:
30115
30116 @example
30117 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30118 @end example
30119
30120 and
30121
30122 @example
30123 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30124 @end example
30125
30126 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30127
30128 @example
30129 (1 2 3 4 5)
30130 @end example
30131
30132 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30133 also valid:
30134
30135 @example
30136 (1 . 5)
30137 @end example
30138
30139 and is equal to the previous range.
30140
30141 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30142 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30143 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30144 range handling.)
30145
30146 @example
30147 range = simple-range / normal-range
30148 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30149 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30150 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30151 number *[ " " contents ]
30152 @end example
30153
30154 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30155 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30156 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30157 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30158 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30159 sequences.)
30160
30161
30162 @node Group Info
30163 @subsection Group Info
30164
30165 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30166 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30167 describes the group.
30168
30169 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30170 second is a more complex one:
30171
30172 @example
30173 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30174
30175 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30176 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30177 (nnml "")
30178 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30179 @end example
30180
30181 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30182 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30183 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30184 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30185 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30186 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30187 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30188 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30189 this section is about.
30190
30191 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30192 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30193 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30194
30195 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30196
30197 @example
30198 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30199 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30200 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30201 group = quote <string> quote
30202 ralevel = rank / level
30203 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30204 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30205 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30206 read = range
30207 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30208 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30209 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30210 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30211 @end example
30212
30213 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30214 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30215 in pseudo-BNF.
30216
30217 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30218 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30219
30220 @table @code
30221 @item gnus-info-group
30222 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30223 @findex gnus-info-group
30224 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30225 Get/set the group name.
30226
30227 @item gnus-info-rank
30228 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30229 @findex gnus-info-rank
30230 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30231 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30232
30233 @item gnus-info-level
30234 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30235 @findex gnus-info-level
30236 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30237 Get/set the group level.
30238
30239 @item gnus-info-score
30240 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30241 @findex gnus-info-score
30242 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30243 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30244
30245 @item gnus-info-read
30246 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30247 @findex gnus-info-read
30248 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30249 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30250
30251 @item gnus-info-marks
30252 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30253 @findex gnus-info-marks
30254 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30255 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30256
30257 @item gnus-info-method
30258 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30259 @findex gnus-info-method
30260 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30261 Get/set the group select method.
30262
30263 @item gnus-info-params
30264 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30265 @findex gnus-info-params
30266 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30267 Get/set the group parameters.
30268 @end table
30269
30270 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30271 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30272
30273 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30274 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30275 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30276 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30277
30278
30279 @node Extended Interactive
30280 @subsection Extended Interactive
30281 @cindex interactive
30282 @findex gnus-interactive
30283
30284 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30285 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30286 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30287
30288 @lisp
30289 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30290 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30291 ...
30292 )
30293 @end lisp
30294
30295 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30296 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30297 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30298 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30299 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30300 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30301 @code{interactive}.
30302
30303 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30304 adds a few more.
30305
30306 @table @samp
30307 @item y
30308 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30309 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30310 variable.
30311
30312 @item Y
30313 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30314 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30315 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30316
30317 @item A
30318 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30319 function.
30320
30321 @item H
30322 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30323 function.
30324
30325 @item g
30326 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30327 function.
30328
30329 @end table
30330
30331
30332 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30333 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30334 @cindex XEmacs
30335 @cindex Emacsen
30336
30337 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30338 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30339 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30340
30341 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30342 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30343 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30344 Gnus, that's very useful.
30345
30346 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30347 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30348 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30349 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30350 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30351 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30352 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30353 following function:
30354
30355 @lisp
30356 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30357 (start-itimer
30358 "gnus-run-at-time"
30359 `(lambda ()
30360 (,function ,@@args))
30361 time repeat))
30362 @end lisp
30363
30364 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30365 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30366 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30367 all over.
30368
30369 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30370 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30371 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30372
30373 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30374 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30375 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30376
30377
30378 @node Various File Formats
30379 @subsection Various File Formats
30380
30381 @menu
30382 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30383 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30384 @end menu
30385
30386
30387 @node Active File Format
30388 @subsubsection Active File Format
30389
30390 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30391 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30392 in each group.
30393
30394 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30395
30396 @example
30397 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30398 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30399 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30400 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30401 no.general 1000 900 y
30402 @end example
30403
30404 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30405
30406 @example
30407 active = *group-line
30408 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30409 group = <non-white-space string>
30410 spc = " "
30411 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30412 low-number = <positive integer>
30413 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30414 @end example
30415
30416 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30417 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30418
30419
30420 @node Newsgroups File Format
30421 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30422
30423 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30424 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30425 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30426 the user.
30427
30428 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30429 Here's the definition:
30430
30431 @example
30432 newsgroups = *line
30433 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30434 group = <non-white-space string>
30435 tab = <TAB>
30436 description = <string>
30437 @end example
30438
30439
30440 @page
30441 @node Emacs for Heathens
30442 @section Emacs for Heathens
30443
30444 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30445 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30446 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30447 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30448 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30449 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30450 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30451 cat instead.
30452
30453 @menu
30454 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30455 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30456 @end menu
30457
30458
30459 @node Keystrokes
30460 @subsection Keystrokes
30461
30462 @itemize @bullet
30463 @item
30464 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30465
30466 @item
30467 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30468 @end itemize
30469
30470 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30471 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30472 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30473 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30474 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30475 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30476
30477 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30478 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30479 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30480 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30481 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30482 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30483 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30484
30485 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30486 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30487 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30488 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30489 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30490 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30491 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30492
30493 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30494 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30495 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30496 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30497 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30498 it.
30499
30500
30501
30502 @node Emacs Lisp
30503 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30504
30505 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30506 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30507 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30508 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30509
30510 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30511 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30512 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30513 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30514 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30515 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30516 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30517 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30518 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30519 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30520
30521 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30522 write the following:
30523
30524 @lisp
30525 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30526 @end lisp
30527
30528 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30529 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30530 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30531 change how Gnus works.
30532
30533 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30534 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30535 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30536 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30537 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30538
30539 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30540 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30541 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30542
30543 Some pitfalls:
30544
30545 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30546 that means:
30547
30548 @lisp
30549 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30550 @end lisp
30551
30552 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30553 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30554
30555 @lisp
30556 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30557 @end lisp
30558
30559 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30560 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30561
30562 @page
30563 @include gnus-faq.texi
30564
30565 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30566 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30567 @include doclicense.texi
30568
30569 @node Index
30570 @chapter Index
30571 @printindex cp
30572
30573 @node Key Index
30574 @chapter Key Index
30575 @printindex ky
30576
30577 @bye
30578
30579 @iftex
30580 @iflatex
30581 \end{document}
30582 @end iflatex
30583 @end iftex
30584
30585 @c Local Variables:
30586 @c mode: texinfo
30587 @c coding: utf-8
30588 @c End: